Hochiki Products PDF
Hochiki Products PDF
Hochiki Products PDF
APPLICATION
The HOCHIKI America ALG-V Photoelectric Smoke
Sensor is particularly suited to detecting optically dense
smoke typical of fires involving materials such as soft
furnishings, plastic, foam or other similar materials which
tend to smoulder and produce large visible smoke particles.
Hochiki's unique design allows fast response to flaming
fires as well as smoldering fires while eliminating false
alarms.
OPERATION
The detection chamber consists of a light emitting diode
(LED) and photodiode arrangement. The chamber is
designed such that light emitted by the LED cannot
Shown without base normally reach the photo diode. In the event of fire,
particles of smoke enter the chamber and scatter the
STANDARD FEATURES light. As the smoke level increases, the scattering effect
• Low Profile - Only 1.97" high, including base. increases, causing more light to hit the photo- diode.
• Simple and reliable device addressing method. The chamber contains a unique baffle design which allows
• Very low current consumption using the unique smoke to enter the chamber while preventing external
"Low Power Mode". light from affecting the photodiode. The photodiode input
level is sampled to sense smoke density.
• Automatic compensation for sensor contamination.
• Built-in optical fire test feature. When the smoke density exceeds a preset threshold
• Uses the noise immune Digital Communication the sensor transmits an interrupt to the fire control panel
Protocol (DCP), which utilizes interrupts for fast indicating a fire condition. The fire alarm control panel
response to fires. can adjust the sensor threshold to compensate for
contamination.
SPECIFICATIONS
Operating Voltage 17-41 VDC Up to 127 devices are permitted on each loop. A sensor
address can be set by a hand held programming unit.
Current Consumption The sensor mounts to an electronics free base and
Standby: Normal: 390µA (typical) incorporates a locking mechanism for secure installation.
Low Power Mode: The base provides mounting slots, terminals for field wiring
120µA (@ 0.75 sec.) and a third contact for a remote indicator/LED. The sensor
incorporates dual LED's for easy viewing of sensor status.
Average when Polled: 2mA
Alarm: 8mA
Transmission Method DCP - Digital
ENGINEERING SPECIFICATIONS
Communication Protocol The contractor shall furnish and install where indi-
Maximum Humidity 95% RH Non-Condensing cated on the plans, photoelectric sensors HOCHIKI
UL Ambient Installation 32°F to 100° F America Model ALG-V. The combination sensor
head and twist lock base shall be UL listed compat-
Temperature Range (0° C to 37.8° C) ible with a UL listed fire alarm control panel.
Operating Temperature 14°F to 122° F
Range (-10° C to 50° C) PRODUCT LISTINGS
Air Velocity Range 0-4000 fpm
Underwriters Laboratories: S1383
Color & Case Material Bone PC / ABS Blend
CSFM #: 7272-0410:149
Weight 3.4oz FM#: 3022559
(5.1 oz. with 4" base) MEA Report #: 284-91-E Vol. IV
Bases 4" YBN-NSA-4
Continued on back.
6" HSB-NSA-6
Specifications subject to change without notice.
The base shall permit direct interchange with the HOCHIKI America AIE-EA ionization type smoke sensor, and the
ATG-EA heat sensor.
The sensitivity of the sensor shall be capable of being measured by the control panel.
The vandal-resistant, security locking feature shall be used in those areas as indicated on the drawing. The
locking feature shall be optional and can be implemented when required.
BASES
The HOCHIKI America YBN-NSA-4 and the HSB-NSA-6 mounting bases are electronics free and are a simple
rugged design with screw terminals for wiring connections. A common mounting base allows sensor interchange
and maintains loop continuity when sensors are removed. A simple anti-tamper head locking system is provided
which is enabled by removing a small plastic tab on the back of the sensor. Once locked, the head can be removed
using a small diameter screw driver.
NOTE: Fire alarm control panel compatibility is required for DCP products.
State-of-the-art communications protocol, DCP, allows system components (DCP sensors AIE-EA,
ALG-V and ATG-EA, bases and modules), to be used concurrently in a system's signal conditioning loop.
Hochiki America Corporation ALG-V Specifications subject to change without notice.
AIE-EA IONIZATION SMOKE SENSOR
APPLICATION
The HOCHIKI America AIE-EA Ionization smoke sensor
has a responsive and highly stable operation that gives
it an extremely wide range of uses. The AIE-EA can be
used in areas where early warning of trouble from super-
heated or flaming combustibles is expected. The AIE-
EA is also constructed to be effectively used where out-
side RFI (Radio Frequency Interference) and other elec-
trical interference is expected to be encountered.
OPERATION
Shown without base
A single radioactive source ionizes two chambers which
causes a small DC current to flow between the elec-
STANDARD FEATURES. trodes in each chamber. Smoke can freely enter the
• Low Profile - Only 2.22" high, including base. outer chamber while the inner chamber is virtually sealed
• Simple and reliable device addressing method. to smoke. Smoke entering the outer chamber causes a
reduction in the DC current, the imbalance between the
• Very low current consumption using the unique two chambers is proportional to the smoke density. The
"Low Power Mode". two chamber design is utilized to compensate for changes
• Automatic compensation for sensor in atmospheric and environmental conditions. When the
contamination. sensed input value exceeds a predetermined threshold,
• Built in fire test feature. an interrupt is issued to the control panel indicating a
• Uses the noise immune Digital Communication fire alarm.
Protocol (DCP), which utilizes interrupts for fast
response to fires. The fire alarm control panel can adjust the sensor thresh-
old to compensate for contamination. Up to 127 de-
vices are permitted on each loop. A sensor address can
SPECIFICATIONS be set by a hand held programming unit. The sensor
mounts to an electronics free base and incorporates a
Operating Voltage 17-41 VDC locking mechanism for secure installation. The base
Current Consumption provides mounting slots, terminals for field wiring and a
Standby: Normal: 350µA (typical) third contact for a remote indicator/LED. The sensor in-
corporates dual LED's for easy viewing of sensor status.
Low Power Mode:
140µA (@ 0.75 sec)
Average when polled: 2mA ENGINEERING SPECIFICATIONS
Alarm: 8mA
Transmission Method DCP - Digital The contractor shall furnish and install where indicated
Communication Protocol on the plans, dual-chamber, ionization smoke sensor
Maximum Humidity 95% RH Non Condensing HOCHIKI America AIE-EA. The combination sensor head
UL Ambient Installation 32°F to 100°F and twist-lock base shall be UL listed compatible with a
UL listed fire alarm control panel.
Temperature Range (0°C to 37.8°C)
Operating Temperature 14°F to 122°F
Range (-10°C to 50°C) PRODUCT LISTINGS
Radiation Source Americium 241 (0.98µCi) Underwriters Laboratories: S1383
Color & Case Material Bone PC / ABS Blend CSFM #: 7271-0410:148
Weight 4.2oz (5.9 oz. w/ 4" base) FM#: 3022559
Base 4" YBN-NSA-4 MEA Report#: 284-91-E Vol. IV
6" HSB-NSA-6
Continued on back.
Specifications subject to change without notice.
The sensitivity of the sensor shall be capable of being measured by the control panel.
The vandal-resistant, security locking feature shall be used in those areas indicated on the drawing. The
locking feature shall be optional and can be implemented when required.
BASES
The HOCHIKI America HSB-NSA-6 and the YBN-NSA-4 mounting bases are electronics free and are a
simple rugged design with screw terminals for wiring connections. A common mounting base allows
sensor interchange and maintains loop continuity when sensors are removed. A simple anti-tamper head
locking system is provided which is enabled by removing a small plastic tab on the back of the sensor.
Once locked, the head can be removed using a small diameter screw driver.
NOTE: Fire alarm control panel compatibility is required for DCP products.
State-of-the-art communications protocol, DCP, allows system components (DCP sensors AIE-EA,
ALG-V and ATG-EA, bases and modules), to be used concurrently in a system's signal conditioning loop.
Hochiki America Corporation • AIE-EA Specifications subject to change without notice.
ATG-EA HEAT SENSOR
APPLICATION
The HOCHIKI America ATG-EA Sensor provides accurate
temperature measurement data to the fire alarm control
panel. This sensor is particularly suited to environments
where smoke detectors are unsuitable because of the
precense of system or cooking fumes such as in a
kitchen.
OPERATION
The ATG-EA Heat sensor incorporates a highly linear
thermistor circuit, with the thermistor mounted externally.
The specially designed cover protects the thermistor
while allowing maximum air flow. The thermistor circuit
STANDARD FEATURES produces a voltage proportional to temperature which is
• Low Profile - Only 2.0" high, including base scaled, and transmitted as a digitally encoded value to
• Simple and reliable device addressing method the control panel. When the ambient temperature
• Very low current consumption using the unique exceeds a pre-programmed threshold (fixed
"Low Power Mode" temperature), the sensor transmits an interrupt to the
• Built-in optical fire test feature control panel indicating a fire alarm. The fire alarm control
• Uses the noise immune Digital Communication panel can adjust the sensor threshold for different
Protocol (DCP), which utilizes interrupts for fast Standard's requirements. The rate of rise function is
response to fires calculated within the fire alarm control panel, which can
• Adjustable threshold temperature 135°F - 150°F also initiate a fire test which functionally tests the sensor.
(determined by panel)
Up to 127 devices are permitted on each loop. A sensor
SPECIFICATIONS address can be set by a hand-held programming unit.
The sensor mounts to an electronics free base and in-
Operating Voltage 17-41 VDC
corporates a locking mechanism secure installation. The
Current Consumption
base provides mounting slots, terminals for field wiring,
Standby Normal: 350µA (typical)
and a third contact for a remote indicator/LED. The sen-
Low Power Mode: sor incorporates dual LED's for easy viewing of sensor
110µA (@ 0.75 sec.) status.
Average when Polled 2mA
Alarm 8mA
ENGINEERING SPECIFICATIONS
Transmission Method DCP - Digital
Communication Protocol Heat sensors are installed in accordance with NFPA
Maximum Humidity 95% RH Non-Condensing (National Fire Pretection Association) 72, the UL Listed
UL Ambient Installation 32°F to 115° F Spacing Requirements and the rules and regulations set
Temperature Range (0° C to 47° C) forth by the local authorities having
Operating Temperature 135°F to 150° F
Range (57.2° C to 65.6° C) PRODUCT LISTINGS
Color & Case Material Bone PC / ABS blend Underwriters Laboratories: S2966
Weight 3.2oz CSFM #: 7272-0410:147
(4.9 oz. with 4" base) FM#: 3022559
Bases 4" YBN-NSA-4 MEA Report#: 284-91-E Vol. IV
6" HSB-NSA-6
Continued on back.
Specifications subject to change without notice.
BASES
The HOCHIKI America HSB-NSA-6 and the YBN-NSA-4 mounting bases are electronic free and are a simple
rugged design with screw terminals for wiring connections. A common mounting base allows sensor inter-
change and maintains loop continuity when sensors are removed. A simple anti-tamper head locking system
is provided which is enabled by removing a small plastic tab on the back of the sensor. Once locked, the head
can be removed using a small diameter screw driver.
NOTE: Fire alarm control panel compatibility is required for DCP products.
State-of-the-art communications protocol, DCP, allows system components (DCP sensors AIE-EA,
ALG-V and ATG-EA, bases and modules), to be used concurrently in a system's signal conditioning loop.
HSB-NSA-6
STANDARD FEATURES
• UL & ULC Listed
• Designed for use with all NS analog sensors.
• Available in 4 and 6 inch models.
• Contains a security locking tab for tamper
protection.
PRODUCT LISTINGS
Underwriters Laboratories: S1383
Underwriters Laboratories of Canada: CS463
SPECIFICATIONS CSFM #: 7300-0410:132
FM#: 3022559
YBN-NSA-4 4 inches
MEA Report #: 284-91-E Vol. IV
HSB-NSA-6 6 inches
Security Feature Plastic Tamper-Lock
Color Bone PC / ABS Blend
Continued on back.
Specifications subject to change without notice.
The base shall permit direct interchange with the HOCHIKI America AIE-EA ionization type smoke sensor, ALG-V
photoelectric smoke sensor, and the ATG-EA heat sensor.
The sensitivity of the sensor shall be capable of being measured by the control panel.
The vandal-resistant, security locking feature shall be used in those areas as indicated on the drawing. The locking
feature shall be optional and can be implemented when required.
It shall be possible to perform a functional test of the sensor without the need of generating smoke. The test method
shall simulate the effects of products of combustion in the chamber to ensure testing of internal circuitry.
YBN-NSA-4
(+)
U.L.
LISTED
COMPATIBLE
DCP
LOOP (-) 8mA MAX.
OUTPUT
U.L.
LISTED (+)
POWER
LIMITED
SUPPLY 8mA MAX.
OUTPUT
HSB-NSA-6
(+)
U.L.
LISTED
COMPATIBLE
CONTROL (-)
PANEL
U.L.
LISTED
POWER
LIMITED (+)
SUPPLY
NOTE: Fire alarm control panel compatibility is required for DCP products.
State-of-the-art communications protocol, DCP, allows system components (DCP sensors AIE-EA,
ALG-V and ATG-EA, bases and modules), to be used concurrently in a system's signaling line circuit.
Hochiki America Corporation Analog Sensor Bases Specifications subject to change without notice.
ASB - ANALOG SOUNDER BASE
SPECIFICATIONS
FireNET
CONTROL NEXT DEVICE
8mA Max.
PANEL
LOOP OUT
NEXT DEVICE
(+) FIGURE A
TOP VIEW
8mA MAX.
OUTPUT
NOTE: Class A style 7 wire configuration requires the installation of short circuit isolators (SCI).
LOOP IN
CONNECT FOR CLASS A (STYLE 6 OR 7)
HO HA
HO HA-
CH -0 8-
CH 08
IKI 06 AS
IKI -067 AS
M M
AM 7 R B
AM R B
ER EV.
ER EV
IC A B
IC . B
A
CO
CO
RP
RP
.
.
SC
SC
G
G
TP3
TP
3
F
F
DET
DE
TP
T P1
TS
SC
AUX POWER
TP2
TP
S
S
2
S5
S56
6
S
BLK
BLK
BLK
BLK
RED
RED
C-0103
C-0103
RED
RED
2
2
2
2
RED RED RED
FIGURE B
BOTTOM VIEW
SPECIFICATIONS
Primary AC: 120VAC @ 2 amps 60hz (Optional 220VAC)
Output DC: 24VDC @ 4 amps
Power Supply: 4 amp integrated
Charger Current: 1.5 amps max.
Dimensions: 14.5"W x 24" H x 5"D
Weight: 31 lbs (without batteries)
Color: Red (optional charcoal)
Material: ABS/steel enclosure
Display: 8 line x 40 character LCD (320 characters total)
Network: Dual RS485 ports (64 panels max.)
Zones: 500 network wide software zones per system (Output zones 1 to 253 only for SOM 2.0 & earlier)
SLC loops: 2 or 4 (class A or B)
Devices per loop: 127 sensors & modules, plus 127 analog sounder bases, 254 total
(800 addresses+sub-addresses max. per panel)
NAC Outputs: (4) 2.5 amp@24VDC (class B)
Relay Outputs: (5) Form C 1amp@30VDC
Voltage Outputs: (3) 500mA@24VDC
Aux. Power: 500mA@24VDC
Aux. Inputs: (8) digital pull downs
PC Port: RS232
Printer Port: RS232
The contractor shall furnish and install where indicated on the plans, the serial remote annunciator model
FN-LCD-S. The FN-LCD-S shall connect to the FireNET fire alarm control panel (FACP) or network
annunciator (FN-LCD-N) RS485 slave bus. The serial remote annunciator shall annunciate on its 320
character display and local buzzer, the condition of its master FireNET FACP. Up to 15 FN-LCD-S serial
annunciators may be connected together on a single RS-485 FireNET slave bus. The FN-LCD-S shall be
UL listed and compatible with the Hochiki FireNET control panel, and have surface or flush mount
capability.
WIRING DIAGRAM
1522RO @
FIT JUMPER
ADDRESS COMM1 0V +24V COMM2 FOR END OF LINE
RESET W / DOG RESET COMM1 COMM2
+
+
l
ON K S
1 2 3 4 COMMS
ACTIVE
Reset
Not Used
Switch
Not Used
7. PR2
8. PR3
l +
COMMS
ADDITIONAL
I/O BOARDS
To next
( +)
AUX serial
24 VDC
l +
24X (- ) FN-LCD-
S or
other
NETWORK (+)
RS485
l +
IN RS-485
(- ) Buss
Device
NETWORK
l +
OUT
STANDARD FEATURES
• UL 864 9th edition Listed
• 320 character liquid crystal display (8 line x 40
character)
• LED indicators for Fire, Supervisory Alarm, Pre-
Alarm, Fire Output Active, Power On, On Test, Panel
Sounder Silenced, Delay Active, More Events, Point
Bypassed, General Trouble, Power Trouble, System
Trouble & NAC Trouble
• Dual RS485 ports for primary fire network
• RS485 slave bus for expansion - up to 31 FN-4127-IO
DESCRIPTION boards or up to 15 FN-LCD-S serial annunciators and
up to16 FN-4127-IO boards
The FN-LCD-N type LCD network annunciator is • 2 built-in RS-232 interfaces for programming via a PC
designed to be used with the FireNET analog and serial printer interface
addressable system. It allows for remote access,
• 4 on board programmable Form C relays rated at 1
monitoring & control of the FireNET system throughout Amp at 30VDC (Fire, Supervisory, Trouble &
the building. Auxiliary)
The FN-LCD-N is a true network annunciator that can • Same controls as the FireNET fire panel (Reset,
access, monitor & control any or all FireNET panels in Panel Sounder Silence, Lamp Test, Alarm Silence,
the network. Each FN-LCD-N is completely Re-sound Alarm, Fire Drill, Programmable Function,
independent. The highly intuitive user interface and More Events, More Fire Events, Enter & Exit)
320 character LCD display of the FN-LCD-N is exactly • Local piezo sounder for event notification
the same as the FireNET panel. In addition to routing • Supports user codes & firefighter key to enable
any panel in the network to the FN-LCD-N, every event access & controls
category within each panel can also be individually • Powered by FireNET Aux 24VDC or UL fire listed
routed, as well as routing of all remote control functions Aux. 24VDC supply
(reset, alarm silence, re-sound alarm) from individual • Available in red or charcoal, and can be surface or
panels. The FN-LCD-N supports the same RS485 flush mounted (using trim ring)
expansion port as the FireNET panel, allowing for • True network annunciator, any or all panels can be
FireNET expansion boards and accessories to be routed to the FN-LCD-N. In addition, each event
connected to the network annunciator. category can be individually routed to the FN-LCD-N
The FN-LCD-N also has (4) output relays for fire, • Up to (64) FireNET panels & FN-LCD-N's can be
supervisory, trouble & auxiliary. The relays are networked together in any combination
programmable (except supervisory). • 500mA of auxiliary power available rated at 24VDC
Security is established by the use of a password or • Auto-learn feature
firefighters enable key. Designed to be aesthetically • Built-in help & alarm information screens
pleasing, the FN-LCD-N is available in charcoal grey
• Fire drill function
or red and can be surface or flush mounted using a
standard trim ring kit.
• Each FN-LCD-N is completely independent
• Supports up to (31) FN-4127-IO boards on RS485
PRODUCT LISTINGS expansion port
UL 864, NFPA 70 & 72:
• The FN-LCD-N can be configured to remote reset,
silence, resound, any or all panels on the network in
Signaling Device
any combination
S8255 Vol. 2
Specifications subject to change without notice. Continued on back.
ENGINEERING SPECIFICATION
The contractor shall furnish and install where indicated on the plans, the network annunciator model FN-LCD-N.
The FN-LCD-N shall connect to the FireNET fire alarm control panel (FACP) network. The network annunciator
shall be capable of annunciating on its 320 character display and local buzzer, the condition of any FireNET FACP
or network annunciator on the network. Up to 64 FN-LCD-N network annunciators or FireNET FACP's may be
connected together on the network. The FN-LCD-N shall be UL listed, and have surface or flush mount capability.
WIRING DIAGRAM
MODEL DESCRIPTION
DCP-AMS Single Action Hex Key Lock
DCP-AMS DCP-AMS-KL DCP-AMS-LP Dual Action Hex Key Lock
DCP-AMS-KL Single Action Key Lock
DCP-AMS-KL-LP Dual Action Key Lock
DESCRIPTION
The DCP-AMS are the Hochiki America series of
addressable manual pull stations that provide a fast and
practical means of manually initiating a fire alarm signal.
Both single action and dual action manual pull stations
are available. Resetting of the pull station requires either
a Cat 211 key or a 1/8" hex key (depending upon the
model used).
Manual pull stations shall be Underwriters Laboratories Inc. Listed, CSFM Approved, and be installed within the limits
defined in the American Disabilities Act.
WIRING DIAGRAMS
Hochiki America Corporation
OUT TO
NEXT DCP-AMS
MODULE Addressable Manual Pull Station
Ser. No.
SC- S+
S+ SC-
For Proper Installation, see HA-06-135 Rev 12/05
S6512
UL
Listed + S
Hochiki
DCP - SC
Compatible
Panel
Class B (Style 4)
Hochiki America Corporation Hochiki America Corporation Hochiki America Corporation
DCP-AMS DCP-AMS DCP-AMS
Addressable Manual Pull Station Addressable Manual Pull Station Addressable Manual Pull Station
Ser. No. Ser. No. Ser. No.
Listed
Hochiki
- SC
DCP
+ S
Compatible
Panel - SC
Class A Return (Style 6)
Class A (Style 7)
Hochiki America Corporation Hochiki America Corporation
DCP-AMS DCP-AMS
Addressable Manual Pull Station Addressable Manual Pull Station
Ser. No. Ser. No.
+ S
For Proper Installation, see HA-06-063 Rev 2/02
SIGNALING DEVICE
SIGNALING DEVICE
SIGNALING DEVICE
-
ISSUE NO. AH-9774
SC
DCP-SCI
DCP-SCI
DCP-SCI
DCP-SCI
LISTED
LISTED
LISTED
S+ SC- S+ SC-
UL (OUT) S
For Proper Installation, see HA-06-135 Rev 12/05
S6512 (OUT) S (OUT) S
For Proper Installation, see HA-06-135 Rev 12/05
S6512 (OUT) S
S5694
S5694
Hochiki
DCP
Compatible
Panel - SC
+ S
Hochiki America Corporation DCP-AMS, DCP-AMS-LP, DCP-AMS-KL AND DCP-AMS-KL-LP Specifications subject to change without notice.
FN-4127-IO 16 CHANNEL INPUT/OUTPUT BOARD
(RS-485 BUS DEVICE)
SPECIFICATIONS
Supply Voltage: 24 VDC Nominal
Channels: (16) total per I/O board (each
configurable as input or output)
I/O Comms Bus: Up to (32) expansion boards
Quiescent Current: 20mA
Current per input: 3mA max.
Current per output: 100mA max. (*within overall limits)
*Current per bank of 500mA max. (for banks 1-8 & 9-10)
8 outputs:
*Current per I/O board: 1A max.
Communications: RS485 two wire
STANDARD FEATURES
Max Distance from 4,000 ft. (depends on method &
• 16 channels of input/output points. panel: wire size used for input power).
• 32 I/O boards per FireNET panel (512 channels of Cable Capacity: 12 AWG max.
input/output points). Indicators: (2) LED's for communication status
• Each channel configurable as input or output point. Size: 7.5" L x 2.4" W
• Inputs are opto-isolated non-supervised pulldown
type triggered by “dry” contact from input source.
DESCRIPTION
• Outputs are open collector transistor pulldown
type (100mA max each) that provide “wet” voltage The FireNET FN-4127-IO is a 16 channel Input/Output
output. board that provides powerful input/output expansion &
• Simple 4 wire connection to control panel (2 for addition to the FireNET system allowing up to thirty two I/O
power, 2 for data). boards to be connected to each FireNET panel within the
• All inputs/outputs can be assigned to global FireNET network. Every I/O board connected to any panel
functions, any event category, and used in network is available to the entire network, which allows for network
wide Cause & Effect logic. wide input/output mapping. Typical uses include graphical
• Can be mounted locally within control panel LED map displays/annunciators, tabular LED zone display/
enclosure or remotely via FN-ACC accessory annunciators, input/output logic to & from the fire system
enclosure up to 4000ft from the panel. for secondary use (I/O board points cannot be used for
primary fire initiation inputs or notification outputs) such as
• Each I/O board has a unique address 1-32 (set via
access control, burglar, CCTV, intercom, voice, or other 3rd
DIP switch) on the I/O Comms Bus.
party systems. Each channel can be configured to produce
• Input/Outputs are for secondary use, not for a variety of input actions or respond to a variety of output
primary fire initiation inputs or notification outputs. categories or logic. All channels can trigger, or react from,
• Two LED’s are provided for communication status. network wide cause and effect logic depending on their
configuration. The flexibility of these boards is further
PRODUCT LISTINGS enhanced by the fact that each of the channels is
UL 864 Category UOJZ CNN: Signal System Control configurable as either an input or an output. Connection
Unit Sub-Assembly S8255 Vol. 1 Sec. 2 can be achieved through a simple two wire RS485
NFPA72 compliant communications protocol and two wire power input. I/O
CSFM #: 7165-0410:159 boards can be mounted locally in the control panel or
distributed on a bus up to 4,000ft from the panel when
Specifications subject to change without notice. using the FN-ACC accessory enclosure.
SPECIFICATIONS
PRODUCT LISTINGS
UL 864 Category UOJZ CNN: Signal System Control
Unit Sub-Assembly S8255 Vol. 1
NFPA72 compliant
CSFM #: 7165-0410:159
Specifications subject to change without notice.
3-4: CLASS A
OPTIONAL BRANCH
CIRCUIT TO NEXT
INTERFACE MODULE.
JP2
MODULE SUPERVISES
SUPPLY VOLTAGE AND CZM CLASS A
DETECTOR LOOP. Conventional Zone Module
S SC SER. NO. XXXXXXXXX NOTE: ENSURE JUMPER IS IN CORRECT POSITION
TB1 TB2
U.L. LISTED FOR WIRING CONFIGURATION. (POSITION 3-4)
COMPATIBLE SC SC IN+
FIRE CONTROL S
PANEL S IN-
24V- OUT+
UL LISTED 24VDC -
24V+ OUT-
POWER LIMITED +
AND REGULATED MAX. 25 CONVENTIONAL
POWER SUPPLY, DETECTORS
LISTED FOR FIRE 24- 24V+
PROTECTION S5694
NEXT DEVICE ALL WIRING IS SUPERVISED AND POWER LIMTED.
WITH BATTERY
BACKUP. SIGNALING DEVICE
ISSUE NO. AU-6110 EB
DO NOT MIX FIRE ALARM INITIATING, SUPERVISORY, OR
SECURITY DEVICES ON THE SAME MODULE.
1-2: CLASS B
OPTIONAL BRANCH
CIRCUIT TO NEXT
INTERFACE MODULE.
MODULE SUPERVISES
SUPPLY VOLTAGE AND CZM JP2
CLASS B
DETECTOR LOOP. Conventional Zone Module
S SC
TB1 SER. NO. XXXXXXXXX TB2
NOTE: ENSURE JUMPER IS IN CORRECT POSITION
U.L. LISTED FOR WIRING CONFIGURATION. (POSITION 1-2)
COMPATIBLE SC SC IN+
FIRE CONTROL S
PANEL S IN-
24V- OUT+ U.L. LISTED
UL LISTED 24VDC - E.O.L. DEVICE 4.7K
PART NUMBER
0400-01820
E.O.L. DEVICE 4.7K
24V+ OUT- PART NUMBER
POWER LIMITED +
MAX. 25 CONVENTIONAL 0400-01820
AND REGULATED
POWER SUPPLY, DETECTORS
LISTED FOR FIRE 24- 24V+
PROTECTION S5694
NEXT DEVICE
WITH BATTERY
BACKUP. SIGNALING DEVICE
EB
ISSUE NO. AU-6110 ALL WIRING IS SUPERVISED AND POWER LIMTED.
The FRCME-S and FRCME-P shall fit inside a single gang electrical back box. The FRCME-4 shall be supplied with a
plastic face plate and shall be suitable for mounting to a 4" square or double gang electrical back box. The FRCME-4
shall provide a monitor LED that is visible through the face plate.
S+
COMPATIBLE PART NUMBER
0400-01046
SC- CONTROL
IN-A PANEL
FRCME-4/FRCME-S
S5694
IN-B
OUT TO
NEXT
MODULE
U.L. LISTED
SER. NO. XXXXXXXXX
DCP-FRCME-4
COMPATIBLE
SIGNALING DEVICE
ISSUE NO. AH-9755
S+
SC- CONTROL
PANEL
IN-A
S5694
IN-B
CAUTION!
DO NOT CONNECT MORE THAN ONE N/C CONTACT TO AN INPUT.
FRCME-P OUT TO
NEXT
MODULE TYPICAL WIRING FOR N/O CONTACTS ONLY
S SC
DCP-FRCME-P
ISSUE NO. AH-9765
SC CONTROL
RED
S (IN)
PANEL
SC (OUT)
BLK
SC (IN)
IN-A
S5694
WHT
IN-B
S U.L. LISTED
S (OUT)
COMPATIBLE
SIGNALING DEVICE
DCP-FRCME-P
ISSUE NO. AH-9765
RED
SC CONTROL
S (IN)
PANEL
SC (OUT)
BLK
SC (IN)
IN-A
S5694
WHT
IN-B
CAUTION!
DO NOT CONNECT MORE THAN ONE N/C CONTACT TO AN INPUT.
SPECIFICATIONS
DESCRIPTION
PRODUCT LISTINGS
S8255
The FN-CTM City Tie Module shall be Hochiki America City Tie Module. Module terminal blocks shall be capable
of accepting up to 14 AWG wire. The FN-CTM City Tie Module shall be configured such that the Fire Alarm Control
Panels EOL (end of line) device connect directly with the module to ensure that supervision of interface wiring is
performed. The module shall fit into a standard 4" electrical back box. The FN-CTM City Tie Module shall be
Underwriters Laboratories Listed for the intended purpose.
WIRING DIAGRAM
-
NAC Input Compatible UL Listed
E.O.L. DEVICE Fire Alarm Control Panel
EOL
NAC Circuit NAC Circuit
For Proper Installation
S8255 see HA-06-137 Rev 5/06
Automatic heat detectors where ambient temperatures do not exceed 120°F shall be the DCD-135 fixed temperature/
rate-of-rise heat detector rated at 135°F. For areas where ambient temperatures exceed 120°F, but not 160°F, the
DCD-190 fixed temperature/rate-of-rise heat detector rated at 190°F shall be used. Electrical contacts shall be
normally open, rated at 150mA @ 24VDC.
Heat detectors shall be installed in accordance with National Fire Protection Association Standard 72, the spacing
assigned by Underwriters Laboratories and in accordance with the rules and regulations set forth by the local authorities
having jurisdiction. Automatic heat detectors shall be Underwriters Laboratories listed.
4-WIRE OPERATION
(+)
INITIATING LISTED
CIRCUIT END OF LINE
DEVICE
HSC-4R
CONTACTS
(-) H1
H2
YEL
ORN
PUR
HSC-4R HSC-4R
2-WIRE OPERATION
UL LISTED (+)
CONTROL LISTED
PANEL END OF LINE
DEVICE
(-)
PANEL Resistor shown is for example
POWER only. Not all annunciators have
in line resistance.
SUPPLY
(-)
NEGATIVE
NS4 SERIES NS6 SERIES
Annunciation device must be current limited to 20 mA @
24VDC Maximum. Not limiting current could result in
damage to the detector or cause a no alarm condition.
(+)
UL LISTED LISTED
CONTROL END OF LINE
PANEL DEVICE
TERMINAL BLOCK USED ON
HSC-224RA/RST VERSION ONLY
(-) HSC-(XXX)R (2-WIRE)
COM 6
GRY
N/C 5 BLU
GRN
N/O 4 YEL
ORN
HSC-RELAY SERIES N/O 3 PUR
Hochiki America Corporation DCD 135/190 Specifications subject to change without notice.
DSC-EA RATE OF RISE THERMAL DETECTOR
STANDARD FEATURES
1. The DSC features a slim design which combines
visual appeal with a high standard of reliability.
2. The design of the DSC enables the detector to
operate in locations where the temperature is likely
to increase suddenly should a fire develop.
3. The operating characteristics of DSC is a key feature
of the product enabling a very cost effective solution
for the use of heat detectors. This detector consumes
no current in standby, which enables an unlimited
number of detectors to be connected on the same
detection wires.
4. With connection to the standard Hochiki range of
conventional bases, the DSC heat detector can be
connected or disconnected very easily, allowing
simple interchangeability with other members of the
Hochiki conventional detectors.
SPECIFICATIONS
Rated Voltage: 24VDC APPLICATION
Working Voltage: 15 - 30VDC The DSC rate of rise heat detector is suitable for use in
Maximum Switching Current: 100mA max. most applications that require heat detection. Please
Heat Sensing Element: Air chamber composed with note that special attention should be given to avoid
the diaphragm. installation in direct line with hot air heaters, above
Operating Temp. Range: stoves, ovens or other heat generating objects.
-10° C - +50° C
(14°F - 122° F) OPERATION
Storage Temp. Range: -30° C - +70° C
(-22° F - 158° F) The DSC rate of rise heat detectors are composed of
Relative Humidity an air chamber, vent and a flexible metal diaphragm.
(at 40° C): 95% RH Non-Condensing When the DSC is heated, the air in the chamber
Dimensions: 3.9 " D x 1.3" H expands. The vent permits the chamber to breathe and
Weight: 3 oz. slowly release the expanded air. If a fire occurs, the air
Color: Bone in the chamber will expand more rapidly than it can be
Applicable Standard: UL-521 vented. This causes the diagram to close a set of
Response Grade: Ordinary precious metal contacts (nornally open) to trigger the
alarm signal.
PRODUCT LISTINGS
Underwriters Laboratories: S2966
The HSC-(XXX)L Series is a 6" base featuring a current limiting resistor, latching annunciator
output and a latching circuit so the alarm LED will remain lit until the control panel has been
reset. Heat detectors are not recognized as proper detection for life safety protection, therefore
they should be utilized only for the protection of property.
COMPATIBLE (+)
UL LISTED LISTED
CONTROL END OF LINE
PANEL DEVICE
3.9K 1/2W
(-)
Pig Tail Lead
PANEL
POWER (-)
SUPPLY
HSC-(XXX)L SERIES
NEGATIVE
The NS6-100 is a 6" diameter base that has no current limiting nor annunciator output features.
A direct short occurs across the loop when the detector is actuated. Heat detectors are not
recognized as proper detection for life safety protection, therefore they should be utilized only
for the protection of property.
(+)
COMPATIBLE
UL LISTED LISTED
CONTROL END OF LINE
PANEL DEVICE
(-)
6 6
NS6-100
Non polarized, not current limited. No annunciator output.
We try to keep our product information up-to-date and accurate. However, we cannot cover
all specifications or anticipate all requirements. For additional information contact
your local distributor or call or write Hochiki America Corporation.
OPERATION
The DFE 135/190 fixed temperature heat detector is
STANDARD FEATURES suited to alarm in the presence of slowly rising
temperatures. The construction of this model
• Choice of fixed temperature - 135°F or 190°F
incorporates an oversized heat collector protected from
• UL Listed ceiling spacing of 50' by 50' damage by the built-in, durable plastic guard. The DFE
135/190 fixed temperature heat detector used the proven
(2,500 square feet) snap-disc principle of operation. This bi-metal disc
• Self-Restoring deflects when temperature reaches a predetermined
value. The disc deflection then causes a push-rod to
• Heat element protected by a built-in guard close the internal contact resulting in an alarm condition.
• Contact Rating of 100 mA The bi-metal disc returns to its normal shape when the
heat subsides causing internal contacts to return to their
• Highly Dependable normally open position. A standby condition is restored.
• Latching LED base available
ENGINEERING SPECIFICATIONS
SPECIFICATIONS
Automatic heat detectors shall be fixed temperature rated
Response Temperature 135° ± 7.5°F at 135°F for areas where ambient temperatures do not
Temperature 190° ± 7.5°F exceed 120°F and 190°F where ambient temperatures
Contact Rating N/O Contacts exceed 120°F but not 160°F. The fixed temperature el-
100mA @ 60 V ement shall consist of a bi-metallic disc and actuator
Color & Case Material Ivory ACS shaft. Electrical contacts shall be normally open, rated
Mounting Refer to back of this sheet at 100mA @ 60VDC.
The HSC-xxx L Series is a 6" base featuring a current limiting resistor, latching annunciator output
and a latching circuit so the alarm LED will remain lit until the control panel has been reset. Heat
detectors are not recognized as proper detection for life safety protection, therefore they should
be utilized only for the protection of property.
COMPATIBLE (+)
UL LISTED LISTED
CONTROL END OF LINE
PANEL DEVICE
3.9K 1/2W
(-)
Pig Tail Lead
PANEL
POWER (-)
SUPPLY
HSC-(XXX)L SERIES
NEGATIVE
Nominal alarm current shown at 24V. Polarized with annunciator output.
HSC-21L 24mA HSC-221L 41mA
HSC-224L 38mA HSC-220L 73mA
The NS6-100 is a 6" diameter base that has no current limiting nor annunciator output features.
A direct short occurs across the loop when the detector is actuated. Heat detectors are not
recognized as proper detection for life safety protection, therefore they should be utilized only
for the protection of property.
(+)
COMPATIBLE
UL LISTED LISTED
CONTROL
PANEL DEVICE
(-)
6 6
NS6-100
Non polarized, not current limited. No annunciator output.
We try to keep our product information up-to-date and accurate. However, we cannot cover
all specifications or anticipate all requirements. For additional information contact
your local distributor or call or write Hochiki America Corporation.
MS-RA MS-KA/P/R
Functions: Functions:
Remote Alarm LED (red) ALARM
Remote Alarm LED (red)
For Use with: Pilot LED (green)
ALARM
DH-98-I, DH-98-P PILOT
Key-Operated Test/Reset
DH-98-HVI, DH-98-HVP Switch
DH-98-A, DH-98-AR For Use with:
TEST/RESET
DH-98-I, DH-98-P
DH-98-HVI, DH-98-HVP
MS-KA/R MS-RA/R
Functions: Functions:
ALARM Remote Alarm LED (red) Remote Alarm LED (red)
Key-Operated Test/Reset ALARM
Push-button Test/Reset
Switch Switch
For Use with: For Use with:
DH-98-I, DH-98-P TEST/RESET DH-98-I, DH-98-P
TEST/RESET
DH-98-HVI, DH-98-HVP DH-98-HVI, DH-98-HVP
DH-98-AR DH-98-AR
MS-RA/P MS-RA/P/R
Functions: Functions:
Remote Alarm LED (red) Remote Alarm LED (red)
ALARM
ALARM Pilot LED (green) Pilot LED (green)
For Use with: Push-button Test/Reset
PILOT
DH-98-I, DH-98-P Switch
PILOT DH-98-HVI, DH-98-HVP For Use with:
TEST/RESET DH-98-I, DH-98-P
DH-98-HVI, DH-98-HVP
WIRING DIAGRAM
RED
RED
RED GREEN
ALARM
24VDC PILOT
24VDC ALARM HORN
LED LED
BLACK
BLACK
ALARM
PILOT
BLACK
KEY OR
PUSH BUTTON
24VDC
"TEST/RESET"
SWITCH
BLACK
TEST/RESET
PRODUCT SPECIFICATIONS
PUSH KEY
PILOT ALARM BUTTON OPERATED
LED LED TEST/ TEST/ SINGLE DOUBLE
(GREEN) (RED) RESET RESET HORN GANG GANG
MODEL #
MS-RA
MS-RA/P
MS-RA/R
MS-RA/P/R
MS-KA/R
MS-KA/P/R
MS-RH/KA/P/R
Hochiki America Corporation DH-98 Duct Detector Remote Accessories Specifications subject to change without notice.
DH-98 ANALOG DUCT DETECTOR
STANDARD FEATURES
• Detects and limits the spread of smoke
throughout building HVAC ducts.
• Compatible with building automation and fire
alarm systems.
• Installs quickly and easily.
• No screens or filters to clean.
• Rugged gray steel back box with clear cover.
• Accessories - Remote LED alarm
indication capability.
• Meets UL 268A Requirements.
APPLICATION
The HOCHIKI AMERICA DH-98 Analog duct smoke
Duct housing with an ALG-DH analog
photoelectric sensor.
detector provides early detection of smoke and
products of combustion present in air moving
SPECIFICATIONS through HVAC ducts in Commercial, Industrial and
Residential applications. The DH-98 is designed to
D uct Detector Model # DH-98-A DH-98-AR prevent the recirculation of smoke in areas by the
air handling systems, fans and blowers. Complete
Detector Head model ALG-DH
systems may be shut down in the event of smoke
Detector Head Type Analog Photoelectric detection. The HOCHIKI AMERICA DH-98-A and
Communication
the DH-98-AR operate on a DCP powered loop
DCP Powered Loop
(24 VDC source required for DH-98-AR)
DCP Powered Loop DCP Powered Loop/
Input Voltage 24V DC PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
Standby Current 2mAAVG 10mA
The DH-98 is designed and built to meet all local
Alarm Current 8mA 55mA requirements, as well as the NFPA regulations re-
2 form C rated at garding duct smoke detectors. Output terminals
Alarm Contacts N/A 10A@250V AC are provided for remote accessories such as a
Sensitivity Test Method Control Panel horn, strobe, remote status indicators and reset
Power,Alarm, key switches or push buttons. Air sampling is
Remote Indication Compatibility
Alarm Horn/Piezo accomplished by two tubes which protrude into
(Refer to DH-98 Accessories)
Test the duct. An exhaust tube of one standard length
Air Velocity 300 to 4000 ft/min. (7.5") is supplied in the installation kit with the
Ambient Temperature 32°F to 120°F (0°C to 49°C)
smoke duct unit. Once the duct width has been
determined the air intake sampling tubes must be
10% to 85% Relative Humidity
Humidity ordered. Sampling tubes are supplied in three
(non-condensing)
standard lengths 3 ft., 5 ft. and 10 ft. and cut to
Housing Material 18 G.A. steel backbox, clear plastic cover
size to fit the duct.
Finish Grey Paint
Dimensions 91/8"L x 71/4"W x 21/4"H PRODUCT LISTINGS
Maximum Net Weight 3lbs. Underwriters Laboratories: S1383
CSFM #: 3240-0410:155
Sampling Tubes 3ft., 5ft. or 10ft.
FM #: 3022559
MEA Report#: 284-91-E Vol. V
Specifications subject to change without notice.
Continued on back.
The compact DH-98-AR contains 2 sets of form "C" contacts rated at 10 amps.
The pilot and alarm visual indicators, provided on the front of the DH-98-AR duct unit, signal the operating
status of the device. A manual test/ reset switch is located along side the visual indicators.
ENGINEERING SPECIFICATIONS
Air duct smoke detectors shall be HOCHIKI AMERICA DH-98 Series. The detectors shall be listed by Underwriters
Laboratories per UL 268A. The detectors shall operate at air velocities from 300 feet per minute to 4000 feet per
minute.
The duct detector housings shall be of metal construction and complete mechanical installation may be
performed without removal of detector cover. The duct detector shall not require additional filters or screens
which must be maintained. The housing shall contain a base which will accept an analog photoelectric sensor
head. Terminal connections shall be of the screw type and be a minimum of #6 screw. For installations
requiring relay function, terminals shall be provided for remote pilot, remote alarm indication, strobe/ horn and
remote key switch. For installation not requiring relay function, visual indication of alarm and power must be
provided on detector front. A manual reset switch shall be located on front of the device. All wiring must
comply with local codes and regulations.
WIRING DIAGRAMS
ALG-DH ANALOG
DH-98-A SENSOR
1 2 3 4
Note ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○
+ -
REMOTE
ADDRESSABLE ALARM
LOOP LED
+
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
- +
C C
REMOTE
NC NO NC NO
PILOT LED ALARM CONTACTS ALARM CONTACTS
10.0A @ 250VAC 10.0A @ 250VAC
S (+)
TO NEXT SENSOR
ANALOG ADDRESSABLE
OR RETURN
SC (-) FIELD LOOP WIRING
TO CONTROL PANEL
Terminate Remote Accessories as indicated above (if required).
This is not a self-contained stand alone detector.
A U.L. Listed Analog Addressable Fire System is required.
Hochiki America Corporation DH-98 ANALOG DUCT DETECTOR Specifications subject to change without notice.
DIMM - DUAL INPUT MONITOR MODULE
SPECIFICATIONS
DESCRIPTION
STANDARD FEATURES
The Hochiki Dual Monitor Module (DIMM) is designed
• Fast, reliable contact monitoring utilizing the for use on the FireNET analog addressable system.
Hochiki DCP (Digital Communications Protocol) It provides two independent contact monitoring cir-
• 127 devices can be used per DCP loop cuits while only utilizing one address on the SLC loop.
• Bi-colored indicating LED provides module status Up to 127 devices can be placed on a single SLC
loop. The device address is uniquely stored on an
• Dual input contact monitor
onboard EEPROM. The module can be programmed
• Can be programmed to monitor Normally Open to monitor Normally Open (NO) or Normally Closed
(NO) or Normally Closed (NC) contacts (NC) contact fire alarm and supervisory devices. The
• Operates on Class A or Class B SLC loop interrupt driven Digital Communication Protocol (DCP)
• Accepts up to 14 AWG wire combines maximum communication reliability and
• Mounts to 4" square gang box fast response to emergency conditions. The module
has a single bi-colored LED to indicate device sta-
tus. It fits into a standard 4" square or double gang
electrical back box.
PRODUCT LISTINGS
Underwriters Laboratories: S5694
CSFM #: 7300-0410:150
The compact DH-98 contains 3 sets of alarm contacts, 1 set of form “C” contacts rated at 10 amps, 1 set of
form “A” contacts rated at 10 amps, 1 set of form “A” contacts rated at 1 amp. There is also 1 set of form “C”
10 amp trouble contacts for monitoring detector head removal, and the failure of the input supply voltage.
The pilot and alarm visual indicators provided on the front of the DH-98 duct unit, signal the operating status of
the device. A manual test/reset switch is located along side the visual indicators. This switch can be defeated
by cutting a jumper on the PCB.
ENGINEERING SPECIFICATIONS
Air duct smoke detectors shall be HOCHIKI AMERICA DH-98 Series. The detectors shall be listed by
Underwriters Laboratories per UL 268A. The detectors shall operate at air velocities from 300 feet per minute to
4000 feet per minute.
The duct detector housings shall be of metal construction and complete mechanical installation may be
performed without removal of detector cover. Visual indication of alarm and power must be provided on detector
front. A manual reset switch shall be located on front of the device. Detector heads shall not require additional
filters or screens which must be maintained. The housing shall contain a detector base which will accept
photoelectric or ionization detector heads. Terminal connections shall be of the screw type and be a minimum
of # 6 screw. Terminals shall be provided for remote pilot, remote alarm indication, strobe/horn and remote key
switch. All wiring must comply with local codes and regulations.
WIRING DIAGRAMS
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
24 VDC 60 Hz INPUT
24 VAC 60 Hz INPUT @ 0.1 AMP MAX.(Detector only).
@ 0.1 AMP MAX.(Detector only). UP TO 1.9 AMPS FOR AUXILIARY
UP TO 1.9 AMPS FOR AUXILIARY OUTPUTS (HORNS/STROBES).
OUTPUTS (HORNS/STROBES).
- +
1 2 3 4 5 6 1 2 3 4 5 6
DH-98-I DH-98-I
DH-98-P DH-98-P
24 V.A.C. OPERATION 24 V.D.C. OPERATION
G N H G N H
1 2 3 4 5 6 1 2 3 4 5 6
DH-98-I DH-98-HVI
DH-98-P DH-98-HVP
115 V.A.C. OPERATION 230 V.A.C. OPERATION
Hochiki America Corporation • DH-98 Conventional Specifications subject to change without notice.
FireNET™4127 - ANALOG ADDRESSABLE FIRE ALARM CONTROL PANEL
STANDARD FEATURES
Analog design using Hochiki’s advanced DCP
protocol for fast communication.
Up to 127 sensors & modules, plus 127 analog
sounder bases, for a total of 254 points possible per
loop.
Uses standard wire-no shielded or twisted pair
required on SLC loops.
Supports Class B (style 4) and Class A (style 6 or 7)
configuration for SLC loops.
Programmable sensitivity levels by device.
Alarm Verification.
Automatic daily calibration & drift compensation
routine.
Large 8-line x 40-character LCD display (320 charac-
ters total).
2 or 4 loop versions.
DESCRIPTION RS-485 bus for panel network.
Built-in RS-232 interface for programming via a PC.
The FireNET™ 4127 control panel is an analog Five on board Form C relays rated at 1 amp at
addressable fire alarm panel containing 2 or 4 SLC 30VDC (Fire1, Fire2, trouble, supervisory, aux.).
loops with each loop supporting 127 devices of any 500mA of auxiliary power available rated at 24 VDC.
combination (sensors or modules), and 127 analog Loop Explorer Windows® configuration utility.
sounder bases, for a possible total of 254 points. Auto-Learn feature.
Communication between devices is transferred *500 network wide software zones.
through standard cable (shielded or twisted pair is (*Output zones allocated to zones 1-253 only for
not required). Each panel includes a 4-amp power older SOM).
supply and has 4 on board NAC circuits. An RS-485 Network Capability of up to 64 panels.
bus provides communication to the panel network, Built in help and alarm information screens.
while the RS-232 interface allows the convenience of 4 onboard Class B (style Y) NAC circuits rated at
programming via a PC. The system will support a 2.5 amp each.
variety of Hochiki devices: photo, ion and heat Automatic day/night sensitivity modes.
sensors, which contain a unique, patented sensor Fire drill test function.
design incorporating automatic drift compensation Walk test function.
and day/night sensitivity mode. Additional devices Expandable up to 4 SLC Loops (800
include contact monitors, relay controllers, super- addresses+sub-addresses Max.).
vised auxiliary output and short circuit isolator Powerful & versatile Cause & Effect wizard
modules. In addition, interfaces to conventional including:
detection systems can be established by using a *Cause & effect action
conventional zone-monitoring module. The Loop *Disable function configuration
Explorer Windows® Software interface provides the *Test mode configuration
installer with fingertip access to installation program-
PRODUCT LISTINGS
ming and diagnostic tools. An Auto Learn feature
UL 864, Local Signaling Unit. S8255
offers the convenience for quick start applications.
Types: Automatic, manual, waterflow and sprinkler supervisory
Add to this a reputation for high quality and dedicated NFPA 72 Compliant
service makes this an exceptional product both in FM#: 3022559 (Fire Protection, Chapter 14, Local Protective
performance and value. Signaling)
Specifications subject to change without notice. CSFM: 7165-0410:159
Continued on back.
SPECIFICATIONS
Primary AC: 120VAC @ 2 amps 60hz (Optional 220VAC)
Output DC: 24VDC @ 4 amps
Power Supply: 4 amp integrated
Charger Current: 1.5 amps max.
Dimensions: 14.5"W x 24" H x 5"D
Weight: 31 lbs (without batteries)
Color: Red (optional charcoal)
Material: ABS/steel enclosure
Display: 8 line x 40 character LCD (320 characters total)
Network: Dual RS485 ports (64 panels max.)
Zones: 500 network wide software zones per system (Output zones 1 to 253 only for SOM 2.0 & earlier)
SLC loops: 2 or 4 (class A or B)
Devices per loop: 127 sensors & modules, plus 127 analog sounder bases, 254 total
(800 addresses+sub-addresses max. per panel)
NAC Outputs: (4) 2.5 amp@24VDC (class B)
Relay Outputs: (5) Form C 1amp@30VDC
Voltage Outputs: (3) 500mA@24VDC
Aux. Power: 500mA@24VDC
Aux. Inputs: (8) digital pull downs
PC Port: RS232
Printer Port: RS232
The Series 1000 Microprocessor Based Fire Alarm The following modules have been designed to adapt the
System can be configured to meet virtually any system to suit the particular requirements of a building.
requirements. To facilitate this flexibility, the panel has
a number of add-on modules which allow the system to
perform certain functions.
HRM-1008
EIGHT RELAY CIRCUIT MODULE
HPR-100
POLARITY REVERSAL & CITY TIE MODULE
Continued on back.
PRODUCT LISTINGS
Underwriters Laboratories: S6468
CSFM #: 7165-0410:154
Specifications subject to change without notice.
HDACT-100U
UNIVERSAL DIGITAL ALARM COMMUNICA-
TOR TRANSMITTER/DIALER MODULE
Hochiki America Corporation • HCP-1000 Auxiliary Modules Specifications subject to change without notice.
HCP-1008E FIRE ALARM CONTROL PANEL
DESCRIPTION
Hochiki’s HCP-1008E Fire Alarm Control Panel is a
microprocessor based unit designed for maximum
flexibility and easy installation. Fully configurable from
the front panel using the push buttons and DIP switches,
it enables the user to configure the system to meet their
specific requirements.
The HCP-1008E consists of one HMCC-1024-6 main
Chassis in an HBB-1024 Enclosure. The HMCC1024-6
main Chassis comes complete with 8 Class B (Style B)
initiating circuits which may be configured as 4 Class A
(Style D) circuits. It can be expanded up to 24 Class B
or 12 Class A circuits with the addition of two HDM-1008
Initiating Circuit Modules. In addition it comes equipped
with 4 Class A/B (Style Z/Y) indicating circuits which are
each rated at 1.7 Amps. The main Chassis also includes
a 6 amp power supply which powers the system and
supplies two 4-wire resettable regulated smoke power
STANDARD FEATURES supply of 24 VDC 200mA maximum each. The HMCC-
• 8 Class B (Style B) initiating circuits which may 1024-6 also allows for the addition of two HSGM-1004
be configured as 4 Class A (Style D) circuits. Signal Modules or two HRM-1008 Relay Modules in place
Expandable up to 24 Class B or 12 Class A of the HDM-1008 Initiating Circuit Adder Modules.
initiating circuits (Maximum of 2 adder modules and 1 communication
• 4 Class A/B (Style Z/Y) indicating circuits with module).
individual trouble indicators (1.7 Amps max. per
The cabinet is available in a beige color for the Canadian
circuit)
market and a red exterior for the U.S. and international
• Each indicating circuit can be configured as
markets. A Fire Retardant Lexan Window in the hinged
silenceable or non-silenceable. Audibles may be
door allows for viewing of the status LEDs. It comes
configured as Steady, Temporal Code, California
with a durable CAT-30 lock and key. Space is provided
Code or March Time
for up to 17 AH Gel Cell batteries.
• Each initiating circuit can be configured as alarm,
supervisory, waterflow or trouble Hochiki's HCP-1008E is designed as an economical
• Two outputs for 4 wire resettable smoke power Microprocessor Based Fire Alarm Control Panel which
supply (200 mA Max. each) is expandable up to 24 display points. Its modular design
• Alarm verification on initiating circuits suits various applications. Ideal for applications such
• Easy configuration via push buttons and DIP as small institutional and commercial buildings, shopping
switches on the front panel malls, offices and public establishments, the HCP-1008E
is configurable to meet virtually all requirements. The
SPECIFICATIONS panel is designed to be easy in its installation, operation
and maintenance. This makes the system cost effective
Primary Input Power: 120 Volts, 60 Hz, 2 Amps and very reliable for its intended applications.
(Optional 220VAC)
Indicating Current: 24VDC unfiltered, 5 Amps
Standby Power: 24VDC standby batteries PRODUCT LISTINGS
Charging Capability: 10 – 24 AH batteries Underwriters Laboratories: S6468
Dimensions: 26” H x 14 1/2” W x 4 1/2” D CSFM #: 7165-0410:154
Continued on back.
Specifications subject to change without notice.
HCP-1008ES Microprocessor Based Fire Alarm Control Panel expandable up to 24 display points.
Includes HMCC-1024-6S Main Chassis complete with 8 Class B (Style B) Initiating Circuits or 4
Class A (Style D) Initiating Circuits, 4 Class A/B (Style Z/Y) Indicating Circuits, 6 Amp Power
Supply and one HBB-1024 Red Enclosure.
Adder Modules
HDM-1008 Eight Class B (Style B) or 4 Class A (Style D) Initiating Circuit Module
HSGM-1004 Four Class A/B (Style Z/Y) Indicating Circuit Module (Rated at 1.7 Amps per circuit)
HRM-1008 Eight Relay Circuit Module comes with eight Form C relays (Rated for 28 VDC @ 1 Amp. max. per
relay)
Auxiliary Modules
HDACT-100U Universal Digital Alarm Communication Transmitter/Dialer Module
HDACT-100 Digital Alarm Communication Transmitter/Dialer Module
HPR-100 Polarity Reversal and City Tie Module
Remote Annunciators
HRAM-1032 Main Annunciator Chassis comes with Common Control Features, Indicators and 32 Bi-Colored
LEDs
HBB-1001 Annunciator backbox with keylock door
Hochiki America Corporation • HCP-1008ES Fire Alarm Control Panel Specifications subject to change without notice.
HCP 1000 SERIES
Microprocessor Based - Fire Alarm Control Panel
L NOTICE
All information, documentation, and specifications contained in this manual are subject to change
without prior notice by the manufacturer.
Page 2 of 52
10.8 CONFIGURING INITIATING AND INDICATING CIRCUITS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Page 42 of 52
10.9 CONFIGURING CIRCUIT CORRELATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Page 43 of 52
10.10 DISPLAY CONFIGURATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Page 44 of 52
APPENDIX "D" - POWER SUPPLY & BATTERY CALCULATIONS (SELECTION GUIDE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Page 51 of 52
WARRANTY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Page 52 of 52
TABLE of FIGURES
Page 3 of 52
1.0 INTRODUCTION
Introduction :
Hochiki’s SERIES HCP 1000 Fire Alarm Control Units provide a large capacity of supervised Class A or B (UL Style
D or B) Initiating Circuits, and supervised Class A or B (UL Style Z or Y) Indicating Circuits. All Circuits are supervised
for opens and ground faults, and Indicating Circuits for shorts. Optional Modules include additional Initiating and
Indicating Circuits, Relay, and Polarity Reversal & City Tie. Flush or surface mountable enclosures can be used for
retrofits and on new installations.
1.2 Controls and Indicators:8 Push-Buttons, 16 Common Indicators, provision for up to 24 Circuits
(Expansion Chassis adds provision for up to another 48 Circuits)
Page 4 of 52
2.0 GENERAL NOTES
The “S” Version Chassis’ have Slide-Switches instead of DIP Switches for Disconnects. The maximum number of each
Circuit Adder Module type is ...
Any HCP-1000 System may have a HPR-100 added, and up to eight (8) Remote Multiplex Annunciators externally.
As good practice, it is recommended that Circuit Adder Modules be installed in the order of Signals followed by
Detection, followed by Relay Modules.
Often the terms Zone and Circuit are used interchangeably, but in this Manual the term Circuit is used.
Display Points:
On the HCP-1000 an important concept is Display Points. Unlike some products the available LED Displays and
matching Circuit Disconnect Switches are not hard-wired to the Circuit Adder Modules. The Main Fire Alarm Module
and each Circuit Adder Module type have a required number of Display Points specified. In the case of Initiating Circuits
this will be reduced by half if Class “A” operation is selected. Different Main and Expander Chassis provide a fixed
number of Display Points on their attached Display Boards. These are assigned during the Configuration Adder Module
Number and Type operation (see Configuration Section) as required in the cabling order in which Adder Modules are
installed. In any system setup, there must be at least as many Display Points available, as those required by the
Circuits.
Wiring Styles:
Initiating Circuits are configured by default as Class B (Style B). They may be globally (all or none) configured as
Class A (Style D) as described in the Configuration Section. This operation uses odd and even pairs of two-wire Class
B (Style B) circuits to make one four-wire Class A (Style D) circuit, thus cutting in half the number of available Initiating
Circuits.
Indicating Circuits may be individually wired as Class A (Style Z) or Class B (Style Y) without affecting the number
of circuits available (see Module wiring instructions).
Page 5 of 52
3.0 SYSTEM COMPONENTS
Model: HFA-1024TR Flush Trim Ring Model: HECH1048 48 Display Expander Chassis
HFA-1072TR Flush Trim Ring
(add another suffix R for Red Enclosure)
Page 6 of 52
Model: HPR-100 Polarity Reversal and HRA-1000 Series Remote Multiplex
City Tie Module Annunciator Panels
Model: HMCC1024-6 Main Chassis with 8 Style B / 4 Style D Initiating Circuits, 4 Style Y or Z Indicating
Circuits, and a 6 ampere Power Supply. See Module Specifications for more detail.
Model: HMCC1024-12 Same as HMCC1024-6, but with a 12 ampere Power Supply. See Module Specifications
for more detail.
Model: HMCC1024-6S Same as HMCC1024-6, but with Disconnect Slide Switches instead of DIP Switches.
Model: HMCC1024-12SSame as HMCC1024-12, but with Disconnect Slide Switches instead of DIP Switches.
Model: HECH1048 Expander Chassis for up to 48 additional Zones / Circuits. DIP Switches for Disconnect
only. See Module Specifications for more detail.
Model: HCP-1008E Expandable Kit for the Canadian Market, 8 Class B (or 4 Class A) Initiating & 4 (Class A or
B) Indicating Circuits, Expandable to 24 Circuits, 6 Amp Power Supply (HMCC1024-6 Main
Chassis in a HBB-1024 Enclosure).
Model: HCP-1008ES Expandable Kit for the USA Market, 8 Class B (or 4 Class A) Initiating & 4 (Class A or
B) Indicating Circuits, Expandable to 24 Circuits, 6 Amp Power Supply (HMCC1024-6
Main Chassis in a HBB-1024R Enclosure).
Page 7 of 52
4.0 MECHANICAL INSTALLATION and DIMENSIONS
Install the enclosure as shown for the HBB-1024 (Fig.1) or HBB-1072 (Fig.1A) ...
1" BACKBOX
4-9/16"
DOOR
DOOR
SURFACE FLUSH
(SIDE VIEW) (SIDE VIEW)
11" 1-3/4"
17" 14-3/4"
2" TYP.
1-1/2"
10-1/2"
16"
7/32" DIA.
MOUNTING 26-1/4"
26" HOLE 28-1/2"
1-1/4"
TYP.
7-1/2"
FLUSH TRIM
4-1/2"
BACKBOX (MODEL HFA-1024TR) DOOR
Page 8 of 52
Fig.1A: HBB-1072 Flush or Surface Enclosure Installation and Dimensions
7-9/16"
1-1/4" BACKBOX
FLUSH TRIM
BACKBOX WALL WALL
SURFACE FLUSH
(SIDE VIEW) (SIDE VIEW)
1-1/8" & 7/8"
KNOCKOUTS
3-1/8"
22-1/4"
2" TYP.
16"
24-3/4"
22-13/16"
2" TYP.
1-1/2"
2"
7/32" DIA.
MOUNTING
33" 10-1/4" HOLE
35-1/2"
1-1/2" 33-1/4"
15"
2-1/2"
Page 9 of 52
4.1 MAIN CHASSIS INSTALLATION
The Main Chassis is installed in the HBB-1024 Backbox as shown using the supplied hex-nuts. Group the incoming
wires through the top of the enclosure to prepare it for wiring the Modules. Do not run the wires in-between the Modules
since it could cause a short circuit. Use a wire tie to group wires for easy identification and neatness.
Be sure to connect a solid Earth Ground (from building system ground / to a cold water pipe) to the Chassis Earth
Ground Mounting Lug, and to connect the Earth Ground Wire Lugs from the Main Chassis to the ground screw on the
Backbox.
Page 10 of 52
4.2 MAIN & EXPANDER CHASSIS INSTALLATION
The Main and Expander Chassis’ are installed into the HBB-1072 Enclosure as shown using the supplied hex-nuts.
Group the incoming wires through the top of the enclosure to prepare it for wiring the Modules. Do not run the wires in-
between the Modules since it could cause a short circuit. Use a wire tie to group wires for easy identification and
neatness.
Be sure to connect a solid Earth Ground (from building system ground / to a cold water pipe) to the Chassis Earth
Ground Mounting Lug, and to connect the Earth Ground Wire Lugs from BOTH the Main Chassis and the Expander
Chassis to the ground screw on the Backbox.
BACKBOX
EXPANDER CHASSIS
MAIN CHASSIS
TEST/CONFIG CO M M O N CO M M O N
M O DE TRO U B L E ALARM
R E M O T E CO M M O N
A . C . O N
FAILURE SUPERVISORY
BATTERY
SYSTEM L A M P TRO U B L E
RESET TEST
GROUND
FAULT
FIRE AUXILIARY
DRILL DISCONNECT
ACKNO W - BUZZER
L E D G E SILENCE
G ENERAL SIGNAL
ALARM SILENCE
1 8 1 4 1 8 1 8 1 8
CO N F I G . S I G .
DISCONNECT
Z O N E DET. ZONE
DISCONNECT
ZONE
DISCONNECT
ZONE
DISCONNECT
EARTH GROUND LUG
A.C. LINE
#8 x 1/4" TYPE `B' SCREW
CIRCUIT
BREAKER
Page 11 of 52
5.0 MODULES MOUNTING LOCATIONS
The Main Chassis’ in a HBB-1024 or HBB-1072 Enclosure come pre-assembled with all power supply, main panel, and display
components and boards. The Expander Chassis has the display board pre-assembled. The HPR-100 City Tie Module may
be added on the left side, as shown in the figure on the following page. These Modules connect directly to the dedicated P2
connection in the upper-left corner of the Main Fire Alarm Module. Circuit Adder Modules are installed from right to left using
the supplied stand-offs, as shown in the figure on the next page, with the first Module plugging its 26 pin ribbon cable into P5
on the Main Fire Alarm Module, and using the included HMD-579 four wire power cable as described in the Module Settings
section. A second Circuit Adder Module would connect by plugging its 26 pin cable into the matching socket on the previous
module to the right, and by installing the supplied HMD-579 four wire power cable as described in the appropriate Module
Settings section.
In a HBB-1072 Enclosure with an Expander Chassis, there are two each of long extension cables for the 26 pin ribbon cable
(HMD-575) and for the four wire power cable (HMD-580) included. Circuit Adder Modules are installed as on the Main Chassis,
from right to left in two tiers (back then front). These are cabled as in the Main Chassis, except that the first module on the back
tier to the right connects via HMD-575 and HMD-580 extension cables to the second module in the Main Chassis, and the fourth
module on the front tier to the right connects via HMD-575 and MD-580 extension cables to the third module on the first tier to
the left. In other words a continuous right to left, bottom to top, and back to front installation order (see the figure on the next
page).
To enable communication from the Main Fire Alarm Module to all of the Circuit Adder Modules, it is necessary to remove the
Continuity Jumper on JW6 (near P5, the Circuit Adder Module Connector) on the Main Fire Alarm Module. This jumper plug
must be installed on the Continuity Jumper on the last installed Circuit Adder Module (see the appropriate Module Settings
section to verify the location of the Continuity Jumper on a particular Circuit Adder Module). Only the LAST Circuit Adder Module
should have a jumper plug on its Continuity Jumper; all others must be left without a jumper plug !!
There needs to be enough Display Points for each circuit on an Adder Module, and these are assigned during Configuration
(see Configuration Section) in the order in which the Adders are electrically installed (the order in which they have their cables
connected to each other). Both the number of points available for each Display Type, and the number required for each Circuit
Adder Module Type are described in the Module Settings Section.
As good practice, it is recommended that Circuit Adder Modules be installed in the order of Detection followed by Signals,
followed by Relay Modules.
Page 12 of 52
Fig.4: Module Mounting Locations
EXPANDER CHASSIS
NOTES: MODEL: HECH-1048
1. FRONT PLATE IS NOT SHOWN.
2. ONLY ONE OF THE TWO MODULES, HPR-100 or
HDACT-100, CAN BE INSTALLED INTO THE MAIN
CHASSIS.
3. OTHER CIRCUIT ADDER MODULES MAY BE:
A) MODEL HDM-1008 DETECTION ADDER.
B) MODEL HSGM-1004 SIGNAL ADDER.
C) MODEL HRM-1008 RELAY ADDER.
#6-32 x 1 1/2"
#6-32 x 1 1/4" M/F HEX SPACER
SCREW
#6-32 x 1 1/4"
SCREW
#6-32 x 1 1/2"
M/F HEX SPACER
Page 13 of 52
Fig.4A: Circuit Adder Module Mounting Details
Page 14 of 52
6.0 MODULE SETTINGS
JW5 Jumper installed for Class A (Style D) operation of Initiating Circuits 1 and 2.
JW1 Jumper installed for Class A (Style D) operation of Initiating Circuits 3 and 4.
JW2 Jumper installed for Class A (Style D) operation of Initiating Circuits 5 and 6.
JW3 Jumper installed for Class A (Style D) operation of Initiating Circuits 7 and 8.
JW6 Continuity Jumper removed if there are any Circuit Adder Modules installed, and installed on the last Circuit Adder Module.
JW4 Jumper removed if a HPR-100 Module is installed.
The Main Fire Alarm Module contains the following Circuits, each requiring a certain number of Display Points ...
Note that the Main Display Module (part of the Main Chassis) has 4 dedicated Display Points for the 4 Indicating Circuits on the Main Fire
Alarm Module.
Page 15 of 52
6.2 MAIN DISPLAY MODULE (Part of Main Chassis)
The Main Display Module provides 4 dedicated Display Points for the 4 Indicating Circuits on the Main Fire Alarm Module. It also provides
the following general purpose Display Points ...
Note: The Main Display Module comes with a Label Sheet (NP-680) including both English and French slide-in labels. This sheet may be
run through a Laser Printer for labelling purposes before being installed. The first slide-in section comes in two versions; one for Single-
Stage Systems, and one for Two-Stage Systems.
Page 16 of 52
On the HMCC1024-6S and HMCC1024-12S Chassis for the USA Market only, the Main Display Module appears as
shown below. The Disconnect DIP-Switches are replaced by Slide-Switches.
Page 17 of 52
6.3 ADDER DISPLAY MODULE (Part of Expander Chassis)
The Adder Display Module provides the following general purpose Display Points ...
Note that the Adder Display Module comes with a Label Sheet (NP-681) with blank slide-in labels. This sheet may be run through a Laser
Printer for labelling purposes before being installed.
Page 18 of 52
6.4 DETECTION ADDER MODULE (Model HDM-1008)
Jumper JW6 on the Main Fire Alarm Module must be removed if there are any Adder Modules installed.
The HDM-1008 requires 8 Display Points for Style B operation, and 4 for Style D.
Page 19 of 52
6.6 RELAY ADDER MODULE (Model HRM-1008)
Page 20 of 52
6.8 POLARITY REVERSAL and CITY TIE MODULE (MODEL: HPR-100)
Jumper JW4 on the Main Fire Alarm Module must be removed if a City Tie Module is installed.
Page 21 of 52
7.0 FIELD WIRING
Wire devices to terminals as shown. See wiring tables and Appendix A for compatible devices and Appendix C for specifications.
Caution: Do not exceed power supply ratings: Main Chassis HMCC1024-6(S), total current for Indicating Circuits is 5 A max.
Main Chassis HMCC1024-12S), total current for Indicating Circuits is 10 A max.
Note: The Terminal Blocks are “removable” for ease of wiring.
Page 22 of 52
Note: All Initiating Circuits are Compatibility ID “A”.
Page 23 of 52
7.2 DETECTION MODULE (HDM-1008) TERMINAL CONNECTIONS
Wire devices to terminals as shown. See wiring tables and appendix "A" for compatible devices. See appendix "C" for Module
specifications.
Page 24 of 52
7.3 SIGNAL MODULE (HSGM-1004) TERMINAL CONNECTIONS
Wire devices to terminals as shown. See wiring tables and appendix "A" for compatible devices. See appendix "C" for Module
specifications.
Page 25 of 52
7.4 RELAY MODULE (HRM-1008) TERMINAL CONNECTIONS
Wire devices to terminals as shown. See wiring tables and appendix "A" for compatible devices. See appendix "C" for Module
specifications.
Page 26 of 52
7.5 Reserved for Future Use
7.6 POLARITY REVERSAL and CITY TIE MODULE (MODEL: HPR-100) TERMINAL CONNECTIONS
See Appendix for Module specifications. Wire as shown using proper wire gauges.
Note that for use in the USA, the installer MUST add an Atlantic Scientific (Tel. 407-725-8000) Model #24544 Protective
Device, or similar UL-Listed QVRG Secondary Protector, as shown. For use in Canada, the Protective Device is still
recommended, but the HPR-100 may be connected directly to Polarity Reversal or City Tie wiring.
Notes: 1) Either the HPR-100’s City Tie or Polarity Reversal interface may be used, but not both.
2) The City Tie interface is Not Power Limited.
3) The Terminal Blocks are “removable” for ease of wiring.
Page 27 of 52
7.7 POWER SUPPLY CONNECTIONS
The power supply is part of the Main Chassis. The ratings are:
See Appendix for specifications. Wire as shown using proper wire gauges.
Page 28 of 52
7.8 WIRING TABLES & INFORMATION
(AWG) ft m
22 2990 910
20 4760 1450
18 7560 2300
16 12000 3600
14 19000 5800
12 30400 9200
Amperes ft m ft m ft m ft m Ohms
AUXILIARY POWER WIRING: Use the Wiring Table for Indicating Circuits, and see the wiring information for the
Remote Annunciator being used.
RS-485 WIRING: See the wiring information for the Remote Annunciator being used.
4-WIRE SMOKE WIRING: The maximum allowable current is 0.2 Amperes. The maximum allowed Voltage Drop
is 1 Volt. Refer to the Indicating Circuit Wiring Table above.
Page 29 of 52
8.0 SYSTEM CHECKOUT
1. To prevent sparking, do not connect the batteries. Connect the batteries after powering the system from the main
AC supply.
2. Check that all Modules are installed in the proper location with the proper connections.
3. Check all field (external) wiring for opens, shorts, and ground.
4. Check that all interconnection cables are secure, and that all connectors are plugged-in properly.
6. Check all Jumpers and Switches for proper setting.
7. Check the AC power wiring for proper connection.
8. Check that the chassis is connected to EARTH GROUND (cold water pipe).
9. Make sure to close the front cover plate before powering the system from main AC supply.
1. After completing the System Checkout procedures, power-up the panel. The "AC-ON" green LED should illuminate,
the “Common Trouble” LED should illuminate, and the buzzer should sound. Press the white “System Reset” button.
2. Since the batteries are not connected, the "Battery Trouble" LED should illuminate as well as the trouble buzzer
should sound intermittently and the common trouble LED should flash.
3. Connect the batteries while observing correct polarity; the red wire is positive (+) and black wire is negative (-).
4. All indicators should extinguish except for normal power "AC-ON" green LED.
5. Configure the Fire Alarm Control Panel as described in the Configuration section.
8.3 TROUBLESHOOTING:
Circuit Trouble Normally when a Circuit trouble occurs, its designated trouble indicator will be illuminated, as
well as the common trouble indicator and trouble buzzer. To correct the fault, check for open
wiring on that particular Circuit loop or if the Circuit Disconnect Switch is in the on or closed
position. Please note: Disconnecting a Circuit will cause a system trouble (off-normal
position).
Remote Fail A Remote Fail will be indicated on the main panel display for any failure reported by, or failure
to communicate with a Remote Annunciator or other Remote Device.
Ground Fault This panel has a common ground fault detector. To correct the fault, check for any external
wiring touching the chassis or other Earth Ground connection.
Battery Trouble Check for the presence of batteries and their conditions. Low voltage (below 20.4V) will cause
a battery trouble. If battery trouble condition persists, replace batteries as soon as possible.
Config. Mode If the Test/Config Mode LED is illuminated steady, the system is in either Configuration Mode
or Walk-Test Mode. If it is flashing then the Configuration has been corrupted, and has been
reset to defaults; it is then necessary to review / re-enter your Configuration.
Common Trouble If only a common trouble is indicated on the main panel and none of those above confirming
trouble indicators are on, then check the following for possible fault:
i) Check for any missing interconnection wiring.
ii) Check for any Module missing that was part of the Configuration.
iii) Check jumpers positions; particularly ensure that the Continuity Jumper is installed only
on the LAST Circuit Adder Module in the system.
iv) Check for improperly secured cabling.
Page 30 of 52
9.0 INDICATORS, CONTROLS, & OPERATION
Refer to the following LED Indicators and Control Buttons and Switches locations ...
The Main Display Panel on the Fire Alarm Control Unit consists of ...
An Adder Display Module is part of the HECH1048 Expander Chassis, which adds ...
LED Indicators may be Amber, Red, or Green, and may illuminate continuously (steady), or at one of two Flash Rates...
Fast Flash - 120 flashes per minute, 50% duty cycle
Trouble Flash - 20 flashes per minute, 50% duty cycle
Note that each display is supplied with Laser Printer printable paper labels for sliding into the plastic Label Template.
For the Main Display, the paper label is #NP-68O; this includes English and French versions, and for the first column
there are two slide-ins for Single-Stage and Two-Stage operation. For the Adder Display, the paper label is #NP-681,
which are all blank.
Page 31 of 52
9.1 COMMON INDICATORS:
Buzzer:
The Buzzer is activated by any of the following ...
If the Buzzer is turned on in response to a Non-Latching Trouble or Supervisory, it will be turned off if the condition causing it goes away
and there is no other reason for it to be on.
AC On LED:
The AC On Indicator is activated steady green while the main AC power is within acceptable levels. It is turned off when the level falls
below the power-fail threshold and the panel is switched to standby (battery) power.
Acknowledge LED:
If the Panel is configured as Two Stage, the Acknowledge Indicator flashes amber at the Fast Flash Rate while the Auto General Alarm
Timer is timing out. It turns on steady amber when that Timer is cancelled by activating the Acknowledge or Signal Silence buttons. If the
Auto General Alarm Timer times-out and puts the Panel into General Alarm, the Indicator is turned off.
Page 32 of 52
9.2 COMMON CONTROLS:
There is one pair of Circuit Status LED’s for each Initiating, Indicating, and Relay Circuit. For the first four Indicating
Circuits on the Main Fire Alarm Module, these are part of the Common Indicators. For all other Circuits (including
the first eight Initiating Circuits on the Main Fire Alarm Module) these are arranged in columns of eight indicators
numbered from 1 to 8 - top to bottom. For each Circuit, the upper Circuit Status LED may be Red or Amber, and
will be steady, or flashing at either the Fast Flash or Trouble Flash Rates depending on the operation. The Circuit
Trouble LED is only Amber and in general flashes at the Trouble Rate when active. The Status LED is used on
Initiating Circuits only.
After the first eight Initiating Circuits (corresponding to the first column of Circuit LED’s) the Circuit LED’s are
configured in the same order as any Adder Modules. If there are insufficient Display Adders for the number of
Circuits on the Panel, the last Circuits will not be displayed. If there are too many Displays for the number of
Circuits on the Panel, the unassigned ones will be unused.
Page 33 of 52
or if the Circuit is Disconnected. It is always turned off when the Circuit is in Alarm. The Circuit Status Indicator is activated steady red
when the Circuit is in Alarm. On Verified Alarm Circuits, Sprinkler Alarm, and Water-flow Alarm Circuits, the Circuit Status Indicator will
illuminate at the Fast Flash rate during the "Pre-Alarm" Condition. This Indicator will also come on Fast Flash while an active circuit is being
un-disconnected.
Circuit (Zone) Disconnect Switches are provided for all Initiating, Indicating, and Relay Circuits on the Fire Alarm Control
Panel. For the first four Indicating Circuits on the Main Fire Alarm Module, the Disconnect Switches consist of either
a bank of DIP Switches, or Slide Switches in “S” Version Chassis’. For DIP Switches, numbers 1 to 8 correspond to
the Circuits indicated in the Indicator column from top to bottom.
Changing a Circuit Disconnect Switch to the on position bypasses the associated Circuit and turns on its Trouble
Indicator, also activating Common Trouble. While a Circuit is Disconnected, all changes in status (Alarms and Troubles)
on that Circuit are ignored. Disconnected Indicating Circuits are not activated by the Panel.
Disconnecting an active latching Initiating Circuit including Alarms, Water-flow Alarm, Sprinkler Alarm, General Alarm,
and Latching Supervisory does not affect its status until the Panel is reset. Disconnecting an active Non-Latching
Initiating Circuit including Non-Latching Supervisory, and Trouble-Only causes them to behave as if the alarm had gone
away. Disconnecting an active Indicating Circuit immediately deactivates the Circuit.
When an Initiating Circuit Disconnect Switch is returned to the normal state, the state of the Circuit is checked. If the
Circuit is active, the Status Indicator flashes for 10 seconds at the Fast Rate without processing the input. If the Circuit
is not re-Disconnected by then, it will be processed as a new input.
These Disconnected Switches are also used during Configuration Mode and Walk-Test as described in those
sections.
In a Single Stage System all Alarm inputs are treated in a similar manner. Alarm inputs include any of the following:
Non-Verified Alarm, Verified Alarm, Sprinkler Alarm, Water-flow Alarm, and General Alarm Circuits. Any of these Alarm
inputs occurring when the Panel is not already in Alarm cause the following:
Page 34 of 52
Ž The Common Alarm Relay activates if Aux Disconnect is not active
Ž The Auto Signal Silence Timer, if configured, starts
Ž The Signal Silence Inhibit Timer, if configured, starts
Ž All non-Disconnected Relays programmed to the input are activated provided that Aux Disconnect is not active
Ž Non-Disconnected Strobes associated with the input are activated
Ž Non-Disconnected Signals associated with the input are activated at the evacuation rate
Subsequent Alarms when the Panel is already in Alarm, cause the following:
In a Two Stage System Alarm inputs are either First Stage (Alert) inputs or Second Stage (General Alarm) inputs. First
Stage inputs include inputs from the following types of circuits: Non-Verified Alarm, Verified Alarm, Sprinkler Alarm, and
Water-flow Alarm. Second Stage inputs include Alarms on General Alarm Circuits, activation of the General Alarm
button, or expiration of the Auto General Alarm Timer. Any of these alarm inputs occurring when the Panel is not
already in alarm cause the following:
If the alarm is a Second Stage alarm all non-Disconnected Strobe Circuits are activated continuously, all non-
Disconnected Signal Circuits are activated at the evacuation rate, and the General Alarm indicator is turned on. If the
alarm is a First Stage alarm, non-Disconnected Strobe Circuits programmed to that circuit are activated continuously,
non-Disconnected Signal Circuits programmed to that circuit are activated with the Alert Code (see Indicating Circuit
Types, in following section) and the Auto General Alarm Timer, if configured, starts, and the Acknowledge Indicator
starts flashing. Subsequent First Stage alarms when the Panel is already in Alarm, cause the following:
A Second Stage Alarm (General Alarm) when the Panel is already in Alarm causes the following:
Alarm inputs are latching: they remain active until system reset. Note that if the System is configured for Correlations,
any Second Stage / General Alarm (caused by the Auto General Alarm Timer, the General Alarm button on the Front
Panel or Remote Annunciator, or by a General Alarm Initiating Circuit) condition activates ALL Indicating Circuits
whether they are Correlated or not.
Page 35 of 52
9.7 CIRCUIT TYPES:
“Circuits” refers to an actual electrical interface, either Initiating (Detection) or Indicating (Signal). “Zone” is a logical
concept for a Fire Alarm Protected Area, and will consist of at least one Circuit. Often the terms Zone and Circuit are
used interchangeably, but in this Manual the term Circuit is used.
Page 36 of 52
10.0 SYSTEM CONFIGURATION
Configuration of the HCP Series 1000 Fire Alarm Control Panel is performed by a combination of Configuration DIP
Switch settings and button presses. Circuit (Zone) related operations are correlated to their respective Disconnect
Switches.
The Configuration DIP Switches are accessible from the Main Display Module after removing a protective lexan cover
with two screws, and are labeled as CONFIG. 1 to 8. The Circuit (Zone) Disconnect Switches are re-defined as Circuit
(Zone) Select during Configuration. Caution should be used to reset the Zone Disconnect Switches back to the desired
settings before exiting configuration mode. Normal system operation is suspended while Configuration Mode is
active. Configuration Mode is entered whenever any of the Configuration DIP Switches are set as per functions listed
in the Configuration DIP Switch Function Table and exited by turning them all OFF (put switches in the bottom
or OFF positions), then performing a SYSTEM RESET !
WHILE IN CONFIGURATION MODE THE FIRE ALARM CONTROL PANEL IS NOT OPERATING !!
Three buttons and LED indicators are re-defined in Configuration Mode ...
Acknowledge (referred to as the Yellow Button): This becomes a “Select Setting” button and the LED
indicator may show current status of a function.
General Alarm (referred to as the Red Button): This becomes a “Confirmation” button for some
functions, used together with the Yellow Button.
Buzzer Silence (Blue Button): This button performs its normal function of silencing the
buzzer.
Page 37 of 52
DIP SWITCH FUNCTION BUTTON CONFIGURATION DIP-SWITCH FUNCTION TABLE
POSITION (1-8) NUMBER OPERATIONS DESCRIPTION
0000 0111 07 Yellow Waterflow Alarm and Sprinkler Alarm Retard Operation
0010 0000 20 Yellow Normal (Non-Verified) Alarm INITIATING CIRCUITS / DETECTION ZONES
0100 0000 40 Yellow & Red Set Circuit Adder Module Number & Type RESIZE SYSTEM
Page 38 of 52
10.2 ENTERING CONFIGURATION MODE:
The System enters Configuration Mode whenever any of the Configuration DIP Switches 2 to 8 (Switch 1 is used
to enter Walk-Test Mode) are set to a “1" or On position (top position). The TEST / CONFIG MODE and COMMON
TROUBLE LED’s will turn on, and the buzzer will sound. The Buzzer may be silenced at this point.
The Fire Alarm Control Panel is not operating as a Fire Alarm System while in Configuration Mode !!
If there is no activity (no buttons pressed or switches changed) for one hour, the System will return to normal operation,
but will remain in trouble.
As Configuration DIP Switches are changed to select different functions, wait for a few seconds for the appropriate
LED’s to change as the System recognizes the change. Note that Configuration changes take effect immediately as
they are made; there is no “undo” function.
To exit Configuration Mode, after all desired changes are made, all Configuration DIP Switches must be returned to
a “0" or Off position (bottom position). Wait about five seconds, then press the white System Reset button. The System
should now be back in Normal Operation.
The system as shipped from the factory is configured with no Adder Modules, and with certain set defaults. The
Default settings are ...
! All Initiating Circuits are Style B (Class B) Non-Verified Alarms (any Alarm on any initiating circuit activates
all indicating circuits)
! Indicating Circuits are all Common Alarm and set as Silenceable, Temporal Code.
! Manual Signal Silence is enabled
! Two Stage disabled (System will operate Single Stage)
! Water-flow Retard Operation is disabled
! Aux Disconnect will disconnect correlated relays
! Auto Signal Silence Timer is disabled.
! Systems assumes there are no Remote Annunciators
! All Relay correlation is set to Common Alarm activation.
! Fire Drill is enabled
! Relay Adder(s) activate on Common Alarm
! Signal Silence Inhibit Timer is disabled
! Auto General Alarm Timer is disabled
! System assumes there are no Adder Modules
Page 39 of 52
10.5 RESTORE TO DEFAULT / RESIZE (CLASS A or B):
Restoring the System to the Default Configuration is performed whenever it is desirable to restore the Factory Default
Configuration, and also whenever Circuit Adder Modules (Detection, Signal, or Relay) are added, removed, or re-
arranged. Restoring the System to the Default Configuration is performed slightly differently depending on whether the
System is intended to operate with Style B (Class B) or Style D (Class A) Initiating Circuits (Detection Zones). It must
also be remembered to set the Main Fire Alarm Board and Detection Adder Module jumpers for the appropriate
Style / Class (see Module Settings), and that the Style / Class setting is global - for ALL Initiating Circuits.
& Set Config DIP Switch to 0111 1111 (Restore Defaults). & Set Config DIP Switch to 0111 1111 (Restore Defaults).
& Wait 5 seconds. & Wait 5 seconds.
& Press Yellow & Red Buttons together for 1 second. & Press Yellow & Red Buttons together for 1 second.
& Wait 5 seconds. & Wait 5 seconds.
& Set Config DIP Switch to 0000 0001 (Select Style / Class). & Set Config DIP Switch to 0000 0001 (Select Style / Class).
& Wait 5 seconds. & Wait 5 seconds.
& Press Yellow Button till Yellow LED is off. & Press Yellow Button till Yellow LED is on.
& Set Config DIP Switch to 0100 0000 (Resize System *). & Set Config DIP Switch to 0100 0000 (Resize System *).
& Wait 5 seconds. & Wait 5 seconds.
& Press Yellow & Red Buttons together for 1 second. & Press Yellow & Red Buttons together for 1 second.
& Wait 10 seconds. & Wait 10 seconds.
Note that the HFA-1012K can be configured as Style B / Class B only ! The System is now ready for further
Configuration, or Configuration Mode may be exited if the Default Settings are acceptable.
10.6 RESIZE SYSTEM (SET CIRCUIT ADDER MODULE NUMBER & TYPE):
Resizing the System without performing a full Restore to Defaults may be done if the only change is adding an Adder
Display Module, or adding a Circuit Module. It should not be performed other than as part of a full Restore to
Defaults, if Circuit Modules are removed, or inserted between existing Modules, otherwise Circuit specific Configuration
may be mis-assigned.
For Circuit Adder Modules added after existing Modules, to Resize ...
& Set Config DIP Switch to 0100 0000 (Resize System *).
& Wait 5 seconds.
& Press Yellow & Red Buttons together for 1 second.
& Wait 10 seconds.
The System is now ready for further Configuration, or Configuration Mode may be exited if the Default Settings for the
added Modules are acceptable.
* During the Resize (Set Circuit Adder Module Number & Type) part of the operation, the Yellow LED flashes to
indicate how many Adder Display Modules (in addition to the Main Display Module) and Circuit Adder Modules
(including the main board) are found. The Yellow LED flashes for the number of Adder Display Modules first,
followed by the number of Circuit Adder Modules. If no Circuit Adder Modules are found the LED flashes once for
the main board, if one Circuit Adder Module is found it flashes twice, etc. For example if the system has one
Adder Display Module and two Circuit Adder Modules, the Yellow LED will flash two times (once for the Main
Display Module and once for the Adder Display Module), pause, flash three times (once for the main board and once
for each of the adder modules), long pause and repeat.
Note: The Yellow LED indicates how many Adders (plus the main board) are found, not how many the System
is Configured to accept. If the number of Adders found is different from the number the System is
Configured for, the system will be in trouble.
Page 40 of 52
10.7 CONFIGURING FEATURES:
There are two types of Features; those which are just turned ON and OFF, and those with Multiple Settings. For ON
and OFF Features, the Yellow LED is lit for ON, and not lit for OFF, and the Yellow Button is pressed to change the
ON / OFF setting. For Multiple Setting Features, the Yellow LED flashes a number of times to indicate the setting,
then pauses; the Yellow Button is used to change the selected setting. Be sure to pause for about 3 seconds after
changing the Configuration DIP Switches, or pressing the Yellow Button to see the results.
0000 0001 Style D/B (Class A/B) Initiating Circuits Yellow LED lit indicates that all Initiating Circuits (Detection
Zones) are Style D (Class A), off indicates that they are all
Style B (Class B). This Feature can be checked at any time, but
must only be changed as described in Restore to Default.
0000 0010 Manual Signal Silence Enable Yellow LED lit indicates that Manual Silence is enabled.
0000 0011 Fire Drill Enable Yellow LED lit indicates that Fire Drill is enabled.
0000 0100 Two Stage Operation Enabled Yellow LED lit indicates that the System is set for Two Stage
operation, and not lit indicates Single Stage operation.
0000 0101 Common Alarm Relay Operation Yellow LED lit indicates that if the System is for Two Stage
operation, the Common Alarm Relay will only operate during the
General Alarm Stage. If not lit, the Common Alarm Relay will
operate during both Stages.
0000 0110 Output Circuit Correlations Enabled Yellow LED lit indicates that Output Circuits (Indicating Circuits
and Relays) operate according to any set Correlations (see
Correlation section). If the Yellow LED is not lit, all Output
Circuits are Common Alarm; all outputs turn on for any Alarm
Input.
0000 0111 Waterflow & Sprinkler Retard Operation Yellow LED lit indicates that Waterflow Retard is enabled.
0000 1001 Aux Disc & Programmable Relays Yellow LED lit indicates that Correlated Relays are
disconnected by Auxiliary Disconnect.
0011 1000 Show Relay Circuits All Display Points assigned to Relay Circuits will be lit.
0000 1010 Signal Silence Inhibit Timer Yellow LED does not flash = Disabled
Yellow LED flashes 1 time = 1 minute
Yellow LED flashes 2 times = 2 minutes
Yellow LED flashes 3 times = 3 minutes
0000 1011 Auto Signal Silence Timer Yellow LED does not flash = Disabled
(This timer cannot be set shorter than either Yellow LED flashes 1 time = 5 minute
the Auto General Alarm or Signal Silence Yellow LED flashes 2 times = 10 minutes
Inhibit timers, if those timers are enabled) Yellow LED flashes 3 times = 15 minutes
Yellow LED flashes 4 times = 20 minutes
Yellow LED flashes 5 times = 30 minutes
0000 1100 Auto General Alarm Timer Yellow LED does not flash = Disabled
(Leave disabled unless the System is Yellow LED flashes 1 time = 5 minute
configured for Two Stage operation) Yellow LED flashes 2 times = 10 minutes
Yellow LED flashes 3 times = 15 minutes
Yellow LED flashes 4 times = 20 minutes
Yellow LED flashes 5 times = 30 minutes
Page 41 of 52
0000 1101 Audible Indicating Circuit Yellow LED flashes 1 time = Continuous
Evacuation Code Yellow LED flashes 2 times = March Time
Yellow LED flashes 3 times = Temporal Code
Yellow LED flashes 4 times = California Code
0000 1110 Number of Remote Annunciators Yellow LED flashes 0 to 8 times to indicate the number of
Remote Annunciators expected by the System.
10.8 CONFIGURING INITIATING AND INDICATING CIRCUITS:
Initiating Circuits (Detection Zones) and Indicating Circuits (Signal Zones) are Configured by using the
Configuration DIP Switches to select the desired Circuit Type Function, along with the Circuit Trouble LED’s and
Disconnect Switches. When a Circuit Type is selected by the Configuration DIP Switch setting, the Yellow Trouble
LED for each Circuit currently configured as that type will light. To configure Circuits to be of that selected Circuit Type,
all of the desired Circuit Disconnect Switches are turned ON (up position) and the Yellow Button is pressed for about
one second. After a short pause, the Initiating Circuit Yellow Trouble LED’s will be updated to show the new
configuration.
Note: Any subsequent selection of a particular Circuit as a different Circuit Type will supercede the previous selection.
Also note that the physical Circuit Type must be appropriate for the selected Circuit Type; for example only Indicating
Circuits can be configured as Silenceable Strobes.
Be sure to reset Circuit Disconnect Switches to OFF (down position) before attempting to configure any other Circuits.
0010 0000 Normal (Non-Verified) Alarm 0011 0000 Silenceable Audible Signal
As an example, if in a System with eight Initiating Circuits and four Indicating Circuits (Main Board only), we wanted
Class B operation, the first six Initiating Circuits as normal Non-Verified Alarms, the last two as Latching Supervisories,
and the last Indicating Circuit as a Non-Silenceable Strobe, the following sequence would be used ...
Page 42 of 52
10.9 CONFIGURING CIRCUIT CORRELATIONS:
With the Factory Default Configuration, all Outputs are configured to activate with any Inputs configured as Alarms.
If Output Circuit Correlations are enabled (see the Configure Features section), Outputs must be configured to one
or more Inputs to activate at all. This configuration is referred to as a Correlation. There are two configuration options;
correlated individual Outputs to one or more Inputs, or correlating individual Inputs to one or more Outputs. Output
Circuits may be correlated to as many Input Circuits as desired, and vice-versa.
At present, only the following types of Circuit CORRELATIONS are possible ...
C Alarm Circuits (Verified or not, Sprinkler or Water-flow) to Indicating Circuits or Relays.
C General Alarm Circuits to Relays (they are automatically Correlated to ALL Indicating Circuits).
C Supervisory Circuits (Latching or not) to Relays.
C Monitor Circuits to Relays.
C Trouble-Only Circuits to Relays.
IMPORTANT: The Feature Output Circuit Correlations Enabled must be ON for Indicating Circuit Correlations
to operate (see the Configure Features section), otherwise all Indicating Circuits will be “Common Alarm” ; they
will all activate with any Input Circuits configured as Alarms. Relay Circuits are always Enabled for Correlations.
Also note that if the System is configured as Two-Stage, any Second Stage / General Alarm (caused by the Auto
General Alarm Timer, the General Alarm button on the Front Panel or Remote Annunciator, or by a General Alarm
Initiating Circuit) condition activates ALL Indicating Circuits whether they are Correlated or not.
Page 43 of 52
10.10 DISPLAY CONFIGURATION:
The Main and Adder Display Modules on the front panel are automatically updated to display all circuits found whenever
the function Resize - Adder Module Number & Type Configuration is performed. The Main Display Module has
dedicated Trouble LEDs for the four Indicating Circuits on the Main Fire Alarm Module. The eight Initiating Circuits (four
in Class A mode) also on the Main Fire Alarm Module are annunciated on the first column of Display Points (from top
to bottom). Any Adder Module circuits are displayed after the base system input circuits in the same order as the
Adder Modules have been installed (that is from right to left). For example, if there are two 8 Circuit Initiating Adders
and one 4 Circuit Indicating Adder, the Main Display will annunciate 24 Initiating Circuits followed by 4 Indicating
Circuits. If the Fire Alarm Control Panel is configured for Style D (Class A) Initiating Circuits, then the number of
Initiating Circuits is cut in half, so that in the example above, there will only be a total of 12 Initiating Circuits
annunciated, followed by the 4 Adder Indicating Circuits.
Refer to the Figure shown under the Indicators, Controls, & Operation section. It shows how the first 24 Circuits are
mapped to Display Points.
Any configured HRA 1000 Series Remote Annunciators automatically match the main Fire Alarm Control Panel
displays, except that there will be no annunciation of Common Alarm, Common Supervisory, Battery Trouble, Ground
Fault and 4 Signal Trouble indicators.
Page 44 of 52
11.0 WALK TEST OPERATION
Walk-Test allows an installer to verify the Initiating Circuit wiring in a system. Walk-Test is a special Configuration
Mode Function (Function 80 on the Configuration DIP Switches). Circuits to be tested are identified using the Circuit
Disconnect Switches. Activation of any Initiating Circuit which has been selected for Walk-Test will cause the Audible
Indicating Circuits (not Strobes) to activate briefly for a number of short bursts corresponding to the selected circuit
number. If the first selected Circuit is activated, the Indication Circuits will sound for one burst. If the second selected
Circuit is activated, the Indication Circuits will sound for two bursts, and so on. This means that if say Circuits 1,6,23,32
were selected for Walk-Test, they would sound with 1,2,3,4 bursts respectively. The maximum number of Circuits that
may be set at any one time for Walk-Test is 15. The burst interval is half a second on half a second off. After the
sounding pattern has been sent on the Indicating Circuits, the Initiating Circuit is reset and tested again. If it is still
active (in alarm) the pattern will be re-sent. Trouble on any Initiating Circuit selected for Walk-Test causes the Indicating
Circuits to be activated continuously for 5 seconds.
Alarm Verification and Water-flow Alarm Retard Operations are disabled on Circuits being Walk-Tested. All Circuits not
selected for Walk-Test continue to function normally. If a Circuit was Disconnected before Walk-Test mode was entered
and is not selected for Walk-Test, it remains Disconnected while Walk-Test is active. Walk-Test operation is disabled
if the Fire Alarm Control Panel is in Alarm or goes into Alarm while Walk-Test is active.
Page 45 of 52
APPENDIX "A" - COMPATIBLE DEVICES
NOTES:
Whether mixing different models of compatible smoke detectors, or using the same model on the same Circuit, total
standby current of all detectors must not exceed 3 mA.
SMOKE DETECTOR
MAKE MODEL / BASE MAKE MODEL / BASE MAKE MODEL / BASE
HOCHIKI EDWARDS FENWAL
Page 46 of 52
UNDERWRITER’S LABS INC. (UL)
UNITED STATES: 2-WIRE SMOKE DETECTOR CONTROL PANEL COMPATIBILITY
NOTES:
1) Whether mixing different models of compatible smoke detectors, or using the same model on the same Circuit, total
standby current of all detectors must not exceed 3 mA.
2). The below listed Smoke Detectors are compatible with Initiating Circuits having Compatibility Identifier "A".
Page 47 of 52
2451 / B401 A-A 0.12 mA
2451 / B401B A-A 0.12 mA NAPCO
FW-2 HD-6 55uA @ 24VDC
System Sensor -
SpecrAlert
P2415 P2415W P241575 P241575W P2475
P2475W P24110 P24110W S2415 S2415W
S241575 S241575W S2475 S2475W S24110
S24110W H12/24 H12/24W MDL MDLW
Wheelock
AS-2415W-24-FR AS-241575W-FR AS-2430W-FR AS-2475W-FR AS-24110W-FR
AS-2415C-FW AS-2430C-FW AS-2475C-FW AS-24100C-FW AH-24-R
AH-24-WP-R NS-2415W-FR NS-241575W-FR NS-2430W-FR NS-2475W-FR
NS-24110W-FR NS4-2415W-FR NS4-241575W-FR NS4-2430W-FR NS4-2475W-FR
NS4-24110W-FR RS-2415W-FR RSS-241575W-FR RSS-2415W-FR RSS-241575W-FR
RSS-2430W-FR RSS-2475W-FR RSS-24110W-FR RSS-2415C-FW RSS-2430C-FW
RSS-2475C-FW RSS-24100C-FW MT-12/24-ULC MT-24-LS-VFR-ULC MT-24-WS-VFR-ULC
AMT-12/24-R-ULC AMT-24-LS-VFR-ULC MB-G6-24-R MB-G10-24-R SM-12/24-R
DSM-12/24-R
Gentex
ST24-15 ST24-15/75 ST24-30 ST24-60 ST24-75
ST24-110
HS24-15 HS24-15/75 HS24-30 HS24-60 HS24-75
HS24-110
.
Page 48 of 52
.
HRA-1000 Series:
The HRA-1000 Series of Remote Annunciators are units with electrical Modules and Enclosures matching the configurations
of the HCP Series 1000 Fire Alarm Control Panels. For more detailed information see Hochiki Document LT-617HOC. The
Models available are ...
& HRAM-1032: Main Annunciator Chassis with Common Indicators and Controls, and 32 Circuit Capacity.
& HRAX-1048: Adder Annunciator Chassis with 48 Circuit Capacity.
& HRAM-1016: Non-Expandable Annunciator Chassis with Common Indicators and Controls, and 16 Circuit Capacity.
ENCLOSURES:
Page 49 of 52
APPENDIX "C" - MODULE SPECIFICATIONS and FEATURES
Page 50 of 52
APPENDIX "D" - POWER SUPPLY & BATTERY CALCULATIONS (SELECTION GUIDE)
Use the form below to determine the required Main Chassis and Secondary Power Supply (batteries).
IMPORTANT NOTICE
The main AC branch circuit connection for Fire Alarm Control Unit must provide a dedicated continuous power without provision of any disconnect
devices. Use #12 AWG wire with 600-volt insulation and proper over-current circuit protection that complies with the local codes. Refer to appendix
"C" for specifications.
([STANDBY (A) ______ ] X [(24 or 60 Hours) ___ ]) + ([ALARM (B) ______ ] X [%Alarm in Hr.] _____) = (C) ______AH
Main Chassis Selection: Select HMCC1024-6(S) if (B) is less than 6 Amps, HMCC1024-12S) if (B) is less than 12 Amps.
Page 51 of 52
WARRANTY
Hochiki America Corp., manufactured equipment is guaranteed to be free of defects in material and
workmanship for a period of one (1) year from the date of original shipment. Hochiki will repair or replace,
at its option, any equipment which it determines to contain defective material or workmanship. Said
equipment must be shipped to Hochiki prepaid. Return freight will be prepaid by Hochiki. We shall not be
responsible to repair or replace equipment which has been repaired by others, abused, improperly installed,
altered or otherwise misused or damaged in any way. Unless previously contracted by Hochiki, Hochiki will
assume no responsibility for determining the defective or operative status at the point of installation, and will
accept no liability beyond the repair or replacement of the product at our factory authorized service
department.
Page 52 of 52
HCP-200 AUXILIARY MODULES
GENERAL
The HCP-200 Microprocessor Based Fire Alarm System The following modules have been designed to adapt the
can be configured to meet virtually any requirements. system to suit the particular requirements of a building.
HDM-204
FOUR INITIATING CIRCUIT & TWO INDICATING
CIRCUIT MODULE
HRM-204
AUXILIARY QUAD RELAY MODULE
Continued on back.
PRODUCT LISTINGS
HPR-100
POLARITY REVERSAL & CITY TIE MODULE
HDACT-100
DIGITAL ALARM COMMUNICATOR TRANSMITTER/
DIALER MODULE
Hochiki America Corporation • HCP-200 Auxiliary Module Specifications subject to change without notice.
HCP-200 SERIES
Microprocessor Based - Fire Alarm Control Panel
L NOTICE
All information, documentation, and specifications contained in this manual are subject to change
without prior notice by the manufacturer.
Page 1 of 43
TABLE of CONTENTS
APPENDIX "D" - POWER SUPPLY & BATTERY CALCULATIONS (SELECTION GUIDE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Page 35 of 36
WARRANTY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Page 36 of 36
Page 2 of 43
TABLE of FIGURES
Page 3 of 43
1.0 INTRODUCTION
Introduction :
Hochiki's HCP-200 Fire Alarm Control Panels provide 1, 2, 4, or 8 supervised Class B (UL Style B) Initiating Circuits,
or 1, 2, 4 supervised Class A (UL Style D) Initiating Circuits, and 2 or 4 supervised Class A or B (UL Style Z or Y)
Indicating Circuits. All Circuits are supervised for opens and ground faults, and Indicating Circuits for shorts. Optional
Modules include a HDM-204 Zone Adder (required for full capacity in the HCP-204E only), a HDACT-100 Dialer or a
HPR-100 Polarity Reversal & City Tie Module, and HRM-204 or HRM-208 Relay Modules. The two enclosures are flush
or surface mountable, and can be used for retrofits and on new installations.
Page 4 of 43
2.0 GENERAL NOTES
Often the terms Zone and Circuit are used interchangeably, but in this Manual the term Circuit is used.
Wiring Styles:
Initiating Circuits are configured by default as Class B (Style B). They may be globally (all or none) configured as
Class A (Style D) as described in the Configuration Section. This operation uses odd and even pairs of two-wire Class
B (Style B) circuits to make one four-wire Class A (Style D) circuit, thus cutting in half the number of available Initiating
Circuits.
Indicating Circuits may be individually wired as Class A (Style Z) or Class B (Style Y) without affecting the number
of circuits available (see Module wiring instructions).
Page 5 of 43
3.0 SYSTEM COMPONENTS
Model: HCP-202,4 Fire Alarm Control Panel Model: HPR-100 City Tie Module
Model: HCP-204E Fire Alarm Control Panel Model: HDACT-100 Dialer Module
Model: HDM-204 Zone Adder Module Model: HRM-204 & HRM-208 4 & 8 Relay Module
Page 6 of 43
3.1 MODELS
Model: HCP-202 Small enclosure Fire Alarm Control Panel with two Class B (Style B) or one Class A (Style D) Initiating
Circuits, and 2 Power Limited Class A/B (Style Z/Y) Indicating Circuits (1.70 amperes each, 2.4 amperes
total) with individual trouble indicators. Common Alarm & Trouble Relays. Interface for Remote Trouble
Indicator. Resettable Four Wire Smoke Detector Power Supply. May have one of HDACT-100, HPR-100,
HRM-204, or HRM-208 installed. Can be used with 4 amp-hour or 6.5 amp-hour batteries (2 required).
Model: HCP-204 Small enclosure Fire Alarm Control Panel with four Class B (Style B) or two Class A (Style D) Initiating
Circuits, and 2 Power Limited Class A/B (Style Z/Y) Indicating Circuits (1.70 amperes each, 2.4 amperes
total) with individual trouble indicators. Common Alarm & Trouble Relays. Interface for Remote Trouble
Indicator and/or 1 to 3 of HRAM-208 Remote Multiplex Annunciators. Resettable Four Wire Smoke
Detector Power Supply. May have one of HDACT-100, HPR-100, HRM-204, or HRM-208 installed. Can
be used with 4 amp-hour or 6.5 amp-hour batteries (2 required).
Model: HCP-204E Large enclosure Fire Alarm Control Panel with four Class B (Style B) or two Class A (Style D) Initiating
Circuits, and 2 Power Limited Class A/B (Style Z/Y) Indicating Circuits (1.70 amperes each, 5 amperes
total) with individual trouble indicators. Common Alarm & Trouble Relays. Interface for Remote Trouble
Indicator and/or 1 to 3 of HRAM-208 Remote Multiplex Annunciators. Resettable Four Wire Smoke
Detector Power Supply. May have one of HDACT-100 or HPR-100, and one HDM-204 installed. May also
have one of HRM-204 or HRM-208 installed. Can be used with 4 amp-hour, 6.5 amp-hour, or 10 amp-
hour batteries (2 required).
Model: HDM-204 Zone Adder Module for the HCP-204E. Brings the total capacity to eight Class B (Style B) or four Class
A (Style D) Initiating Circuits, and 4 Power Limited Class A/B (Style Z/Y) Indicating Circuits (up to 1.7
amperes each, 5 amperes total).
Model: HRM-208 Relay Adder Module for the HCP-204 or HCP-204E. Adds eight configurable Form-C Relays rated 1A,
28 VDC.
Model: HRM-204 Relay Adder Module for the HCP-204 or HCP-204E. Adds four configurable Form-C Relays rated 1A, 28
VDC.
Model: HCH-429 Accessory Mounting Plate for the HCP-202, or HCP-204 if one of HRM-204, HRM-208, HPR-100, or
HDACT-100 Modules are to be used.
3.2 ACCESSORIES
Page 7 of 43
4.0 MECHANICAL INSTALLATION and DIMENSIONS
Install the enclosure as shown below for the HCP-202, or HCP-204 ...
3 -5"
3 -8" 16 BACKBOX
DOOR DOOR
SURFACE FLUSH
(SIDE VIEW) (SIDE VIEW)
BACKBOX
5
1-8"
3
DOOR 13 -4 "
1
10 -2"
5
1" 1-8" 3
1-4"
1
14 -8"
3
12 -4"
7
3 -8"
1
15 -8"
#6 x 5/16" SCREW
1"
3 -8
Page 8 of 43
Fig.2: HCP-204E Enclosure Installation and Dimensions
Page 9 of 43
5.0 MODULES MOUNTING LOCATIONS
The HCP-200 Series come pre-assembled with all components and boards, except for Adder Modules. Module installation
locations are shown below.
Be sure to connect a solid Earth Ground (from building system ground / to a cold water pipe) to the Chassis Earth Ground
Mounting Lug, and to connect the Earth Ground Wire Lugs from the Main Chassis to the ground screw on the Backbox.
NOTES:
1. RELAY MODULE MAY BE MODEL HRM-204 OR HRM-208.
2. ONLY ONE OF HPR-100 OR HDACT-100 MAY BE INSTALLED.
HDACT-100)
HPR-100)
Page 10 of 43
Fig.4: HCP-204E Module Mounting Locations
Page 11 of 43
6.0 MODULE SETTINGS
Class A / B Selection: On the HCP-202, HCP-204 and HCP-204E only, JW1 & JW2 are connected from 1 to 2 for Initiating Circuit Class
B (Style B) operation, and from 2 to 3 for Class A (Style D) operation. Only JW2 is present on the HCP-202.
Note that the Class A/B selection affects all Initiating Circuits, and must be used with the correct
Configuration DIP Switch Setting.
Zone Adder Module: On an HCP-204E only, remove the jumper on JW4 if a HDM-204 Zone Adder is installed. The Zone Adder
Module is plugged into P6 & P7.
Relay Module: Remove the jumper on JW3 if an HRM-204 or RM-208 Relay Module is installed. The Relay Module is plugged
into P1.
Digital Communicator: Remove the jumper on JW6 if a HDACT-100 Digital Communicator is installed. The Digital Communicator
is plugged into P8.
City Tie: Remove the jumper on JW6 if a PR-100 City Tie is installed. The City Tie is plugged into P8.
Battery: Connected to P2(+’ve) & P3(-’ve) via the factory installed cables.
Transformer: Factory wired to P4 & P5, do not disconnect.
JW5 There should be no jumper here; do not use.
SW9,11,13 Configuration DIP Switches.
Battery Fuse F1: Replace with 10 Amp, 1-1/4" Fast Acting Fuse
Page 12 of 43
6.2 ZONE ADDER MODULE (Model HDM-204)
Finally, there are jumpers JW1.2, JW2.3, up to JW7.8 that allow a relay to have the same control as an adjacent relay. For example, starting
with the factory default setting, moving the jumper from JW2 to JW1.2 will make both Relays 1 & 2 operate with Initiating Circuit #1.
Page 13 of 43
Page 14 of 43
6.4 DACT / DIALER MODULE (Model HDACT-100)
Page 15 of 43
7.0 FIELD WIRING
Because most of the Field Wiring on the HCP-200’s is to the Main Boards on the swinging DeadFront, it is very
important to properly dress the wires so as not to place stress on either their connection to the boards, or running to
conduit. The Figure below shows the required wiring techniques.
USE AT LEAST
3 WIRE TIES WIRE TIE
AS SUPPLIED IN 2 PLACES
THROUGH HOLES TO BACK OF
ON DEADFRONT ENCLOSURE
DRESS WIRES NEAR
TOP OF ENCLOSURE
CLEAR OF ADDER
MODULES
Page 16 of 43
7.2 MAIN FIRE ALARM MODULE TERMINAL CONNECTIONS
Wire devices to terminals as shown. See wiring tables and Appendix A for compatible devices and Appendix C for specifications.
Caution: Do not exceed power supply ratings: HCP-202, HCP-204, total current for Indicating Circuits is 2.4 A max.
HCP-204E, total current for Indicating Circuits is 5 A max.
Page 17 of 43
Fig.11A: Main Fire Alarm Module Terminal Connections (continued)
Page 18 of 43
7.3 ZONE ADDER MODULE (HDM-204) TERMINAL CONNECTIONS
Wire devices to terminals as shown. See wiring tables and appendix "A" for compatible devices. See appendix "C" for Module specifications.
Page 19 of 43
7.4 RELAY MODULE (HRM-204 or HRM-208) TERMINAL CONNECTIONS
Page 20 of 43
7.5 DACT / DIALER MODULE (HDACT-100) TERMINAL CONNECTIONS
7.6 POLARITY REVERSAL and CITY TIE MODULE (MODEL: HPR-100) TERMINAL CONNECTIONS
See Appendix for Module specifications. Wire as shown using proper wire gauges.
Note that for use in the USA, the installer MUST add an Atlantic Scientific (Tel. 407-725-8000) Model #24544 Protective Device,
or similar UL-Listed QVRG Secondary Protector, as shown. For use in Canada, the Protective Device is still recommended,
but the HPR-100 may be connected directly to Polarity Reversal and City Tie wiring.
Note: The Terminal Blocks are “depluggable” for ease of wiring.
The City Tie Interface is Not Power Limited.
Either the HPR-100’s City Tie or Reverse Polarity Interface may be used, but not both.
Fig.14: HPR-100 Polarity Reversal and City Tie Module Terminal Connections
Page 21 of 43
7.7 POWER SUPPLY CONNECTIONS
The power supply is part of the Main Fire Alarm Module and the Chassis. The ratings are:
Model HCP-204E:
Electrical input ratings: 120 VAC, 60 Hz, 2.5A (Uses a 4.0A circuit breaker)
Power supply total current: 6 A maximum
Battery Fuse on Main Module: F1: Replace with 10 Amp, 1-1/4" Fast Acting Fuse
See Appendix "C" for specifications. Wire as shown using proper wire gauges.
Page 22 of 43
7.8 WIRING TABLES
(AWG) ft m
22 2990 910
20 4760 1450
18 7560 2300
16 12000 3600
14 19000 5800
12 30400 9200
Amperes ft m ft m ft m ft m Ohms
4-WIRE SMOKE WIRING: The maximum allowable current is 0.15 Amperes. The maximum allowed Voltage
Drop is 1 Volt. Refer to the Indicating Circuit Wiring Table above.
Page 23 of 43
8.0 SYSTEM CHECKOUT
1. To prevent sparking, do not connect the batteries. Connect the batteries after powering the system from the main
AC supply.
2. Check that all Modules are installed in the proper location with the proper connections.
3. Check all field (external) wiring for opens, shorts, and ground.
4. Check that all interconnection cables are secure, and that all connectors are plugged-in properly.
6. Check all Jumpers and Switches for proper setting.
7. Check the AC power wiring for proper connection.
8. Check that the chassis is connected to EARTH GROUND (cold water pipe).
9. Make sure to close the front cover plate before powering the system from main AC supply.
1. After completing the System Checkout procedures, power-up the panel. The "AC-ON" green LED should illuminate,
the “Common Trouble” LED should illuminate, and the buzzer should sound. Press the “System Reset” button.
2. Since the batteries are not connected, the "Battery Trouble" LED should illuminate, and the buzzer should sound
intermittently and the Common Trouble LED should flash.
3. Connect the batteries while observing correct polarity; the red wire is positive (+) and black wire is negative (-).
4. All indicators should extinguish except for normal power "AC-ON" green LED.
5. Configure the Fire Alarm Control Panel as described in the Configuration section.
8.3 TROUBLESHOOTING:
Circuit Trouble Normally when a Circuit trouble occurs, its designated trouble indicator will be illuminated, as
well as the Common Trouble Indicator and the Buzzer. To correct the fault, check for open
wiring on that particular Circuit loop or if the Circuit Disconnect Switch is on. Please note:
Disconnecting a Circuit will cause a system trouble (off-normal position).
Remote Fail A Remote Trouble will be indicated on the main panel display for any failure reported by, or
failure to communicate with a Remote Annunciator, HDACT-100, or HPR-100.
Ground Fault This panel has a common ground fault detector. To correct the fault, check for any external
wiring touching the chassis or other Earth Ground connection.
Battery Trouble Check for the presence of batteries and their conditions. Low voltage (below 20.4V) will cause
a battery trouble. If battery trouble condition persists, replace batteries as soon as possible.
Page 24 of 43
9.0 INDICATORS, CONTROLS, & OPERATION
Refer to the following LED Indicators and Control Switch locations ...
Page 25 of 43
9.1 INDICATORS:
Buzzer:
The Buzzer is activated by any of the following ...
If the Buzzer is turned on in response to a Non-Latching Trouble or Supervisory, it will be turned off if the condition causing it goes away
and there is no other reason for it to be on.
AC On LED:
The AC On Indicator is activated steady green while the main AC power is within acceptable levels. It is turned off when the level falls
below the power-fail threshold and the panel is switched to standby (battery) power.
Test LED:
Indicates steady Amber when the Fire Alarm Panel is in Walk Test Mode.
Page 26 of 43
These LED’s indicate Trouble for Initiating and Indicating Circuits. They illuminate Slow Flashing Amber (20 flashes per minute) for any field
wiring fault, or if the circuit has been Disconnected.
Page 27 of 43
9.2 CONTROLS:
9.3 OPERATION:
All Alarm inputs are treated in a similar manner. Alarm inputs include Non-Verified or Verified Alarms, and Water-flow
Alarms. Any of these Alarm inputs occurring when the Panel is not already in Alarm cause the following:
Subsequent Alarms when the Panel is already in Alarm, cause the following:
Page 28 of 43
9.4 CIRCUIT TYPES:
“Circuits” refers to an actual electrical interface, either Initiating (Detection) or Indicating (Signal). “Zone” is a logical
concept for a Fire Alarm Protected Area, and will consist of at least one Circuit. Often the terms Zone and Circuit are
used interchangeably, but in this Manual the term Circuit is used.
Page 29 of 43
10.0 SYSTEM CONFIGURATION
Configuration of the HCP-200 Series is accomplished simply by DIP Switch and Jumper Settings. For DIP Switches,
0 = switch “off”, 1 = Switch “on’). On the Main Fire Alarm Board ...
Notes:
& After any Configuration Switches are changed, it is necessary to perform a System Reset !!
& Only Indicating Circuit 2 may be configured for Visual Devices.
& If Initiating Circuit 3 is configured as Waterflow, the corresponding Verified selection becomes a Retard selection.
Note: Do not use Retard Operation with any external Retarding device; maximum Retard may not exceed 120 seconds.
& If Initiating Circuit 4 is configured as Alarm, the corresponding Latching selection has no effect.
& If Initiating Circuit 4 is configured as Supervisory, the corresponding Verified selection has no effect.
& The selection of Class A/B (Style Z/Y) Indicating Circuits is only a matter of how they are wired. See Connection
Info.
& If Class A (Style D) Initiating Circuits are selected (HCP-202, HCP-204, HCP-204E only), the appropriate Board
Jumpers must also be set. Class B Initiating Circuits 1&2 combine to create Class A Circuit #1, and Class B
Initiating Circuits 3&4 combine to create Class A Circuit #2. DIP Switches for Circuits 3&4 are ignored except for
an HCP-204E with a HDM-204 Adder. LED Indicators for Circuits 3&4 are non-functional except for an HCP-204E
with a HDM-204 Adder.
Page 30 of 43
Page 31 of 43
On the HDM-204 Zone Adder Module ...
Notes:
& After any Configuration Switches are changed, it is necessary to perform a System Reset !!
& Only Indicating Circuit 4 may be configured for Visual Devices.
& If Initiating Circuit 7 is configured as Waterflow, the corresponding Verified selection becomes a Retard selection.
Note: Do not use Retard Operation with any external Retarding device; maximum Retard may not exceed 120 seconds.
& If Initiating Circuit 8 is configured as Alarm, the corresponding Latching selection has no effect.
& If Initiating Circuit 8 is configured as Supervisory, the corresponding Verified selection has no effect.
& The selection of Class A/B (Style Z/Y) Indicating Circuits is only a matter of how they are wired. See Connection
Info.
& If Class A (Style D) Initiating Circuits are selected the appropriate Board Jumpers must also be set. Class B
Initiating Circuits 5&6 combine to create Class A Circuit #3, and Class B Initiating Circuits 7&8 combine to create
Class A Circuit #4. DIP Switches for Circuits 5 to 8 are ignored, and LED Indicators for Circuits 5 to 8 are non-
functional.
Page 32 of 43
11.0 WALK TEST OPERATION
Walk-Test allows an installer to verify the Initiating Circuit wiring in a system. Walk-Test is entered by pressing and
holding both the Buzzer Silence and Lamp Test Momentary Switches for at least 1 second. Circuits to be tested
are identified using the Circuit Disconnect Slide Switches. Activation of any Initiating Circuit which has been selected
for Walk-Test will cause the Audible Indicating Circuits to activate briefly for a number of short bursts corresponding to
the Circuit number. Any subsequent activations on the same Initiating Circuit will activate the Audible Indicating Circuit
only once. If another Initiating Circuit is activated then the Audible Indicating Circuits will activate for a number of short
bursts corresponding to the Circuit number of the new zone being walk-tested, and so on.
For example, if Initiating Circuit #3 is first activated, the Indication Circuits will sound for three bursts, with additional
activations sounding for one burst, etc. The initial burst interval denoting the count of the Circuit number is one
second on half a second off. The subsequent burst interval denoting additional activations on the same Initiating Circuit
is one half second on then off. After the sounding pattern has been sent on the Indicating Circuits, the Initiating Circuit
is reset and tested again. If it is still active (in alarm) the pattern will be re-sent. Trouble on any Initiating Circuit when
in Walk-Test mode causes all Indicating Circuits to be activated continuously for 5 seconds.
Alarm Verification and Water-flow Alarm Retard Operations are disabled on Circuits being Walk-Tested. All Circuits not
selected for Walk-Test continue to function normally. Walk-Test operation is disabled if the Fire Alarm Control Panel
is in Alarm or goes into Alarm while Walk-Test is active. It will also time-out after 60 minutes of no activity.
Page 33 of 43
APPENDIX "A" - COMPATIBLE DEVICES
NOTES:
Whether mixing different models of compatible smoke detectors, or using the same model on the same Circuit, total
standby current of all detectors must not exceed 3 mA.
SMOKE DETECTOR
MAKE MODEL / BASE MAKE MODEL / BASE MAKE MODEL / BASE
HOCHIKI EDWARDS FENWAL
Page 34 of 43
UNDERWRITER’S LABS INC. (UL)
UNITED STATES: 2-WIRE SMOKE DETECTOR CONTROL PANEL COMPATIBILITY
NOTES:
1) Whether mixing different models of compatible smoke detectors, or using the same model on the same Circuit, total
standby current of all detectors must not exceed 3 mA.
2). The below listed Smoke Detectors are compatible with Initiating Circuits having Compatibility Identifier "A".
Page 35 of 43
2400TH A - N/A 0.12 mA
2451 / B401 A-A 0.12 mA
2451 / B401B A-A 0.12 mA NAPCO
FW-2 HD-6 55uA @ 24VDC
Page 36 of 43
UNDERWRITER’S LABS INC. (UL)
UNITED STATES: 4-WIRE SMOKE DETECTOR CONTROL PANEL COMPATIBILITY
System Sensor -
SpecrAlert
P2415 P2415W P241575 P241575W P2475
P2475W P24110 P24110W S2415 S2415W
S241575 S241575W S2475 S2475W S24110
S24110W H12/24 H12/24W MDL MDLW
Wheelock
AS-2415W-24-FR AS-241575W-FR AS-2430W-FR AS-2475W-FR AS-24110W-FR
AS-2415C-FW AS-2430C-FW AS-2475C-FW AS-24100C-FW AH-24-R
AH-24-WP-R NS-2415W-FR NS-241575W-FR NS-2430W-FR NS-2475W-FR
NS-24110W-FR NS4-2415W-FR NS4-241575W-FR NS4-2430W-FR NS4-2475W-FR
NS4-24110W-FR RS-2415W-FR RSS-241575W-FR RSS-2415W-FR RSS-241575W-FR
RSS-2430W-FR RSS-2475W-FR RSS-24110W-FR RSS-2415C-FW RSS-2430C-FW
RSS-2475C-FW RSS-24100C-FW MT-12/24-ULC MT-24-LS-VFR-ULC MT-24-WS-VFR-ULC
AMT-12/24-R-ULC AMT-24-LS-VFR-ULC MB-G6-24-R MB-G10-24-R SM-12/24-R
DSM-12/24-R
Gentex
ST24-15 ST24-15/75 ST24-30 ST24-60 ST24-75
ST24-110
HS24-15 HS24-15/75 HS24-30 HS24-60 HS24-75
HS24-110
The HRAM-208 Eight Zone Remote Annunciator mounts in an electrical box. It provides annunciation for the HCP-204 or HCP-
Page 37 of 43
204E’s full complement of 8 Initiating circuits.
Page 38 of 43
APPENDIX "C" - MODULE SPECIFICATIONS and FEATURES
Fire Alarm Control Panel (HCP-202) Fire Alarm Control Panel (HCP-204E)
General: In smaller Enclosure ... General: In larger Enclosure ...
M 2 supervised Style B (Class B) or 1 Style D (Class A) M 4 supervised Style B (Class B) or 2 Style D (Class A)
Initiating Circuits; configurable (Normal or Verified). Initiating Circuits; configurable. [Compatibility ID “A”]
[Compatibility ID “A”] Power Limited: 26VDC, 3 mA standby, 1.5Vp-p
Power Limited: 26VDC, 3 mA standby, 1.5Vp-p ripple, 50 mA max. (alarm)
ripple, 50 mA max. (alarm) M 2 Style Y/ Z (Class A/B) Indicating Circuits; configurable as
M 2 Style Y/Z (Class A/B) Indicating Circuits; configurable as strobes or audibles.
strobes or audibles. Power Limited: 24 VDC unfiltered
Power Limited: 24 VDC unfiltered 1.7 A @ 49C per Circuit (5A Total)
1.7 A @ 49C per Circuit (2.4 A Total) M One HDM-204 Zone Adder may be added.
M Initiating Circuit Disconnect Switch. M Initiating Circuit Disconnect Switches.
M Optional DACT or City Tie Adder. M Optional DACT or City Tie Adder.
M Optional HRM-204 / HRM-208 Relay Module. M Optional HRM-204 / HRM-208 Relay Module.
M Resettable 4-Wire Smoke Supply. M Resettable 4-Wire Smoke Supply.
Power Limited: 28VDC, 100mA max, 1.5Vp-p ripple Power Limited: 28VDC, 100mA max, 1.5Vp-p ripple
M Aux Power Supply. M Aux Power Supply.
Power Limited: 24VDC, 300mA max, unfiltered Power Limited: 24VDC, 300mA max, unfiltered
for RTI or Remote Annunciators for RTI or Remote Annunciators
M 1 RTI Interface for connection to an RTI Remote Trouble M 1 RS-485 Connection for up to 3 HRAM-208 Remote
Indicator. Annunciators.
M Auxiliary relays: (resistive loads) M 1 RTI Interface for connection to an RTI Remote Trouble
Common Alarm: Form C, 1Amp, 28VDC Indicator.
Common Trouble: Form C, 1Amp, 28VDC M Auxiliary relays: (resistive loads)
M Micro-controller Based Design. Common Alarm, Supervisory, Trouble
M DIP Switch Configurable. All are Form C, 1Amp, 28VDC
M Walk-Test function. M Micro-controller Based Design.
Electrical ratings: M DIP Switch Configurable.
M AC Line Voltage: 102 to 132 VAC. M Walk-Test function.
2 Amps (primary, transformer inline fuse) Electrical ratings:
M Pwr Supp. ratings: 2.75 Amps. max. (secondary) M AC Line Voltage: 102 to 132 VAC.
M For Indicating Circuits: 24VDC unfiltered 2.5 Amps (Uses 4A circuit breaker)
2.40 Amps. max. M Pwr Supp. ratings: 6 Amps. max. (secondary)
M Battery: 24VDC, Gel-Cell/Sealed Lead-Acid M For Indicating Circuits: 24VDC unfiltered
Charging capability: 4 to 6.5 AH batteries 5 Amps. max.
Fuse on Main Board: 10 Amps. M Battery: 24VDC, Gel-Cell/Sealed Lead-Acid
M Current Consumption: Standby: 110 mA, Alarm: 220 mA Charging capability: 10 to 24 AH batteries
Fuse on Main Board: 10 Amps.
Fire Alarm Control Panel (HCP-204) M Current Consumption: Standby: 110 mA, Alarm: 220 mA
General: Same as HCP-202, plus ... Zone Adder Module (HDM-204)
M 4 supervised Style B (Class B) or 2 Style D (Class A) M May be added to HCP-204E.
Initiating Circuits; configurable (Normal or Verified, and for M 4 supervised Style B (Class B) or 2 Style D (Class A)
Style B there may be one Waterflow and one Supervisory). Initiating Circuits; configurable. [Compatibility ID “A”]
[Compatibility ID “A”] Power Limited: 22VDC, 3 mA standby, 1.5Vp-p
M Optional HRM-204 or HRM-208 Relay Module. ripple, 50 mA max. (alarm)
M 1 RS-485 Connection for up to 3 HRAM-208 Remote M 2 Style Y or Z (Class B or A) Indicating Circuits; configurable
Annunciators. as strobes or audibles.
M Auxiliary relays: (resistive loads) Power Limited: 24 VDC unfiltered, 1.7A @49C per
Common Alarm, Supervisory, Trouble Circuit
All are Form C, 1Amp, 28VDC M Current Consumption: Standby: 45 mA, Alarm: 120 mA
DACT / Dialler Module (HDACT-100) 8 Zone Remote Annunciator (HRAM-208)
M DACT - “Digital Alarm Communicator Transmitter” M RS-485 Interface, up to 3 per FA-200 Panel.
Using Ademco Contact ID and SIA-DCS Protocols. M Current Consumption: Standby: 35 mA, Alarm: 90 mA
M See Hochiki document LT-617HOC for further info. Remote Trouble Indicator (HRTI-1)
M Current Consumption: Standby: 45 mA, Alarm: 120 mA M Trouble LED and Trouble Buzzer
Polarity Reversal and City Tie Module (HPR-100) M Current Consumption: Standby: 35 mA, Alarm: 35 mA
M Supervised City Tie Not Power Limited .
24VDC unfiltered, 210 mA max., Trip coil: 14 ohms External Battery Cabinet (BC-160)
M Polarity Reversal Power Limted M Up to 24 A-H Batteries for HCP-200 FA Panels.
24VDC open, 12VDC @ 3.5 mA, 8 mA max. (shorted)
M Current Consumption: Standby: 35 mA, Alarm: 300 mA
Model: HRM-204 / HRM-208 Relay Module
M Four or Eight Relays: Form C, 1A (resistive), 28 VDC per System Model: SERIES FA-200, Fire Alarm Control Panel
contacts System Type: Local, Auxiliary (using HPR-100), Remote Station
M Each individual relay can be: Protected Premises (using HDACT-100 or HPR-100), Central
Relay per Zone, Common Alarm, Common Supervisory Station Protected Premises (using HDACT-100).
M Current Consumption: Standby: 5 mA, Alarm: 160 mA Type of Service: A, M, WF, SS (SS is only Local or with HDACT-100)
Type of Signalling: Non-Coded
Applicable Standards: NFPA 70 and 72, UL-864, ULC S-
524,ULC S-527
Page 39 of 43
APPENDIX "D" - POWER SUPPLY & BATTERY CALCULATIONS (SELECTION GUIDE)
Use the form below to determine the required Secondary Power Supply (batteries).
IMPORTANT NOTICE
The main AC branch circuit connection for Fire Alarm Control Unit must provide a dedicated continuous power without provision of any disconnect
devices. Use #12 AWG wire with 600-volt insulation and proper over-current circuit protection that complies with the local codes. Refer to appendix
"C" for specifications.
([STANDBY (A) ______ ] X [(24 or 60 Hours) ___ ]) + ([ALARM (B) ______ ] X [%Alarm in Hr.] _____) = (C) ______AH
Total Alarm Current: Must be 2.75 amperes or less for HCP-202, and HCP-204. Indicating Circuits not to exceed 2.4 amperes.
Must be 6 amperes or less for HCP-204E. Indicating Circuits not to exceed 5 amperes.
Examples: Configuration 24 Hrs Standby, 5 Min Alarm 60 Hrs Standby, 5 Min Alarm
HCP-202/4 Basic 4 AH Batteries Not Possible
HCP-202/4, HDACT-100, HRM-208, HRTI-1 6.5 AH Batteries Not Possible
Page 40 of 43
HCP-204E, HDM-204 10 AH Batteries 12 AH Batteries
HCP-204E, HDM-204, HDACT-100, HRM-208, 3 of HRAM-208 10 AH Batteries 24 AH Batteries
Always use the Selection Guide Chart to verify actual Battery Requirements.
Page 41 of 43
WARRANTY
Phone:(714) 522-2246
FAX:(714) 522-2268
Technical Support Phone: 1-800-845-6692
or technical support @hochiki.com
Page 42 of 43
Page 43 of 43
EOLR-12/24 VOLT END OF LINE RELAY
APPLICATION
The models EOLR-12 and EOLR-24 are end of line power
supervision relays used with 4-wire type smoke detec-
tors. If the power is interrupted the EOLR will cause
the alarm panel to indicate a "trouble" condition. It may
be energized with either 12 or 24 volts depending upon
model. Both models contain a form "A" contact for open-
ing the detection loop circuit of the panel upon loss of
power. Both models are encapsulated for durability
and are UL listed.
OPERATION
The EOLR is energized in a normal standby condition.
STANDARD FEATURES When there is a loss of power the relay contact will
open, causing an open circuit on the detection loop of
• Works with 4-wire type smoke detector the control panel. The control panel will then annunci-
connections. ate a trouble signal indicating a trouble condition.
• Available in 12 or 24 volt models.
• Encapsulated for durability. The models EOLR-12 and EOLR-24 are designed spe-
cifically for use with the Hochiki HSC-4R and HSC-
4R12 Four Wire Smoke Detector Bases.
SPECIFICATIONS
Model HA-EOLR-12 (12V) HA-EOLR (24V)
Coil Relay Rating 9-16 VDC 18-32 VDC
Contact Relay Rating 1A@ 125 VAC 2A@ 125 VAC
Dimensions 1 1/4” L x 1 1/4” W x /”D 1 1/4” L x 1 1/4” W x /”D
Connections: 9 Inch Length 18 AWG Stranded Color Coded Wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
4-WIRE OPERATION
(+) LISTED
END OF LINE
INITIATING DEVICE
CIRCUIT
DESCRIPTION
SPECIFICATIONS
Primary Input Power 120 volts, 60 Hz, 1 Amps PRODUCT LISTINGS
Indicating Current 24VDC unfiltered, 2.5Amps
Underwriters Laboratories: S6468
Standby Power 24VDC Standby Batteries
Charging Capability 4 – 6.5 AH Batteries CSFM #: 7165-0410:152
Dimensions: 12 3/4”H x 13 3/4”W x 3 1/8”D
Continued on back.
Specifications subject to change without notice.
Model Description
HCP-202 Two Zone Microprocessor Based Fire Alarm Control Panel comes with 2 Class B (Style B) or 1
Class A (Style D) Initiating Circuits, 2 Class A/B (Style Z/Y) Indicating Circuits and a 2.75 Amp
Power Supply. Allows for one HDACT-100 Digital Communicator or one HPR-100 Polarity Reversal
Module or one HRM-204 or HRM-208 Auxiliary Relay Module. Red enclosure comes with keylock
door.
Adder Modules
HDACT-100 Digital Alarm Communication Transmitter/Dialer Module
HPR-100 Polarity Reversal/City Tie Module
HRM-204 Auxiliary Relay Module comes with 4 configurable relays
HRM-208 Auxiliary Relay Module comes with 8 configurable relays
(Note: Only one of the above modules can be used with the HCP-202)
• 4 Class B (Style B) Initiating Circuits which may The HCP-204 utilizes a simple DIP switch configuration
be configured as 2 Class A (Style D) circuits for programming initiating and indicating circuits as well
• 2 Class A/B (Style Z/Y) Indicating Circuits with as the enabling and disabling of system functions such
individual trouble indicators (1.25 Amps max. per as Signal Silence, Fire Drill and Auxiliary Disconnect.
circuit) Some predefined Initiating circuits can optionally be
• Each Indicating Circuit can be configured as configured as Waterflow or Latching/Non-Latching
Silenceable or Non-Silenceable. Audibles may be Supervisory. In addition the HCP-204 allows for Alarm
configured as Steady, Temporal Code, California Verification on the initiating circuits. The Indicating
Code or March Time circuits may be configured as Silenceable or Non-
• Selectable Alarm Verification on Initiating Circuits Silenceable with the audibles configured for Steady,
• Output for 4-wire resettable regulated smoke March-Time, Temporal Code, or California Code. The
power supply of 24 VDC 100mA maximum HCP-204 is equipped with auxiliary relay contacts for
• Output for RTI or Remote Annunciators of 24VDC, Common Alarm, Trouble and Supervisory. If no
300 mA max. unfiltered Supervisory circuits are enabled, the Supervisory relay
• Built-in Walk Test operation becomes a second Alarm relay.
• Auxiliary relay contacts for Common Alarm,
Common Trouble and Common Supervisory. If no The cabinet is available in a beige color for the Canadian
Supervisory circuits are enabled, the Supervisory market and a red exterior for the U.S. and International
relay becomes a second Alarm relay markets. A Fire Retardant Lexan Window in the hinged
• 2.75 Amp Power Supply door allows for viewing of the status LEDs. It comes
• Easy configuration via DIP switches with a durable CAT-30 lock and key. Space is provided
for up to 10 AH batteries.
SPECIFICATIONS
Primary Input Power 120 volts, 60 Hz, 1 Amps
Indicating Current 24VDC unfiltered, 2.5Amps PRODUCT LISTINGS
Standby Power 24VDC Standby Batteries Underwriters Laboratories: S6468
Charging Capability 4 – 6.5 AH Batteries CSFM #: 7165-0410:152
Dimensions 12 3/4"H x 13 3/4"W x 3 1/8"D
Continued on back.
Specifications subject to change without notice.
Model Description
HCP-204 Four Zone Microprocessor Based Fire Alarm Control Panel comes with 4 Class B (Style B) or 2
Class A (Style D) Initiating Circuits, 2 Class A/B (Style Z/Y) Indicating Circuits and a 2.75 Amp
Power Supply. Allows for one HDACT-100 Digital Communicator or one HPR-100 Polarity Reversal
Module or one HRM-204 or HRM-208 Auxiliary Relay Module. Red enclosure comes with keylock
door.
HCH-429 Series 200 Accessory Mounting Plate. Used to mount HDACT-100 or HPR-100 or HDM-204 or
HRM-208 on the HCP-204
Adder Modules
HDACT-100 Digital Alarm Communication Transmitter/Dialer Module
HPR-100 Polarity Reversal/City Tie Module
HRM-204 Auxiliary Relay Module comes with 4 configurable relays
HRM-208 Auxiliary Relay Module comes with 8 configurable relays
(Note: Only one of the above modules can be used with the HCP-204)
Remote Annunciator
HRAM-208 Remote Multiplex Annunciator comes with Common Control Features, Indicators and 8 Bi-Colored
LEDs
Controls: Signal Silence, Buzzer Silence, Lamp Test & System Reset
Indicators: A.C. On, Common Trouble & Signal Silence
Model Description
HCP-204E Four expandable to Eight Zone Microprocessor Based Fire Alarm Control Panel comes with 4 Class
B (Style B) or 2 Class A (Style D) Initiating Circuits, 2 Class A/B (Style Z/Y) Indicating Circuits and
a 6 Amp Power Supply. Expandable up to 8 Class B (Style B) Initiating Circuits or 4 Class A (Style
D) and 4 Class A/B (Style Z/Y) Indicating Circuits. Allows for one HDACT-100 Digital Communicator
or one HPR-100 Polarity Reversal Module. Also allows for one HRM-204 or HRM-208 Auxiliary
Relay Module. Red enclosure comes with keylock door.
Adder Modules
HDM-204 Four Class B (Style B) or Two Class A (Style D) Initiating Circuit and 2 Class A/B (Style Z/Y)
Indicating Circuit Module
HDACT-100 Digital Alarm Communication Transmitter/Dialer Module
HPR-100 Polarity Reversal/City Tie Module
HRM-204 Auxiliary Relay Module comes with 4 configurable relays
HRM-208 Auxiliary Relay Module comes with 8 configurable relays
Remote Annunciator
HRAM-208 Remote Multiplex Annunciator comes with Common Control Features, Indicators and 8 Bi-Colored
LEDs
Controls: Signal Silence, Buzzer Silence, Lamp Test & System Reset
Indicators: A.C. On, Common Trouble & Signal Silence
APPLICATIONS
INSTALLATION
STANDARD FEATURES
The HDM-1008 consists of a PC board which mounts at
• Eight Class B (Style B) or 4 Class A (Style D) the bottom of the chassis. The PC board is connected
Initiating Circuits which can be configured as Alarm, via cables to the board on the main chassis. Space is
Supervisory, Waterflow or Trouble Circuits provided on the front panel allowing the application of
• Bi-Colored Alarm/Supervisory and Trouble LED slide-in labels for initiating zone description. Labels are
provided for individual annunciation of each zone provided with each chassis. Removable terminal blocks
• Slide-in labels for zone identification are provided for easy connection of field wiring and
• Programmable as Supervisory Circuit for Latching servicing.
and Non-Latching
• All circuits are power limited for use with limited
energy cable
• Removable terminal blocks for ease of wiring and
servicing
• Extensive transient protection of all circuits
SPECIFICATIONS
Continued on back.
Output Voltage 22 VDC
Standby Current 50 mA PRODUCT LISTINGS
Max. Standby Current 3 mA
End of Line Resistor 3.9K ohm ±5%, ½ W Underwriters Laboratories: S6468
CSFM #: 7165-0410:154
Specifications subject to change without notice.
INI1+
SUPERVISED INITIATING CIRCUIT #1
STYLE B
(ALARM ZONE)
WIRING
INI1-
STYLE D
INI1
INI2+
SUPERVISED INITIATING CIRCUIT #2
(SUPERVISORY OR WATERFLOW ZONE) STYLE B
WIRING
INI2-
INI3+
INI3-
STYLE D SUPERVISED INITIATING CIRCUIT #2
INI2 STYLE D
(ALARM ZONE) SEE STYLE D NOTE
WIRING
INI4+
INI4-
INI5+
INI5-
STYLE D
INI3
INI6+
INI7-
STYLE D
INI4
INI8+
LEGEND:
INI8-
SUPERVISORY OR
SMOKE DETECTOR
WATERFLOW
SWITCH (NO)
HEAT DETECTOR
NOTES: ALL CIRCUITS ARE POWER LIMITED, AND MUST USE TYPE
FPL, FPLR, OR FPLP POWER LIMITED CABLE.
INITIATING CIRCUITS ARE FULLY SUPERVISED AND RATED
FOR 22 VDC, 3 mA STANDBY, 5 mV RIPPLE, 50 mA MAX.
ALARM. THEY MAY BE CONFIGURED AS REQUIRED. THE
ALARM THRESHOLD IS 21 mA. MAXIMUM LOOP
RESISTANCE IS 100 OHMS, 50 OHMS PER SIDE.
APPLICATION
OPERATION
• Ribbon Cable To Connect To HDACT-100 and The DACT products support three level of restricted
HDACT-100U. access to the Configuration Mode which allows for
• Configures the HDACT-100 and HDACT-100U parameter configuration and control of operation.
• 4 Line x 20 Character LCD Display With Each level is associated with a separate Passcode
Keypad. (Up to 8-digit numeric code) and may be individually
modified. Once a user gains access to the Configura-
tion Mode, they are presented with a menu of selec-
tions according to the level of access granted.
SPECIFICATIONS
All configurable items have default values assigned by
the "Restore-To-Default" operation. All items must
• 4-line X 20 Character LCD Display and keypad
have a (non-zero value assigned unless specifically
• Configures HDACT-100 and HDACT-100U
identified as OPTIONAL.
communicator/dialer
• Equipped with ribbon cable to connect to HDACT
communicator
• Keypad in a rugged metal enclosure
PRODUCT LISTINGS
Underwriters Laboratories: Pending
CSFM #: Pending
MEA Report # Pending
Continued on back.
Specifications subject to change without notice.
Ceiling
#1
120°
2m
#2
3m
Ceiling Height
4m
5m
6m
7m
8m
Floor
WIRING DIAGRAMS
PANEL
POWER (-)
SUPPLY
HSB-2 Wire
UL LISTED
CONTROL
(+)
PANEL
LISTED
END OF LINE
DEVICE
(-) 3.9K 1/2W
PANEL
POWER 16mA MAX.
SUPPLY OUTPUT
(-) 16mA MAX.
OUTPUT
NEGATIVE CURRENT LIMTED AT 24VDC
1.2"
#6-32
HEXNUTS
BB-1001 BACKBOX IS SHOWN
ANNUNCIATOR CHASSIS
ORDERING INFORMATION
Model Description
Modules
HRAM-1032 Main Annunciator Chassis comes with Common Control Features, Indicators and 32 Bi-Colored
LEDs
HRAX-1048 Adder Annunciator Chassis comes with 48 Bi-Colored LEDs
Backboxes
HBB-1001 Annunciator backbox with keylock door (Houses 1 module)
HBB-1002 Annunciator backbox with keylock door (Houses 2 modules)
HBB-1003 Annunciator backbox with keylock door (Houses 3 modules)
Hochiki America Corporation • HRA-1000 Remote Annunciators Specifications subject to change without notice.
HRAM-208 REMOTE ANNUNCIATOR
DESCRIPTION
CSFM #: 7120-0410:153
24 VDC
- 24 VDC POWER FROM
OUTPUT FIRE ALARM CONTROL PANEL
+
APPLICATIONS
INSTALLATION
SPECIFICATIONS
Continued on back.
Output Voltage 24 VDC Unfiltered
Standby Current 35 mA PRODUCT LISTINGS
Alarm Current (unloaded) 150 mA
Output Current per Zone - Power Limited 1.7Amps Underwriters Laboratories: S6468
End of Line Resistor 3.9K ohm ±5%,½ W
CSFM #: 7165-0410:154
Specifications subject to change without notice.
IND1+(Y/Z)
IND1-(Y/Z)
IND2+(Y/Z)
IND2+(Z)
INDICATING STYLE
SUPERVISED INDICATING CIRCUIT #2 WIRING
CIRCUIT 2 IND2-(Z)
IND2-(Y/Z)
IND1+(Y/Z)
IND1-(Y/Z)
IND2+(Y/Z)
IND2+(Z)
INDICATING STYLE
CIRCUIT 4 SUPERVISED INDICATING CIRCUIT #4 WIRING
IND2-(Z)
IND2-(Y/Z)
LEGEND:
NOTES: ALL CIRCUITS ARE POWER LIMITED, AND MUST USE TYPE BELL, HORN, OR STROBE
FPL, FPLR, OR FPLP POWER LIMITED CABLE.
INDICATING CIRCUITS ARE FULLY SUPERVISED AND
RATED FOR 24 VDC UNFILTERED 1.7 AMP MAX. THEY MUST
BE WIRED AS SHOWN IN THE WIRING TABLES. 3.9K 1/2W ELR LISTED S5434
MP-1 Red front cover with white lettering, a single- 2.5 Amp #18 Awg Approximately
pole, single-throw normally open switch, with a 120/250V Pigtail - 6" Long 5H x 3W x 1D
spring latching mechanism. 3/8" Stripped Ends
MG-1 Red front cover with white lettering, a single- 2.5 Amp #18 Awg Approximately
pole, single-throw normally open switch, with a 120/250V Pigtail - 6" Long 5H x 3W x 1D
spring latching mechanism, with a break grlass 3/8" Stripped Ends
latch.
MP-2 Red front cover with white lettering, two single- 2.5 Amp #18 Awg Approximately
pole, single-throw normally open switch, with a 120/250V Pigtail - 6" Long 5H x 3W x 1D
spring latching mechanism. 3/8" Stripped Ends
MG-2 Red front cover with white lettering, two single- 2.5 Amp #18 Awg Approximately
pole, single-throw normally open switch, with a 120/250V Pigtail - 6" Long 5H x 3W x 1D
spring latching mechanism, with a break grlass 3/8" Stripped Ends
latch.
Specifications subject to change without notice.
OPTION DESIGNATIONS
A Anodized Brushed Aluminum with red lettering PRODUCT LISTINGS
T Terminal Strip Underwriters Laboratories: 4LO3
D Dual Action CSFM #: 7150-1134:101
Add option letter to the end of model number.
SPECIFICATIONS
Contacts Normally Open
Contact Current Rating 3A @ 120 VAC
Dimensions (WxHxD) 3.5" x 5 1/4" x 3/4"
DESCRIPTION
WIRING DIAGRAM
TOP REAR VIEW
HPS-CP/S
STANDARD FEATURES
L1
• Actuating switch, a heavy duty plunger type L2
IN
CIRCUIT
• Glass plate (2.5" x 2.5"), a Factrolite single L2 OUT
strength (obscured) type. L1
• Steel rod attached
• Mounts in a standard electrical outlet box
• Available in English & Spanish
• UL listed
• Made in USA PRODUCT LISTING
Underwriter Laboratories: S6512
Specifications subject to change without notice CSFM #: 7150-0410:164
DESCRIPTION
• Compatible with all Hochiki Control Panels The HPS-SA-EX/WP is manufactured in conformance
• Rugged die-cast housing with the standards set forth in the Americans with
• Rated class I group B (hydrogen) C&D, class II Disabilities Act.
groups E,F,G, class III, 4X outdoor
The HPS-SA-EX/WP has a white pull down lever in its
• Weather Proof center. Pulling down the lever latches it into place.
• Corrosion-resistant construction The HPS-SA-EX/WP's normally open contact switch is
• Latching alarm levers shorted causing an alarm on the fire initiating loop.
The pull down lever can not be reset unless the correct
• Screw Terminals 12-22 AWG
key is inserted into the manual fire alarm box lock and
• Key-locked reset the unit is opened. The latching lever can then be
• Optional glass break rod restored to its normal position.
• DPDT Contacts
When the HPS-SA-EX/WP is being reset and has a
glass break rod installed, all debris must be removed
SPECIFICATIONS prior to installing another rod to ensure the unit will
close and lock securely.
Contacts DPDT Form "C" (NO/C/NC)
Contact Current Rating 10 Amps @ 120/240 VAC
Dimensions (HxWxD) 4.75 in. x 3.125 in. x
3.375 in. (12.1 cm x 7.9 PRODUCT LISTING
cm x 8.6 cm) Underwriter Laboratories: E154860
CSFM #: 7151-0410:163
Specifications subject to change without notice
SPECIFICATIONS
Contact Current Rating 10A @ 120 VAC To Fire Alarm 1
Control/Communicator N/O
zone or point 2
Switch
PRODUCT LISTING
Underwriter Laboratories: S2984
CSFM #: 7150-0410:162 Wire Connections
STANDARD FEATURES
• Metal Construction
• Enclosed switch with glass rod (included)
• 10 Amps @ 120 VAC
• Available in: Single Action, Dual Action and
Dual Action in Spanish (HPS-DAH/S)
• UL, FM, CSFM Listed
• Made in USA
HPS-SAH HPS-SAK
DESCRIPTION
PRODUCT LISTING
Underwriters Laboratories: S2984
CSFM #: 7150-0410:162
HPS-DAK HPS-DAK/S
Continued on back.
Mechanical
UL 15 22 39 23 30 39 71 75 77
G
ULC TE
OF CA L IFO
R
Low 0 1 0
MEA
NI
ST
A
TEMPORAL
indoor use, ceiling and wall mount, under UL 1971
ST
LL
27 35 52 36 45 64 80 83 84
TE
A
FIR
E MAR
SH
High 0 0 1
E
E
S
RV I C
Standard. 3000 Hz
Low 0 0 0 15 22 39 23 30 39 71 75 77
Features:
* Designed to meet or exceed NFPA/ANSI Standards and UL **Sound output varies with tone and options selected.
464 Audible Signal Appliance.
Application: * UL listed for Wall mount.
The H24W Horn series is recommended for use in areas * Screw terminals capacity up to 12 AWG. Wired Without Audible Silence Feature: Wired for Audible Silence Feature:
such as: meeting rooms, schools, corridors, apartments, * Universal mounting plate included with each unit.
* 24 volts DC with two field selectable settings Sync Module Sync Module
office buildings, restaurants, hotels, and any other
* Polarized with wide listed voltage ranges using filtered F.A.C.P. SMS1-3A F.A.C.P. F.A.C.P. SMS1-3A
application where effective audible warning is required by Signal To Next Device or Strobe Signal
Circuit
Horn Signal To Next Device or
Federal, State, or local authority having jurisdiction. DC or unfiltered FWR input voltage. Circuit_ _ IN_ _
OUT End-Of Line-Resistor
_
Circuit
_ IN OUT End-Of Line-Resistor
+ H+H + + + _ H+H
_ _
* Horn field selectable tones: + + +
3000 Hz interrupted or Electro-mechanical + _ +
_
Temporal or Non-temporal
High or Low dBA output
* All models mount to 4” square, single gang, double gang, *The Sync module is rated for 3.0 amperes at 24 VDC.
or octagon back box.
Horn Selectable Sound Output: * Available in red or white housing. Dimensions:
* Synchronization requires an AMSECO SMS1-3A Sync Inches (mm)
3-3/8 (85.7)
Module.
5 (127) 1-17/32 (39) 1-13/16 (46)
Select- A -Horn Wiring:
3-9/32 (83.5)
Jumper
3-3/8 (85.7)
3-9/32 (83.5)
PC3 PC2 PC1 Control To Next Device or
5 (127)
Panel End-Of Line-Resistor
+ _
Temporal - Non-Temporal + _
Electro Mech - 3000 Hz
High - Low
WARNING:
Conductor Size (AWG), Length and capacity should be taken into consideration Mounting Options:
prior to design and installation of these products, particularly in retrofit
installations.
Mounting to a single gang box. Mounting to a 4” square back box. Mounting to a double gang box. Surface mount.
Ordering Information:
Model Input Sync w/ Universal Wall Ceiling Color Color
Number Voltage SMS1-3A Mounting Mount Mount Red White
( VDC ) Module
4” x 4” x 1-1/2”
H24WR 24 2” backbox 4” x 4” x 1-1/2”
backbox
backbox 4BX-1
H24WW 24 Surface Mount
Universal Mounting Plate Universal Mounting Plate Universal Mounting Plate back box
4SP-M
Horn Horn Horn Horn Mounting Plate
Specifications subject to change without notice.
Application:
G
L
UL ULC
OF C A L IFO
TE R
A
MEA
NI
ST
FM
A
ST
LL
The HP-24 mini horn series is recommended for use in areas
T
A
E SH
FIR
A DA
E MA R
E
E
S
RVI C
APPROVED
such as; meeting rooms, schools, corridors, apartments, office
Features:
buildings, restaurants, hotels, and any other application where
* Designed to meet or exceed NFPA/ANSI Standards
effective audible warning is required by Federal, State, or local
and UL 464 Audible Signal Appliance.
authority having jurisdiction.
* Screw terminals capacity up to 12 AWG.
* 4-wires for easy field wiring.
Engineering Specifications: * Polarized with wide listed voltage ranges using filtered
The Audible alarm indicating appliance shall be AMSECO DC or unfiltered FWR input voltage.
model HP-24 or equivalent device. The horn shall be listed * Mounts to a single gang box.
under UL 464 standard for Audible Signaling Appliance and * Available in red or white housing.
shall be approved for fire protective service. The sound output
shall be 82 dB at 10 ft. The signaling mini Horn shall operate on Mini Horn Wiring:
24VDC from a non-coded regulated DC supply or full-wave
rectified, unfiltered supply. The Horn shall be capable of WALL
mounting to a single gang box. The HP-24 shall be installed as
per plans and specifications.
Control To Next Device or
Panel End-of Line-Resistor
Dimensions: Inches (mm) _ + _ +
Mounting:
FIR
E
0.16 (4)
Specifications:
Model Rated Wiring Operating UL Indoor Average Plate Temperature
Number Voltage Type Range dB @ 10ft. dB @ 10ft Current Color Operating
( VDC ) (VDC) ( dBA ) ( dBA) ( Amps) Range
90 °
MECHANICAL *1
Standard 1971 requirements for emergency signaling devices WA 177cd. LOW 0 1 0 402 275 220 497 366 301 73 76 79
for the hearing impaired. The SH24C-177 Horn/Strobe features
Surface Mount: using RBX-1 back box skirt and SPC-1 retrofit plate
I NG 90° LL TEMPORAL
HIGH 0 0 1 419 294 235 511 379 312 82 84 84
a 177 candela intensity output. The Horn provides two different Single gang Double gang Octagon
C EIL Compound
3000 Hz
LOW 0 0 0 402 275 220 497 366 301 *2
74 77 79
° ° Compound
field selectable tones, and a High / Low output setting that can be Horn/Strobe 177cd. back box back box back box 90 90 90°
45°
achieved with the use of mini jumpers located on back of the unit. Note: The low volume Temporal setting of *1 & *2 at 16V FWR/DC are not suitable to use for Fire Alarm Public Mode (Suitable for General and
45°
FI
The round housing design offers a low profile appearance and is LI
STI N
4” square Private Modes only).
R
UL
G
A
OF C L IFOR
ULC FI FI
E
TE
MEA
NI
E
ST
E
A
back box R R
R
clearly labeled with “FIRE” lettering to be view from all angles.
ST
LL
FI
FI
E
E
T
A
E SH
FIR
E MAR
E
E
S
RV I C
FI R E
These appliances are polarized for connecting to supervised fire SPC-1 SPC-1
alarm circuits. The strobe is designed with a xenon flashtube and Features:
* 177 candela output.
FI R E FI R E
=1 =0 Average Current ( mA ) Sound Output
provides a candela intensity field selector switch for maximum 45° 45°
FI
performance. * ADA/NFPA/ANSI compliant. R
P P P DC ( dBA@DC)
E
PC3 PC2 PC1 FWR
0°
°
0°
* UL listed for Ceiling and Wall mounting under UL1971.
90 ° 90° C C C
The Ceiling mount Horn/Strobe series is available in red and
* Designed for use in sleeping and non-sleeping areas. 90 0° Pattern Tone Volume 3 2 1 16V 24V 33V 16V 24V 33V 16V 24V 33V
white housing 24V DC models. The SH24C-177 can be RBX-1
synchronized by using the SMD10-3A (daisy chain) Sync * Screw terminal capacity up to 12 AWG. RBX-1 RBX-1 RBX-1 ELECTRO HIGH 1 1 1 34 44 49 33 40 45 86 88 88
Module to comply with NFPA recommendations concerning * Polarized strobes with wide listed voltage ranges using 90° MECHANICAL LOW 1 1 0 17 25 34 19 27 34 76 80 83
90 °
filtered DC or unfiltered FWR input voltage. NON-TEMP.
45°
photosensitive epilepsy when installing 2 or more visual 0°
45°
* Horn field selectable tones: HIGH 1 0 1 34 44 49 33 40 45 87 88 88
appliances within the field of view. The strobe signals are 3000 Hz
3000 Hz interrupted or Electro-mechanical Horn LOW 1 0 0 17 25 34 19 27 34 77 81 83
designed for sleeping and non-sleeping areas and are listed for Compound Compound only
indoor use, ceiling and wall mount, under UL 1971 Standard. Temporal or Non-temporal ELECTRO HIGH 0 1 1 34 44 49 33 40 45 80 84 84
High or Low dBA output MECHANICAL LOW 0 1 0 17 25 34 19 27 34 *1
73 76 79
* Meets ADA guidelines for minimum one flash per/sec (1Hz). TEMPORAL
* All models mount to 4” x 4” x 1-1/2” back box. Horn/Strobe Combination Wiring: Wired Without Audible Silence Feature: HIGH 0 0 1 34 44 49 33 40 45 82 84 84
Application: 3000 Hz *2
* 24 volt strobe models 177 candela intensity. Sync Module LOW 0 0 0 17 25 34 19 27 34 74 77 79
The SH24C-177 Ceiling Horn/Strobe Series is recommended
* Synchronization requires an AMSECO SMD10-3A Room Spacing for Ceiling-Mounted Visible Appliances Note: The low volume Temporal setting of *1 & *2 at 16V FWR/DC are not suitable to use for Fire Alarm Public Mode (Suitable for General and
for use in areas such as: meeting rooms, schools, corridors, Using the Sync Modules: F.A.C.P. FI
To Next Device F.A.C.P. SMD10-3A FI
To Next Device or
(daisy chain) Sync Module. R
E
Signal R
E
Private Modes only).
R
apartments, office buildings, restaurants, hotels, and any other Minimum Light Output by Room Size. Signal or End-Of Line- IN OUT End-Of Line-
FI
E
FI
E
* RBX-1 back box skirt for surface mount (optional). The Sync module is designed to provide a synchronized temporal Circuit Circuit
_ _ _ _
application where effective audible and visual warning are
* The SPC-1 retrofit plate allows mounting to a variety of back pattern (code 3) tone, and synchronize the strobe flashes when used + _ Resistor
+ H+H + + Resistor
required by Federal, State, or local authority having jurisdiction. Maximum Maximum Room Size (ft.)
+ _
FI R E
boxes (optional). with AMSECO’s 177cd Strobe, and Horn/Strobe as well as the ability Ceiling
FI R E
R
E
To Next Device
FI
SMD10-3A
E
R
R
Strobe Signal Horn Signal
FI
E
Circuit Circuit or End-Of Line-
PC3 PC2 PC1 For a synchronization system, the maximum number of strobe lights Maximum One Strobe To Next Device or +
_ _ H+H
_ _ OUTPUT
INPUT _ Resistor
Two Strobes Four Strobes + + +
that can be connected to a listed Fire Alarm Control Panel 3Amp
FI R E
3-3/8 (85.7)
Model Input Strobe Sync Mounting Horn Flash Housing 60¢X 60¢ 135 cd. 95 cd. 30 cd.
Voltage Output Module Type Sound Rate Color Ordering Information: Horn
Number 70¢X 70¢ 185 cd. 95 cd. 60 cd. Signal +
(VDC) (Candela) Output (Times/min.) Circuit _
Model Input Maximum Average Mounting Color 80¢X 80¢ 240 cd. 135 cd. 60 cd.
SH24C-177R 24 177 SMD10-3A Ceiling/Wall Selectable 60 Red Number Voltage Load Current Back Box 90¢X 90¢ 305 cd. 185 cd. 95 cd.
SH24C-177W 24 177 SMD10-3A Ceiling/Wall Selectable 60 White (VDC) (Amps) (mA) 100¢X 100¢ 375 cd. 240 cd. 95 cd. WARNING:
The Horn/Strobe is listed for indoor use with a temperature operating range of 32°F ~ 120°F (0°C ~ 49°C ) * The Horn/Strobe must be used only on circuits with continuously operating voltage. DO NOT use strobe on coded or interrupted circuits in which
SMS1-3A 24 3 9 4"x4"x1-1/2" Red 110¢X 110¢ 455 cd. 240 cd. 135 cd. the applied voltage is interrupted ON and OFF as the strobe may fail to flash.
120¢X 120¢ 540 cd. 305 cd. 135 cd. * The applied voltage must be within its rated input voltage range. 1-13/32 (35)
SMD10-3A 24 3 9 4"x4"x1-1/2" Red
Specifications subject to change without notice.
130¢X 130¢ 635 cd. 375 cd. 185 cd. * Fuse ratings on signaling circuits must handle peak currents from all devices connected to those circuits. 6-7/8 (174) 2-25/32 (70) 3-3/8 (85.7)
The total current draw from all devices connected to the sync module should not exceed
NA: Not allowable
Hochiki America Corporation 3.0A, and should only be connected to circuits that provide continuously applied voltage.
7051 Village Drive, Suite 100 Buena Park, CA 90621-2268
Phone: 714/522-2246 Fax: 714/522-2268
Hochiki America Corporatrion : SH24C-177
Technical Support: 800/845-6692 or technicalsupport@hochiki.com 06/2003 Hochiki America Corporatrion : SH24C-177 Specifications subject to change without notice. Hochiki America Corporatrion : SH24C-177 Specifications subject to change without notice. Specifications subject to change without notice.
Mounting: using SPC-1 retrofit plate Double gang Octagon Horn/Strobe Current Draw Table:
Single gang =1 =0
back box
back box back box Engineering Specifications: Average Current (mA) Sound Output
The audible and visual alarm indicating appliance shall be AMSECO model SH24C-3075110 or equivalent device. The Strobe shall be P P P ( dBA @ DC )
4” square PC3 PC2 PC1 DC FWR
listed under UL 1971 Standard for signaling devices for the hearing impaired and shall be approved for fire protective service. The
SH24C-3075110 back box
SPC-1 SPC-1 SPC-1
candela output shall be field selectable, having three (3) settings 30cd, 75cd and 110cd output. All settings shall be UL1971 listed for both
Pattern Tone Volume
C C
3 2
C
1 16V 24V 33V 16V 24V 33V 16V 24V 33V
ceiling and wall mount applications. The Horn shall provide two different field selectable tones, and a High and Low field selectable sound
Ceiling and Wall Mount output setting. The signaling Horn/Strobe shall operate on 24VDC from a non-coded regulated DC supply or full-wave rectified, unfiltered
Electro High 1 1 1 160 129 116 203 171 153 86 88 88
Horn Mechanical Low 1 1 0 138 110 101 189 158 142 76 80 83
-A- Combination supply. The signaling strobe shall be designed to produce a signal flash of one flash per second with continuously applied minimum
&
NON-TEMP
High 1 0 1 160 129 116 203 171 153 87 88 88
voltage. When strobe synchronization is required, the horn/strobe shall be compatible with the AMSECO SMS1-3A or SMD10-3A (daisy 3000 Hz
chain) or other source of AMSECO sync protocol. The Horn/Strobe shall be capable of CEILING and WALL mount to a variety of back Strobe Low 1 0 0 138 110 101 189 158 142 77 81 83
Description:
boxes using the AMSECO SPC-1 retrofit back plate. @ Electro High 0 1 1 160 129 116 203 171 153 80 84 84
AMSECO’s Ceiling and Wall mount is -A-
Signaling devices shall be installed in all non-sleeping areas as per plans and specifications. 30cd Mechanical Low 0 1 0 138 110 101 189 158 142 *1
73 76 79
designed to comply with the Americans with Disability Act (ADA) TEMPORAL
and meet UL Standard 1971 requirements for emergency High 0 0 1 160 129 116 203 171 153 82 84 84
3000 Hz *2
signaling devices for the hearing impaired. The SH24C-3075110 Surface Mount: using RBX-1 back box skirt and SPC-1 retrofit plate Low 0 0 0 138 110 101 189 158 142 74 77 79
-A- features a unique candela intensity field Light Output Dispersion: Electro High 1 1 1 218 170 148 276 221 195 86 88 88
Single gang Double gang Octagon Mechanical 201
selector switch for alternating the candela to 30cd, 75cd or 110cd back box back box back box
Low 1 1 0 151 133 262 208 184 76 80 83
Horn NON-TEMP
90°
G
intensity output. The Horn provides two different field selectable Horn/Strobe with Selectable 30cd, 75cd or 110cd. High 1 0 1 218 170 148 276 221 195 87 88 88
IN
90° & 3000 Hz
IL
tones, and a High / Low output setting that can be achieved with 4” square Low 1 0 0 201 151 133 262 208 184 77 81 83
E
Strobe
C
the use of mini jumpers located on back of the unit. The round UL ULC back box
°
°
MEA High 1 1 218 170 148 221 195 84 84
90
0 276 80
90
Electro
housing design offers a low profile appearance and is clearly SPC-1 SPC-1 SPC-1 Compound Compound @ Mechanical Low *1
90° 0 1 0 201 151 133 262 208 184 73 76 79
labeled with “FIRE” lettering to be view from all angles. These Features: FI 75cd TEMPORAL
45 °
E FI
High 0 1 218 170 148 221 195 84 84
45 °
R 0 276 82
R
FI
appliances are polarized for connecting to supervised fire alarm
E
* Selectable Candela 30cd, 75cd or 110 candela output. 3000 Hz
E
FI
Low *2
R
E
0 0 0 201 151 133 262 208 184 74 77 79
circuits. The strobe is designed with a xenon flashtube and
R
* ADA/NFPA/ANSI compliant.
FI
FI R E
provides a candela intensity field selector switch for maximum Electro High 1 1 1 273 207 173 348 270 232 86 88 88
* UL listed for Ceiling and Wall mounting under UL1971. FI R E
performance. The Ceiling/Wall mount Select -A-HornStrobe Mechanical Low 1 1 0 256 188 158 334 257 221 76 80 83
* Designed for use in non-sleeping areas. RBX-1 FI R E
series is available in red and white housing 24V DC models. The RBX-1 RBX-1 RBX-1 45 ° 45 ° Horn NON-TEMP High 1 0 1 273 207 173 348 270 232 87 88 88
* Screw terminal capacity up to 12 AWG.
FI
°
90
& 3000 Hz
90
R
E
SH24C-3075110 can be synchronized by using the SMD10-3A Low 188 158 257 221 81 83
0°
* Polarized strobes with wide listed voltage ranges using filtered 1 0 0 256 334 77
0°
90° Strobe
(daisy ch ain) Sync Module to comply with NFPA DC or unfiltered FWR input voltage. 0° Electro High 0 1 1 273 207 173 348 270 232 80 84 84
recommendations concerning photosensitive epilepsy when * Horn field selectable tones: @ Mechanical Low 0 1 0 188 158 257 221 *1
76 79
256 334 73
installing 2 or more visual appliances within the field of view. The 3000Hz interrupted or Electro-mechanical 0° 110cd TEMPORAL High 0 1 207 173 270 232 84 84
90°
90° 0 273 348 82
45 °
strobe signals are designed for non-sleeping areas and are listed Temporal or Non-temporal 3000 Hz
45 °
*2
Low 0 0 0 256 188 158 334 257 221 74 77 79
for indoor use, ceiling and wall mount, under UL 1971 Standard. High or Low dBA output Compound Compound
* Meets ADA guidelines for minimum one flash per/sec (1 Hz). Note: The low volume Temporal setting of *1 & *2 at 16V FWR/DC are not suitable to use for Fire Alarm Public Mode (Suitable for General and
Private Modes only).
* All models mount to 4” x 4” x 1-1/2” back box.
* Synchronization requires an AMSECO SMD10-3A Horn/Strobe Combination Wiring: Wired Without Audible Silence Feature:
Application: Room Spacing for Wall-Mounted Visible Appliances Minimum Light Output by room Size (Non-Sleeping) Horn Only Current Draw and Sound Output Table:
(daisy chain) Sync Module. Sync Module
The SH24C-3075110 Ceiling Horn/Strobe Series is Maximum One Strobe Two Strobes Maximum One Strobe Two Strobes
* RBX-1 back box skirt for surface mount (optional). Four Strobes Four Strobes =1 =0
recommended for use in areas such as: meeting rooms, schools, Room Room F.A.C.P. E
FI
To Next Device F.A.C.P. SMD10-3A
E
FI
To Next Device or Average Current (mA) Sound Output
* The SPC-1 retrofit plate allows mounting to a variety of back per Room per Room per Room per Room per Room per Room R Signal R
R
Signal or End-Of Line- IN OUT End-Of Line-
corridors, apartments, office buildings, restaurants, hotels, and
FI
E
FI
E
boxes (optional). Size Size Circuit
_ Resistor
Circuit
_ _ _ _ Resistor PC3 PC1
P P P DC FWR
( dBA @ DC )
any other application where effective audible and visual warning 20¢X 20¢ 15 cd. NA 60 cd. + + H+H + + Pattern
PC2 C C C
* Available in red or white housing. NA 80¢X 80¢ 240 cd. 135 cd. Tone Volume
+ _
16V 24V 33V 16V 24V 33V 16V 24V 33V
FI R E
R
E
Height (ft.) 20 X 20 30 X 30 40 X 40 50 X 50 To Next Device
FI
SMD10-3A
E
R
Private Modes only).
R
Strobe Signal Horn Signal
FI
E
Circuit Circuit or End-Of Line-
+
_ _ _ _ OUTPUT
INPUT _ Resistor
30 75cd. 75cd. 177cd. 177cd. To Next Device or + H+H + +
Strobe Only Current Draw Table:
FI R E
End-Of Line-Resistor
+ _
FI R E
3-3/8 (85.7)
Horn
(VDC) (Selectable) Output (Times/min.) Signal +
_ @ 75cd Peak 304 222 212 562 464 454
Circuit
SH24C-3075110R 24 30, 75, 110 SMD10-3A Ceiling/Wall Selectable 60 Red In-Rush 306 342 374 540 478 498
Average 244 168 129 320 235 192
SH24C-3075110W 24 30, 75, 110 SMD10-3A Ceiling/Wall Selectable 60 White
WARNING: Peak 418 288 208 680 572 532
The Horn/Strobe is listed for indoor use with a temperature operating range of 32F ~ 120F (0C °~ 49C ° ) @ 110cd
* The Horn/Strobe must be used only on circuits with continuously operating voltage. DO NOT use strobe on coded or interrupted circuits in which 398
In-Rush 386 430 644 580 548
1-13/32 (35) the applied voltage is interrupted ON and OFF as the strobe may fail to flash.
Specifications subject to change without notice. 6-7/8 (174) * The applied voltage must be within its rated input voltage range.
2-25/32 (70) 3-3/8 (85.7)
* Fuse ratings on signaling circuits must handle peak currents from all devices connected to those circuits.
Hochiki America Corporation
7051 Village Drive, Suite 100 Buena Park, CA 90621-2268
Phone: 714/522-2246 Fax: 714/522-2268
Hochiki America Corporatrion : SH24C-3075110
Technical Support: 800/845-6692 or technicalsupport@hochiki.com 06/2003 Hochiki America Corporatrion : SH24C-3075110 Specifications subject to change without notice. Hochiki America Corporatrion : SH24C-3075110 Specifications subject to change without notice. Specifications subject to change without notice.
Mounting Options:
Strobe with Universal mounting Strobe with Universal mounting Strobe with Universal mounting Strobe with Universal mounting
Patented
SH24W-153075 plate and single gang box. plate and 4” square back box. plate and double gang box. plate and surface mount back box.
UL
G
L
O F C A L I FO
ULC TE R
MEA
A
FM
NI
ST
A
lettering and is polarized for connecting to supervised fire
ST
LL
TE
A
FIR SH
E MA R
E
S
E
alarm circuits. The strobe is designed with a xenon flashtube APPROVED RVI C
3 9/32(83.5)
* Designed to meet or exceed NFPA/ANSI Standards and ADA
3 3/8(85.7)
3 9/32(83.5)
The Select-A-Horn/Strobe series is available in red and white
5 (127)
Accessibility Guidelines.
housing 24V DC models. The SH24W-153075 can be
* UL listed for wall mounting.
synchronized by using the SMD10-3A Sync Module to comply
* Screw terminal capacity up to 12 AWG.
with NFPA recommendations concerning photosensitive
* Universal mounting plate included with each unit.
epilepsy when installing 2 or more visual appliances within the
* 24V DC strobe with two field selectable settings 15cd or 30cd.
field of view. The strobe signals are listed for indoor use, wall
* Polarized strobes with wide listed voltage ranges using filtered
mount, under UL 1971 Standard.
DC or unfiltered FWR input voltage.
* Horn field selectable tones:
3000 Hz interrupted or Electro-mechanical Using the Sync Module:
Application: Temporal or Non-temporal Dimensions: Inch (mm)
High or Low dBA output The Sync module is designed to provide a synchronized temporal pattern
The SH24W-153075 Horn/Strobe Series is recommended
(code3) tone, and synchronize the strobe flashes when used with AMSECO’s 4.33 (110)
for use in areas such as: meeting rooms, schools, corridors, * Meets ADA guidelines for minimum one flash per/sec (1Hz).
line of Select-A-Strobe and Select-A-Horn/Strobe series as well as the ability
apartments, office buildings, restaurants, hotels, and any * All models mount to 4” square, single gang, double gang, or 3.374 (85.7)
to silence the horn while maintaining the strobe flashes. 0.2 (5)
other application where effective audible and visual warning octagonal back box. The SMD10-3A has the capability of connecting two style Y (class B) circuits or
are required by Federal, State, or local authority having * 24 volt strobe models 15 or 30 candela intensity. one style Z (class A) circuit and is rated for 3 amperes per circuit.
jurisdiction. * Tamper-proof candela selector switch. The SMD10-3A can be interconnected so that more than two alarm zones can
* Synchronization requires an AMSECO SMD10-3A Sync Module. be synchronized when connected using the SYNC terminals (daisy chain
* Available in red or white housing.
3.374 (85.7)
connection).The maximum number of interconnected SMD10-3A modules is
4.33 (110)
Strobe Selectable Candela Output: twenty (20). All inputs are polarized for compatibility with standard reverse
polarity supervision of circuit wiring, when used with Fire Alarm Control Panel
(F.A.C.P).
15 Horn Selectable Sound Output:
cd Ordering Information:
30
cd Model Input Maximum Average Mounting Color
Number Voltage Load Current Back Box
F (VDC) (Amps) (mA)
I
R 15
E PC3 PC2 PC1 SMD10-3A 24 3 9 4"x4"x1-1/2" Red
The total current draw from all devices connected to the SMD10-3A should not exceed 3.0A. Mounting:
30 The SMD10-3A should only be connected to circuits that provide continuously applied voltage.
+ _
Note: The low volume Temporal setting of *1 & *2 at 16V FWR/DC are not suitable to use for Fire Alarm Public Mode (Suitable for General and
Private Modes only).
Hochiki America Corporatrion : SH24W-153075 Specifications subject to change without notice. Hochiki America Corporatrion : SH24W-153075 Specifications subject to change without notice.
Engineering Specifications: Horn/Strobe Current Draw Table:
The audible and visual alarm indicating appliance shall be AMSECO model SH24W-75110 or equivalent device. The Strobe shall
be listed under UL 1971 Standard for signaling devices for the hearing impaired and shall be approved for fire protective service. P P P Average Current (mA) Sound Output
The candela output shall be field selectable, having a dual setting of 75cd or 110cd output. The Horn shall provide two different PC3 PC2 PC1 ( dBA @ DC )
C C C
SH24W-75110 Patented field selectable tones, and a High and Low field selectable sound output setting. The signaling Horn/Strobe shall operate on
Pattern Tone Volume 3 2 1
16V
DC
24V 33V 16V
FWR
24V 33V 16V 24V 33V
SMS1-3A
24VDC from a non-coded regulated DC supply or full-wave rectified, unfiltered supply. The signaling strobe shall be designed to
Select -A- Horn /Strobe
TM
Combination produce a signal flash of one flash per second with continuously applied minimum voltage. The Horn/Strobe shall be capable of Electro High 1 1 1 160 125 115 212 159 145 85 87 88 Sync Module
WALL mounting to a universal backbox. Visual signaling devices shall be mounted 80” above the highest floor point or 6” below Mechanical Low 1 1 0 148 112 102 199 144 120 75 78 81
NON-TEMP
Description: ceiling; (whichever is lowest) and are to be installed as per plans and specifications. High 1 0 1 160 125 115 212 159 145 85 88 88 When used with the SH24W Horn/Strobe Series the SMS1-3A
3000 Hz
AMSECO’s Select-A-Horn/Strobe Series is designed to @ Low 1 0 0 148 112 102 199 144 120 75 78 81 provides synchronized temporal pattern and a synchronized
comply with the Americans with Disability Act (ADA) and Light Output Distribution / Horizontal and Vertical Dispersion: High 125 159 strobe flash while using a single pair of wires on a single class
75cd Electro 0 1 1 160 115 212 145 81 83 84
"A" circuit.
meet UL Standard 1971 requirements for emergency Mechanical Low 0 1 0 148 112 102 199 144 120 71 75 77
signaling devices for the hearing impaired. The SH24W UL Required Minimum Light Output (cd) TEMPORAL
45 High 0 0 1 160 125 115 212 159 145 80 83 84 SMS1-3A Sync Module
series Select-A-Horn/Strobe features a unique candela Wall Mount Horizontal Wall Mount Vertical WALL 3000 Hz
Degrees @75cd @110cd @75cd @110cd Low 0 0 0 148 112 102 199 144 120 71 75 77
intensity field selector switch for alternating the candela 0 75.00 110.00 75.00 110.00 90 I STI N
High 1 1 1 212 157 141 277 205 173 85 87 88 L F CALI
Electro UL
G
ULC
O FO
TE R
A
output 75cd to 110cd. The Horn provides two different field FM
N
ST
IA
30 56.25 82.50 67.50 99.00 Mechanical Low
ST
LL
1 1 0 200 144 128 264 190 148 75 78 81 TE
A
FIR SH
E MA R
E
S
E
APPROVED RVI C
Horn/Strobe with Universal Mounting Plate Included 35 56.25 82.50 48.75 71.50 45 NON-TEMP
High 1 157 205
40 56.25 82.50 34.50 50.60 1 0 212 141 277 173 85 88 88
be achieved with the use of mini jumpers located on back of 3000 Hz
the unit. The strobe housing is clearly labeled with vertical STI N
LI F CA LI
45 56.25 82.50 25.50 37.40 Compound 45
90
@ Low 1 0 0 200 144 128 264 190 148 75 78 81 Model Number Input Maximum Average Mounting Color
50 41.25 60.50 20.25 29.70
UL Voltage Load Current
G
ULC
FO
Back Box
O
110cd
TE R
MEA High
A
FM
NI
157 205
ST
1 1 212 141 173 83 84
A
“FIRE” lettering and is polarized for connecting to 55 33.75 49.50 16.50 24.20 Electro 0 277 81
ST
LL
(VDC) (Amps) (mA)
T
A
A DA
E SH
F IR
E MAR
E
E
Mechanical 200
S
supervised fire alarm circuits. The strobe is designed with a APPROVED RV I C
0 1 0 144 128 264 190 148 71 75 77
65 26.25 38.50 12.00 17.60 45 TEMPORAL
xenon flashtube and provides a candela intensity field 70 26.25 38.50 11.25 16.50 High 0 0 1 212 157 141 277 205 173 80 83 84 SMS1-3A 24 3 9 4"x4"x1-1/2" Red
75 22.50 33.00 9.75 14.30 3000 Hz
selector switch for maximum performance. Features: 80 22.50 33.00 9.00 13.20 Compound 45 Low 0 0 0 200 144 128 264 190 148 71 75 77
The Select-A-Horn/Strobe series is available in red and 85 ~ 90 18.75 27.50 9.00 13.20 WALL High 1 1 1 27 35 52 36 45 64 85 87 88 * The total current draw from all devices connected to the SMS1-3A should not exceed 3.0A.
* Designed to meet or exceed NFPA/ANSI Standards and ADA 90 Electro
white housing 24V DC models. The SH24W-75110 can be Compound 45 18.00 26.40 Mechanical Low 22 30
**The SMS1-3A should only be connected to circuits that provide continuously applied voltage.
Accessibility Guidelines. 1 1 0 15 39 23 39 75 78 81
synchronized by using the SMS1-3A Sync Module to * UL listed for wall mounting. NON-TEMP High 1 0 1 27 35 52 36 45 64 85 88 88
comply with NFPA recommendations concerning * Screw terminal capacity up to 12 AWG. Horn 3000 Hz
Low 1 0 0 15 22 39 23 30 39 75 78 81
Sound Output Dispersion (dB)
photosensitive epilepsy when installing 2 or more visual * Universal mounting plate included with each unit. Only High 35 45
Degrees Wall Mount Horizontal Wall Mount Vertical Electro 0 1 1 27 52 36 64 81 83 84 SMS1-3A Current Draw Table:
appliances within the field of view. The strobe signals are * 24V DC strobe with field selectable settings 75cd or 110cd. +90 -6 dB -3 dB 90 Mechanical Low 0 1 0 15 22 39 23 30 39 71 75 77
listed for indoor use, wall mount, under UL 1971 Standard. * Polarized strobes with wide listed voltage ranges using filtered +60 -2 dB -2 dB
TEMPORAL
+30 -1 dB -1 dB High 0 0 1 27 35 52 36 45 64 80 83 84
DC or unfiltered FWR input voltage. 0 0 dB 0 dB 0 3000 Hz Voltage Average Peak In-Rush
Low 0 0 0 15 22 39 23 30 39 71 75 77
* Horn field selectable tones: -30 -1 dB -3 dB
-60 -2 dB -5 dB 90
Application: 3000 Hz interrupted or Electro-mechanical -90 -6 dB -6 dB DC FWR DC FWR DC FWR
Strobe Only Current Draw Table:
The SH24W-75110 Horn/Strobe Series is recommended for Temporal or Non-temporal
use in areas such as: meeting rooms, schools, corridors, High or Low dBA output Wired Without Audible Silence Feature:
Horn/Strobe Combination Wiring: Average Current (mA) Peak Current (mA) In-Rush Current (mA) 20V 8mA 8mA 31mA 57mA 44mA 62mA
apartments, office buildings, restaurants, hotels, and any * Meets ADA guidelines for minimum one flash per/sec (1Hz).
* All models mount to 4” square, single gang, double gang, or.
24 volt models 24 volt models 24 volt models 24V 9mA 9mA 32mA 62mA 52mA 75mA
other application where effective audible and visual warning 33V 33V 33V
octagonal back box. F.A.C.P. SMS1-3A 16V 24V 16V 24V 16V 24V
are required by Federal, State, or local authority having Control To Next Device or Signal To Next Device or 30V 10mA 10mA 33mA 66mA 70mA 94mA
jurisdiction. * 24 volt strobe models 75 or 110 candela intensity. Panel End-Of Line-Resistor Circuit_ _ IN_ F End-Of Line-Resistor Candela DC FWR DC FWR DC FWR Candela DC FWR DC FWR DC FWR Candela DC FWR DC FWR DC FWR
_
F
+ _
OUT I
* Tamper-proof candela selector switch. +
I
R
E
H+H + + R
E
75 138 186 97 134 75 111 75 163 362 137 286 112 248 75 163 362 137 286 121 248
The SMS1-3A module is listed for indoor use with a temperature
+ _
* Synchronization requires an AMSECO SMS1-3A Sync Module. operating range of 32 F ~ 120 F ( 0 C ~ 49 C ).
Strobe Selectable Candela Output: * Available in red or white housing. + _ 110 190 251 129 180 98 139 110 203 442 163 366 131 307 110 203 442 163 366 131 307
The SH24W-75110 series horn/strobe is listed for indoor use with a temperature operating range of 32 ° F ~ 120° F ( 0° C ~ 49° C ).
75 Horn Selectable Sound Output: *The Sync module is rated for 3.0 amperes at 24 VDC. Dimensions: Inches (mm) Mounting: Dimensions: Inch (mm)
cd 5(127) 2 1/4(56.9) 3 3/8(85.7)
4.33
11 Signals Wired for Independent Operation: Wired for Audible Silence Feature: 1 13/16(46)
Electrical Back box
0cd (110)
F 3.374 0.2
3 9/32(83.5)
3 9/32(83.5)
3 3/8(85.7)
I
(85.7)
5(127)
F
R 75 I
(5)
E PC3 PC2 PC1 R F.A.C.P. F.A.C.P. SMS1-3A F
F.A.C.P. E To Next Device or Strobe Signal Horn Signal I To Next Device or
Strobe Signal End-Of Line-Resistor
Circuit Circuit R
11 Circuit
_ Strobe Horn _ +
_ _ H+H
_ IN _ OUT
_ E End-Of Line-Resistor
0 + _ _ + + + +
+ +
+ _
Tamper Proof Temporal - Non-Temporal Mounting Options:
Electro Mech - 3000 Hz
High - Low Horn/Strobe with Universal mounting Horn/Strobe with Universal mounting Horn/Strobe with Universal mounting Horn/Strobe with Universal mounting
(85.7)
(110)
4.33
3.374
F.A.C.P. To Next Device or plate and single gang box. plate and 4” square back box. plate and double gang box. plate and surface mount back box.
Ordering Information: Horn Signal
Circuit
End-Of Line-Resistor
_
+ _ +
Input Selectable Sync Mounting Horn Wiring Housing 4”x4”X1-1/2”
Model
Number Voltage Strobe Output Module Type Sound Type Color
(VDC) (Candela) Output SMS1-3A
4” x 4” x 1-1/2”
WARNING: 2” backbox 4” x 4” x 1-1/2”
backbox
SH24W-75110R 24 75 or 110 SMS1-3A Wall Only Selectable Terminals Red * Horn/Strobe must be used only on circuits with continuously operating voltage. DO NOT use strobe on coded or interrupted F
backbox
4BX-1
F F F
circuits in which the applied voltage is interrupted ON and OFF as the strobe may fail to flash. I I I Surface Mount
SH24W-75110W 24 75 or 110 SMS1-3A Wall Only Selectable Terminals White R Universal Mounting Plate R Universal Mounting Plate R Universal Mounting Plate I
R
4SP-M back box
* The applied voltage must be within its rated input voltage range. E E E E
Mounting
* Fuse ratings on signaling circuits must handle peak currents from all devices connected to those circuits. Horn/Strobe Horn/Strobe Horn/Strobe Horn/Strobe Plate
Specifications subject to change without notice.
Description:
AMSECO’s Ceiling and Wall mount strobe is designed to comply Light Output Dispersion:
with the Americans with Disability Act (ADA) and meet UL
90 °
G
WA
IN
Standard 1971 requirements for emergency signaling devices 90° LL
IL
E
for the hearing impaired. The SL24C-177 strobe round housing
°
°
90
90
design offers a low profile appearance and is clearly labeled with Compound Compound
“FIRE” lettering to be view from all angles. These appliances are FI 90°
45°
E FI
45°
polarized for connecting to supervised fire alarm circuits. The R
R
FI
E
FI
strobe is designed with a xenon flashtube and provides a 177 Strobe 177cd. R
E
R
FI
E
candela intensity output for maximum performance.
FI R E
FI R E
STI N
LI
G
OF CA L IFOR
ULC TE
MEA
NI
ST
A
FI R E
ST
LL
housing 24V DC models. T
45° 45°
A
E SH
FI R
E MAR
E
E
S
RV I C
FI
°
90
The SL24C-177 can be synchronized by using the SMD10-3A
90
R
E
0°
0°
Sync Module to comply with NFPA recommendations 90°
concerning photosensitive epilepsy when installing 2 or more
0°
Features:
visual appliances within the field of view. The strobe signals are * ADA/NFPA/ANSI Compliant. 0°
90 °
listed for indoor use, ceiling and wall mount, for sleeping and * UL listed for Ceiling and Wall mounting under UL1971. 90°
45°
45°
non/sleeping areas under UL 1971 Standard. * Screw terminal capacity up to 12 AWG. Compound Compound
* 24V DC strobe with 177cd output. Using the Sync Module:
* Polarized strobes with wide listed voltage ranges using Sync Module Room Spacing for Ceiling-Mounted Visible Appliances
Application: Filtered DC or unfiltered FWR input voltage. F.A.C.P. SMD10-3A FI
Minimum Light Output by Room Size.
Signal E To Next Device or
The SL24C-177 Ceiling Strobe Series is recommended for use * Meets ADA guidelines for minimum one flash per/sec (1Hz). R
R
Circuit IN OUT End-Of Line- Maximum
FI
E
in areas such as: warehouses, meeting rooms, schools, * Munts to 4” square, back box. _ _ _ _ Resistor Maximum Room Size (ft.)
+ H+H + + Ceiling
corridors, apartments, office buildings, restaurants, hotels, and * 24 volt strobe models. 20 X 20 30 X 30 40 X 40 50 X 50
+ _
Height (ft.)
FI R E
any other application where effective visual warning is required * Designed for sleeping and non/sleeping areas.
* Synchronization requires an AMSECO SMS1-3A or 30 75cd. 75cd. 177cd. 177cd.
by Federal, State, or local authority having jurisdiction.
SMD10-3A (daisy chain) Sync Module. 20 30cd. 75cd. 110cd. 177cd.
* RBX-1 back box skirt for surface mount (optional) *The Sync module is rated for 3.0 amperes at 24 VDC. 10 30cd. 30cd. 75cd. 110cd.
Strobe Wiring: * The SPC-1 retrofit plate allows mounting to a variety of back
boxes (optional). Mounting:
FI
* Available in red or white housing. *The SPC-1 Universal Retrofit Plate is designed for mounting to a variety of back boxes.
Control E To Next Device *Surface mount installations, use the RBX-1 Back Box Skirt.
R
R
4” square
FI R E
Wiring Terminals: back box
4” square
back box RBX-1
RBX-1 RBX-1 RBX-1
Current Draw Table:
DC FWR
Current (mA)
16V 24V 33V 16V 24V 33V
Average 378 245 185 468 332 264
@ 177cd Peak 584 428 380 844 804 700
In-Rush 460 476 508 788 828 716 Dimensions: Inches (mm)
Ordering Information:
Model Input Strobe Sync Mounting Flash Operating Housing
3-3/8 (85.7)
Number Voltage Output Module Type Rate Voltage Range Color
(VDC) (Candela) (Times/min.) (VDC)
SL24C-177R 24 177 SMD10-3A Ceiling / Wall 60 16 ~ 33 Red
SL24C-177W 24 177 SMD10-3A Ceiling / Wall 60 16 ~ 33 White
The strobe is listed for indoor use with a temperature operating range of 32°F ~ 120°F (0°C ~ 49°C ) 6-7/8 (174) 1-13/32 (35) 3-3/8 (85.7)
2-25/32 (70)
Specifications subject to change without notice.
90 °
WA
LL
G
UL Standard 1971 requirements for emergency signaling 90°
IN
IL
devices for the hearing impaired. The SL24C-3075110 Select-
E
C
°
°
A-Strobe features a unique candela intensity field selector Compound Compound
90
90
switch for alternating the candela 30cd, 75cd or 110cd intensity 90°
45°
FI
45°
Strobe with Selectable Candela 30cd, 75cd, 110cd FI
R
E
output. The round housing design offers a low profile
E
R
R
FI
E
FI
E
R
R
appearance and is clearly labeled with “FIRE” lettering to be
FI
E
STI N
LI
FI R E
UL
G
OF CA L IFOR
ULC TE
MEA
NI
ST
view from all angles. These appliances are polarized for
A
ST
LL
FI R E
T
A
E SH
FI R
E MAR
E
E
S
FI R E
RV I C
FI
designed with a xenon flashtube and provides a candela E
R
0°
0°
* Selectable Candela 30cd, 75cd or 110 candela output.
°
90
90
intensity field selector switch for maximum performance. The 90°
* ADA/NFPA/ANSI compliant. 0°
Ceiling/Wall mount Select-A-Strobe series is available in red
and white housing 24V DC models. The SL24C-3075110 can be * UL listed for Ceiling and Wall mounting under UL1971.
* Designed for use in non-sleeping areas.
90 °
synchronized by using the SMD10-3A (daisy chain) Sync 0° 90°
45°
45°
Compound Compound
Module to comply with NFPA recommendations concerning * Screw terminal capacity up to 12 AWG.
* Polarized strobes with wide listed voltage ranges using filtered Strobe Current Draw Table:
photosensitive epilepsy when installing 2 or more visual
appliances within the field of view. The strobe signals are DC or unfiltered FWR input voltage. DC FWR
Current (mA)
designed for non-sleeping areas and are listed for indoor use, * Meets ADA guidelines for minimum one flash per/sec (1Hz). 16V 24V 33V 16V 24V 33V
ceiling and wall mount, under UL 1971 Standard. * All models mount to 4” x 4” x 1-1/2” back box.
Average 121 87 70 168 131 110
* Synchronization requires an AMSECO SMD10-3A
(daisy chain) Sync Module. @ 30cd Peak 221 215 165 414 350 338
* RBX-1 back box skirt for surface mount (optional) In-Rush 254 298 338 402 418 458
Application: Strobe 183 127 101 240 180 151
* The SPC-1 retrofit plate allows mounting to a variety of back Average
The SL24C-3075110 Ceiling Strobe Series is recommended for
boxes (optional). @ 75cd Peak 298 218 209 554 458 450
use in areas such as: warehouses, meeting rooms, schools,
corridors, apartments, office buildings, restaurants, hotels, and * Available in red or white housing. In-Rush 306 342 374 540 478 498
any other application where effective visual warning is required Average 236 162 125 310 227 186
Strobe Wiring: 410 282 204 670 564 526
by Federal, State, or local authority having jurisdiction. @ 110cd Peak
In-Rush 386 398 430 644 580 548
FI To Next Device
Control E
R
R
Resistor
Strobe Selectable Candela:
+ _ *The SPC-1 Universal Retrofit Plate is designed for mounting to a variety of back boxes.
*Surface mount installations, use the RBX-1 Back Box Skirt.
Single gang Double gang Octagon
back box back box back box
FI R E
+ _ 4” square
back box
SPC-1 SPC-1 SPC-1
H
C
IT
4” square
S
R
IN OUT
3-3/8 (85.7)
Circuit End-Of Line-
FI
E
_ _ _ _ Resistor
SL24C-3075110R 24 30, 75, 110 SMD10-3A Ceiling / Wall 60 16 ~ 33 Red + H+H + +
+ _
FI R E
L
Compound 45
G
F CA L IFO
ULC
O
TE R
MEA 90
A
FM
NI
ST
“FIRE” lettering and is polarized for connecting to
A
90 50 8.25 16.50 4.05 8.10
ST
LL
T
A
A DA
E SH
F IR
E MAR
E
S
APPROVED VI C
3-9/32 (83.5)
3-9/32 (83.5)
3-3/8 (85.7)
F H+H
Panel End-Of Line-Resistor R
cd
5 (127)
I E
_
+ _
R
+ E
+ _
F
I
R 15
E
*The Sync module is rated for 3.0 amperes at 24 VDC.
30
Conductor size (AWG), length and capacity should be taken into
Tamper Proof consideration prior to design and installation. Mounting Options:
Strobe with Universal mounting Strobe with Universal mounting Strobe with Universal mounting Strobe with Universal mounting
plate and single gang box. plate and 4” square back box. plate and double gang box. plate and surface mount back box.
Ordering Information:
L
45 56.25 82.50 25.50 37.40
G
F CA L IFO
ULC
O
TE R
Compound 45
MEA
A
FM
NI
ST
fire alarm circuits. The strobe is designed with a xenon
A
90 50 41.25 60.50 20.25 29.70
90
ST
LL
T
A
A DA
E SH
F IR
E MAR
E
E
S
APPROVED R V IC
55 33.75 49.50 16.50 24.20
switch for maximum performance. 0 60 30.00 44.00 13.50 19.80
Features: 45 0 65 26.25 38.50 12.00 17.60
The Select-A-Strobe Series is available in red and white 70 26.25 38.50 11.25 16.50
housing 24VDC models. The SL24W-75110 can be * Designed to meet or exceed NFPA/ANSI Standards and ADA Compound 45 90
75 22.50 33.00 9.75 14.30
synchronized by using the SMS1-3A sync module to comply Accessibility Guidelines. 80 22.50 33.00 9.00 13.20
with NFPA recommendations concerning photosensitive * UL listed for wall mounting. 85 ~ 90 18.75 27.50 9.00 13.20
* Screw terminal capacity up to 12 AWG. Compound 45 18.00 26.40
epilepsy when installing 2 or more visual appliances within
the field of view. The strobe signals are listed for indoor * Universal mounting plate included with each unit.
use, wall mount, under UL 1971 Standard. * 24V DC strobe with field selectable settings 75cd or 110cd. Strobe Current Draw Table:
* Polarized strobes with wide listed voltage ranges using filtered
DC or unfiltered FWR input voltage.
DC FWR
* Meets ADA guidelines for minimum one flash per/sec (1Hz). Current (mA)
* All models mount to 4” square, single gang, double gang, or 16V 24V 33V 16V 24V 33V
Application: octagonal back box. Average 132 92 71 178 128 105
The SL24W-75110 Strobe series is recommended for use in * 24 volt strobe models 75 or 110 candela Intensity. @ 75cd Peak 157 132 108 354 280 242
areas such as: meeting rooms, schools, corridors, * Tamper-proof candela selector switch. In-Rush 157 132 121 354 280 242
apartments, office buildings, restaurants, hotels, and any * Synchronization requires an AMSECO SMS1-3A Sync Module. Average 181 122 94 241 170 134
other application where effective visual warning is required * Available in red or white housing. @ 110cd Peak 194 156 127 432 356 302
by Federal, State, or local authority having jurisdiction. In-Rush 194 156 127 432 356 302
11 F
Circuit_ _ IN_ _
OUT F
I
End-Of Line-Resistor
+ + +
3-9/32 (83.5)
3-9/32 (83.5)
Panel
3-3/8 (85.7)
End-Of Line-Resistor H+H R
0cd I
5 (127)
E
_ R
+ E
+ _
+ _
F
I
R 75
E
*The Sync module is rated for 3.0 amperes at 24 VDC.
11
0
Conductor size (AWG), length and capacity should be taken into consideration
Tamper Proof prior to design and installation. Mounting Options:
Strobe with Universal mounting Strobe with Universal mounting Strobe with Universal mounting Strobe with Universal mounting
plate and single gang box. plate and 4” square back box. plate and double gang box. plate and surface mount back box.
Ordering Information:
90 °
AMSECO’s ceiling and wall mount fire alarm Speaker/Strobe series
G
WA
IN
is designed to generate attention grabbing tones and voice 90° LL
IL
E
commands for emergency signaling evacuation applications.
°
°
Compound
90
90
Compound
These highly efficient low profile speakers are available with field Speaker/Strobe Combination 177cd.
45°
90°
45°
selectable taps ¼, ½, 1, 2 watts. The low profile speakers are R
E
FI
FI
R
STI N FI
R
available in two input voltage models 25 and 70.7 Vrms and can be LI
FI
E
E
UL
E
OF CA L IFOR
ULC R
R
TE
MEA
NI
ST
FI
A
E
installed on a standard 4” square back box. The strobe features a
ST
LL
T
A
E SH
FI R
E MAR
FI R E
E
E
S
RV I C
Pending FI R E
“FIRE” lettering and is polarized for connecting to supervised fire 45° 45°
Features:
FI
°
0°
alarm circuits. The strobe is designed with a xenon flash tube and
0°
* ADA / NFPA / ANSI Compliant
90
R
90
E
provides a high intensity output for maximum performance. The * UL Listed for Ceiling and Wall mounting under UL 1971 90°
0°
SSC-177 Speaker/Strobe Series is available in red or white housing * 177 candela output
models. * Speaker field selectable taps 1/4w, 1/2w, 1w, 2 watts
90 °
0°
45°
90°
45°
The Strobe can be synchronized by using the SMD10-3A sync * Available 25Vrms and 70.7Vrms models Compound Compound
module to comply with NFPA recommendations concerning * Screw terminals capacity up to 12 AWG. Speaker specifications:
photosensitive epilepsy when installing 2 or more visual appliances * Frequency range 400 Hz ~ 4,000 Hz.
within the field of view. The strobe signals are listed for indoor use, Rated Input Voltage 25V 70.7V
* Integral blocking capacitor for line supervision
ceiling and wall mount, under UL 1971 Standard. ( V r.m.s./ 1kHz )
* Polarized strobes with wide listed voltage ranges
using filtered DC or unfiltered FWR input voltage Input Power (Watts) ¼ ½ 1 2 ¼ ½ 1 2
* Meets ADA guidelines for minimum one flash per/sec (1Hz) Impedance (k ohms) 2.5 1.25 0.62 0.31 20 10 5 2.5
* Strobe is polarized and rated at 24VDC Sound Pressure Level (dB/10ft) 75 78 81 84 75 78 81 84
How to Order: * Synchronization requires an AMSECO SMD10-3A (daisy- Frequency Response (Hz) 400 ~ 4,000
Chain) Sync Module
SSC25-177R * RBX-1back box skirt for surface mount (Optional)
Low Frequency Cut Off (Hz) 200
Operating Temperature Range 32°F ~ 120°F ( 0°C ~ 49°C )
* Available in red or white housing
25 = 25Vrms
70 = 70.7Vrms Room Spacing for Ceiling-Mounted Visible Appliances
177 = 177cd Using the Sync Module: Strobe Only Current Draw Table: Minimum Light Output by Room Size.
R = Red
FI DC FWR Maximum Maximum Room Size (ft.)
W = White R
E
Current (mA)
R
16V
E
Ordering Information: *The Sync module is rated for 3.0 amperes at 24 VDC.
4” square
x 2-1/8” deep RBX-1
Speaker Strobe Sync Speaker Strobe Mounting Housing back box.
Model back box
Voltage Output Module Selectable Taps Flash Rate Type Color skirt
Number (Optional)
3-3/8 (85.7)
(Vrms) (Candela) (Watts) (times/min)
SSC25-177R 25 177 SMD10-3A ¼, ½, 1, 2 60 Ceiling & Wall Red
SSC25-177W 25 177 SMD10-3A ¼, ½, 1, 2 60 Ceiling & Wall White
SSC70-177R 70.7 177 SMD10-3A ¼, ½, 1, 2 60 Ceiling & Wall Red R
E
FI
R
FI
E
SSC70-177W 70.7 177 SMD10-3A ¼, ½, 1, 2 60 Ceiling & Wall White
The speaker/strobe is listed for indoor use with a temperature operating range of 32 °F ~ 120°F (0°C ~ 49°C ) FI R E
90 °
tones and voice commands for emergency signaling evacuation
G
IN
IL
applications. These highly efficient low profile speakers are FI
E
E
R
R
F.A.C.P &
FI
E
available with field selectable taps ¼, ½, 1, 2 watts. The low profile Selectable 30cd, 75cd, 110cd.
°
°
Compound
90
90
Compound VOICE / EVAC
speakers are available in two input voltage models 25 and 70.7 TO NEXT DEVICE
45°
Strobe
_ SSpeaker
_
45°
STI N
LI or END-OF-LINE
UL ULC
FI R E
FI
G
OF C A L IFOR
A
Speaker Strobe
NI
ST
R -RESISITOR
R
FI
S+ S _ L+ L _
FI
E
E
ST
LL
R
R
series is designed with the exclusive Select-A-Strobe. The strobe
T
A
E SH
FIR
E MA R
FI
E
E
E
S
RV I C
alternating the candela output 30cd, 75cd and 110cd. The strobe * ADA / NFPA / ANSI Compliant 45°
FI R E
45°
housing is clearly labeled with “FIRE” lettering and is polarized for * UL Listed for Ceiling and Wall mounting under UL 1971 Sync Module
0°
°
0°
90
TO NEXT DEVICE
90
connecting to supervised fire alarm circuits. The strobe is * Three field selectable settings 30cd, 75cd and 110cd SMD10-3A or END-OF-LINE
designed with a xenon flash tube and provides a candela intensity * Speaker field selectable taps 1/4w, 1/2w, 1w and 2 watts _ IN_ OUT
_ -RESISITOR
H+ H + +
field selector switch for maximum performance. * Available 25Vrms and 70.7Vrms models
90 °
The Select-A-Speaker/Strobe Series is available in red or white * Screw terminals capacity up to 12 AWG 0°
45°
45°
Compound Compound
housing models. The Strobe can be synchronized by using the * Frequency range 400 Hz ~ 4,000 Hz Speaker specifications: *The Sync module is rated for 3.0 amperes at 24 VDC.
SMD10-3A sync module to comply with NFPA recommendations * Integral blocking capacitor for line supervision
concerning photosensitive epilepsy when installing 2 or more * Polarized strobes with wide listed voltage ranges Rated Input Voltage 25V 70.7V
visual appliances within the field of view. The strobe signals are using filtered DC or unfiltered FWR input voltage ( V r.m.s./ 1kHz )
listed for indoor use, ceiling and wall mount, under UL 1971 * Meets ADA guidelines for minimum one flash per/sec (1Hz).
Standard. Input Power (Watts) ¼ ½ 1 2 ¼ ½ 1 2
* All models mount to 4” square back box
* Strobes are polarized and rated at 24VDC. Impedance (k ohms) 2.5 1.25 0.62 0.31 20 10 5 2.5
* Synchronization requires an AMSECO SMD10-3A (daisy Sound Pressure Level (dB/10ft) 75 78 81 84 75 78 81 84
How to Order: chain) Sync Module Frequency Response (Hz) 400 ~ 4,000
SSC25-3075110R * RBX-1 back box skirt for surface mount (optional) Low Frequency Cut Off (Hz) 200
* Available in red or white housing Operating Temperature Range 32°F ~ 120°F ( 0°C ~ 49 °C )
25 = 25Vrms
70 = 70.7Vrms Room Spacing for Ceiling-Mounted Visible Appliances
Strobe Selectable Candela: Strobe Only Current Draw Table: Minimum Light Output by Room Size.
3075110 = 30cd, 75cd or 110cd
R = Red DC FWR Maximum Maximum Room Size (ft.)
Current (mA)
W = White 16V 24V 33V 16V 24V 33V Ceiling
Average 121 87 70 168 131 110 Height (ft.) 20 X 20 30 X 30 40 X 40 50 X 50
@30cd Peak 221 215 165 414 350 338 30 75cd. 75cd. 177cd. 177cd.
254 298 338 402 418 458 20 30cd. 75cd. 110cd. 177cd.
Application: In-Rush
H
C
3-3/8 (85.7)
SSC25-3075110R 25 30, 75, 110 SMD10-3A ¼, ½, 1, 2 60 Ceiling & Wall Red
SSC25-3075110W 25 30, 75, 110 SMD10-3A ¼, ½, 1, 2 60 Ceiling & Wall White
SSC70-3075110R 70.7 30, 75, 110 SMD10-3A ¼, ½, 1, 2 60 Ceiling & Wall Red FI
E
SSC70-3075110W 70.7 30, 75, 110 SMD10-3A ¼, ½, 1, 2 60 Ceiling & Wall White R
R
FI
E
The speaker/strobe is listed for indoor use with a temperature operating range of 32 °F ~ 120°F (0°C ~ 49°C )
FI R E
Specifications subject to change without notice. 6-7/8 (174) 1-49/64 (45) 1 (25.5) 3-3/8 (85.7)
2-25/32 (70)
Hochiki America Corporation
7051 Village Drive, Suite 100 Buena Park, CA 90621-2268
Phone: 714/522-2246 Fax: 714/522-2268
Hochiki America Corporatrion : SSC-3075110
Technical Support: 800/845-6692 or technicalsupport@hochiki.com 06/2003 Specifications subject to change without notice.
Engineering Specifications:
The visual alarm indicating appliance shall be AMSECO model SL24C-177 or equivalent device. The Strobe shall be listed under UL 1971 Standard for
signaling devices for the hearing impaired and shall be approved for fire protective service. The candela output shall be 177cd. The strobe shall be
UL1971 listed for both ceiling and wall mount applications. The signaling Strobe shall operate on 24VDC from a non-coded regulated DC supply or full-
SL24C-177 wave rectified, unfiltered supply. The signaling strobe shall be designed to produce a signal flash of one flash per second with continuously applied
minimum voltage. When strobe synchronization is required, the strobe shall be compatible with the AMSECO SMS1-3A or SMD10-3A or other source of
Ceiling and Wall Mount Strobe AMSECO sync protocol. The Strobe shall be capable of CEILING and WALL mount ing to a 4’’ x 4’’ x 1-1/2’’ back box. Signaling devices shall be installed
in all sleeping and non/sleeping areas as per plans and specifications.
Description:
AMSECO’s Ceiling and Wall mount strobe is designed to comply Light Output Dispersion:
with the Americans with Disability Act (ADA) and meet UL
90 °
WA
G
Standard 1971 requirements for emergency signaling devices 90 ° LL
N
LI
EI
for the hearing impaired. The SL24C-177 strobe round housing
°
°
90
90
design offers a low profile appearance and is clearly labeled with Compound Compound
“FIRE” lettering to be view from all angles. These appliances are FI 90 °
45 °
E FI
R
45 °
polarized for connecting to supervised fire alarm circuits. The
R
FI
E
FI
strobe is designed with a xenon flashtube and provides a 177 Strobe 177cd. E
R
R
FI
E
candela intensity output for maximum performance.
FIRE
FIRE
UL
S TI N
LI
G
OF CAL IFOR
ULC TE
MEA
NI
ST
A
45 ° 45 °
FIRE
ST
LL
housing 24V DC models. T
A
E SH
FI R
E M AR
E
E
S
RV IC
FI
°
90
The SL24C-177 can be synchronized by using the SMD10-3A
R
90
E
0°
0°
Sync Module to comply with NFPA recommendations 90 °
concerning photosensitive epilepsy when installing 2 or more
0°
Features:
visual appliances within the field of view. The strobe signals are * ADA/NFPA/ANSI Compliant. 0°
90 °
90 °
listed for indoor use, ceiling and wall mount, for sleeping and * UL listed for Ceiling and Wall mounting under UL1971.
45 °
45 °
non/sleeping areas under UL 1971 Standard. * Screw terminal capacity up to 12 AWG. Compound Compound
* 24V DC strobe with 177cd output. Using the Sync Module:
* Polarized strobes with wide listed voltage ranges using Sync Module Room Spacing for Ceiling-Mounted Visible Appliances
Application: Filtered DC or unfiltered FWR input voltage. F.A.C.P. SMD10-3A FI
Minimum Light Output by Room Size.
Signal E To Next Device or
The SL24C-177 Ceiling Strobe Series is recommended for use * Meets ADA guidelines for minimum one flash per/sec (1Hz). R
R
Circuit IN OUT Maximum
FI
End-Of Line-
E
in areas such as: warehouses, meeting rooms, schools, * Munts to 4” square, back box. _ _ _ _ Resistor Maximum Room Size (ft.)
+ H+H + + Ceiling
corridors, apartments, office buildings, restaurants, hotels, and * 24 volt strobe models. 20 X 20 30 X 30 40 X 40 50 X 50
+ _
Height (ft.)
FIRE
any other application where effective visual warning is required * Designed for sleeping and non/sleeping areas.
* Synchronization requires an AMSECO SMS1-3A or 30 75cd. 75cd. 177cd. 177cd.
by Federal, State, or local authority having jurisdiction.
SMD10-3A (daisy chain) Sync Module. 20 30cd. 75cd. 110cd. 177cd.
* RBX-1 back box skirt for surface mount (optional) *The Sync module is rated for 3.0 amperes at 24 VDC. 10 30cd. 30cd. 75cd. 110cd.
Strobe Wiring: * The SPC-1 retrofit plate allows mounting to a variety of back
boxes (optional). Mounting:
FI
* Available in red or white housing. *The SPC-1 Universal Retrofit Plate is designed for mounting to a variety of back boxes.
Control E To Next Device *Surface mount installations, use the RBX-1 Back Box Skirt.
R
R
or End-Of Line-
FI
Panel
E
4” square
FIRE
Wiring Terminals: back box
4” square
back box RBX-1
RBX-1 RBX-1 RBX-1
Current Draw Table:
DC FWR
Current (mA)
16V 24V 33V 16V 24V 33V
Average 378 245 185 468 332 264
@ 177cd Peak 584 428 380 844 804 700
In-Rush 460 476 508 788 828 716 Dimensions: Inches (mm)
Ordering Information:
Model Input Strobe Sync Mounting Flash Operating Housing
3-3/8 (85.7)
Number Voltage Output Module Type Rate Voltage Range Color
(VDC) (Candela) (Times/min.) (VDC)
SL24C-177R 24 177 SMD10-3A Ceiling / Wall 60 16 ~ 33 Red
SL24C-177W 24 177 SMD10-3A Ceiling / Wall 60 16 ~ 33 White
The strobe is listed for indoor use with a temperature operating range of 32°F ~ 120°F (0°C ~ 49°C ) 6-7/8 (174) 1-13/32 (35) 3-3/8 (85.7)
2-25/32 (70)
Specifications subject to change without notice.
The NS6 and NS4 Series is designed specifically for use with
HOCHIKI Conventional Models SIJ-24 Ionization Smoke Detector,
SLR-24V Photoelectric Smoke Detector, SLR-24H Photoelectric with
Heat Smoke Detector, SLR-835 Photoelectric Smoke Detector, SLR-
835H Photelectric Smoke Detector w/heat, or DCD-135/190 Fixed
Temperature/Rate-of-Rise Heat Detector. The Base is an electronics
free 6" base featuring a plastic tamper-lock lug. Each base is
N S Series B ases Alarm C urrent ID
equipped with a resistor. Refer to the chart (left) for additional
specifications. The NS4 base is a 4" version of the NS6 base.
NS6-224 OR NS4-224 43mA (70mA @ 33.0V MAX) HB-5
* Requi res external current li mi ti ng to 150mA maxi mum. Models HSC-224R, HSC-220R and the HSC-221R are designed
specifically for use with the HOCHIKI Conventional Models SIJ-24,
HSC- (X)R RELAY BASE & SLR-24V, SLR-24H, SLR-835, SLR-835H or DCD-135/190. The
HSC- 4R 4 WIRE BASE HSC-(X)R series is a 6" base with two sets of Form "C" relay
contacts.
Models HSC-224R, HSC-220R and the HSC-221R are also
approved for use with HOCHIKI previous Conventional Models
SIH-24F, SLK-24F, SLK-24FH and the DFE 135/190.
4 Wire B ase Alarm C urrent ID The HSC-4R12 is designed specifically for 12 volt 4 wire applications
HSC -4R 43mA (58mA @ 30.0V MAX) N/A using HOCHIKI Conventional Models SLR-835, SLR-835H. The 6"
HSC -4R12 47mA (75mA @ 18.0V MAX) N/A diameter base is current limited. Relay contact place a direct short
occurs across the loop when the detector is actuated.
HSC- (X) L LATCHING LED BASE Model HSC-4R12 is also approved for use with previous HOCHIKI
Conventional Models SLK-835, SLR-835, and SLR-835H.
The HSC-L Base Series is designed specifically for use with the
HOCHIKI Fixed Temperature Heat Detectors Models
DFE-135/ 190.
The HSC-L Series is a 6" base featuring a current limiting
2 Wire Latching Alarm C urrent ID
resistor, latching annunciator output and a latching circuit so the
HSC -224L 35-42mA @ 24V (54mA MAX) HB-62
alarm LED will remain lit until the control panel has been reset.
67-80mA @ 24V
HSC -220L HB-64
(88.5mA @ 26.5VD C MAX)
We try to keep our product information up-to-date and accurate. However, we cannot cover all specifications or
anticipate all requirements. For additional information contact your local distributor or Hochiki America Corporation.
UL LISTED
CONTROL LISTED
PANEL END OF LINE
DEVICE
UL LISTED LISTED
CONTROL END OF LINE
PANEL
DEVICE
GRY
BLU PIGTAIL AUXILLIARY
GRN CONTACTS
HSC- (X) R SERIES YEL
ORN TWO FORM "C"
PUR
LISTED
END OF LINE
RELAY
HA-EOLR-12 OR HA-EOLR-24
UL LISTED
POWER
SUPPLY
12VDC OR 24VDC
H1
H2 H1,H2 - TERMINAL
YEL PIGTAIL AUXILLIARY CONTACTS
ORN
PUR ONE FORM "C"
HSC-4R OR HSC-4R12
2-WIRE OPERATION
COMPATIBLE
UL LISTED
CONTROL LISTED
PANEL 6 END OF LINE
DEVICE
PANEL
POWER Pig Tail Lead
SUPPLY HSC-(X) L SERIES NS6 SERIES
NEGATIVE
We try to keep our product information up-to-date and accurate. However, we cannot cover all specifications or anticipate all
requirements. For additional information contact your local distributor or Hochiki America Corporation.
Hochiki America Corporation • Conventional Detector Bases Specifications subject to change without notice.
SBC - CONVENTIONAL SOUNDER BASE
DESCRIPTION
EOL
INITIATING
LOOP RESISTOR
UL
LISTED
CONTROL
PANEL
NEXT DEVICE
TOP VIEW
OR
CONVENTIONAL SOUNDER BASE 12V/24V WITHOUT RELAY (2 WIRE) SBC-2
EOL
P57
20
1
P57
20
1
RELAY
+12 +12
-12 -12
12V/24V NEXT NEXT
AUX J2
J4
J2
J4
S1 S1
8 8
7 7
6 6
J3
5
J3
S 8 S 8
5
05 4 05 4
S 3 S 3
D D
G 2 G 2
CO 1 1 CO 1 1
AL AL
GRY
GRY
ON ON
VLT
VLT
BRN
BRN
GRN
GRN
ORG
YEL
ORG
YEL
RED
RED
BLK
BLK
WHT
WHT
BOTTOM VIEW
20
20
1
1
NC NC
NO NO EOL
COM COM RELAY
24V ONLY + 12 + 12
J2
J2
AUX - 12 - 12
NEXT NEXT
J4
J4
S1
J3
S1
J3
8
8
7
8S
8S
05
6
05
DS
5
WHT
S
BLK
G
5
RED
ORG
4
GD
WHT
CO
BLK
YEL
GRN
RED
4
ORG
BRN
3
VLT
AL
YEL
GRY
CO
GRN
BRN
2
AL
VLT
GRY
1 1
1
ON
1
ON
NOTES: FOR ADDITIONAL SOUNDER WIRING DIAGRAM SBC-2, AND SBC-2R INFORMATION, PLEASE REFER TO
INSTALLATION INSTRUCTION HA-06-085.
UL LISTED
12V/24V EOL
POWER RELAY
SUPPLY
12V: SBC-4/12
24V: SBC-4/24
NEXT DEVICE
TOP VIEW
M
M
P572
P5
7203
03
INITIATING
G
LOOP NC NC
F
NO NO
J2
J2
COM COM
+ 12 + 12
UL - 12 - 12
NEXT NEXT
J4
J4
LISTED
CONTROL
J3
J3
PANEL
WH
BLK
RE
S1
S1
ORG
T
YEL
GRN
D
BLK
RE
BLK
WHT
RE D
BLK
5
5
RED
D
ORG
4
4
YEL
GRN
3
3
BLK
RED
BLK
2
2
RED
1
1
1
1
ON
ON
BOTTOM VIEW
NOTES: FOR ADDITIONAL SOUNDER WIRING DIAGRAM SBC-4 INFORMATION, PLEASE REFER TO INSTALLATION
INSTRUCTION HA-06-086.
Hochiki America Corporation Conventional Sounder Base Specifications subject to change without notice.
DH-98 CONVENTIONAL DUCT DETECTOR
STANDARD FEATURES
• Detects and limits the spread of smoke throughout
building HVAC ducts
• Ability to interconnect (all relays operate wth a single
alarm) up to 30 units using the same independent
power supply
• Compatible with building automation and fire
alarm systems
• Installs quickly and easily
• Interchangeable “Plug-In” photoelectric or
ionization heads
• No screens or filters to clean
• Cover provides magnet window and
placement guide for operational testing without
Duct housing is available with either a conventional
photoelectric or ionization detector. disassembly
• Rugged gray steel back box with clear cover
• Accessories - Remote power, remote alarm
SPECIFICATIONS indication capability and remote, horn/piezo
Duct Detector Model # DH-98-I DH-98-P DH-98-HVI DH-98-HVP
capability
Operating Voltage 115V AC,
24V AC/DC
115V AC,
24V AC/DC
230V AC,
24V AC/DC
230V AC,
24V AC/DC
• Meets UL 268A Requirements
Detector Head Model SIJ-24DH
Conventional
SLR-24DH
Conventional
SIJ-24DH
Conventional
SLR-24DH
Conventional
DESCRIPTION
Detector Head Type Ionization Photoelectric Ionization Photoelectric
Power Requirements 230 VAC 8mA 8mA The HOCHIKI AMERICA DH-98 Duct Smoke Detector
Standby
115 VAC 14mA 14mA provides early detection of smoke and products of
24 VAC 20mA 20mA 20mA 20mA combustion present in air moving through HVAC ducts in
Power Requirements
24 VDC 13mA 13mA 13mA 13mA
Commercial, Industrial and Residential applications. The
230 VAC 15mA 15mA
Alarm
115 VAC 28mA 28mA
DH-98 is designed to prevent the recirculation of smoke in
24 VAC 95mA 95mA 95mA 95mA
areas by the air handling systems, fans and blowers.
24 VDC 60mA 60mA 60mA 60mA Complete systems may be shut down in the event of smoke
Alarm Contacts 1 form "C" and 1 form "C" and 1 form "C" and 1 form "C" and detection. The HOCHIKI AMERICA DH-98-I and the DH-
1 form "A" rated
at 10 amps @
1 form "A" rated
at 10 amps @
1 form "A" rated
at 10 amps @
1 form "A" rated
at 10 amps @
98-P operate on 115 VAC, 24 VAC and 24 VDC and the
115 V.A.C. 115 V.A.C. 115 V.A.C. 115 V.A.C. DH-98-HVI and the DH-98-HVP operate on 230 VAC, 24
Detection Loop 1 Form A (1A) 1 Form A (1A) 1 Form A (1A) 1 Form A (1A) VAC and 24 VDC.
Trouble Contacts 1 Form "C" 1 Form "C" 1 Form "C" 1 Form "C"
Sensitivity Test Method Dual Reed Self Diagnostic Dual Reed Self Diagnostic
Switch Test Test Switch Test Test The DH-98 is designed and built to meet all local
Remote Indication Capability Power, Alarm, Power, Alarm, Power, Alarm, Power, Alarm, requirements, as well as the NFPA regulations regarding
(Refer to DH-98 Accessories Horn/Piezo, Horn/Piezo, Horn/Piezo, Horn/Piezo,
Data Sheet for Specifications) Test Test Test Test duct smoke detectors. Output terminals are provided for
Air Velocity 300 to 4000 ft./min remote accessories such as a horn, strobe, remote status
Ambient Temperature 32°F to 120°F (0°C to 49°C) indicators and reset key switches or push buttons.
Humidity 10% to 85% Relative Humidity (non-condensing)
Housing Material 18 G.A. steel backbox, clear plastic cover PRODUCT LISTINGS
Finish Grey Paint
Underwriters Laboratories: S1383
Dimensions 9 1/8"L X 7 1/4"W X 2 1/4"H
Radioactive Element DH-98-I and DH-98-HVI Only: Americum 241 0.5 Mirco-Curie
Continued on back.
The compact DH-98 contains 3 sets of alarm contacts, 1 set of form “C” contacts rated at 10 amps, 1 set of form “A”
contacts rated at 10 amps, 1 set of form “A” contacts rated at 1 amp. There is also 1 set of form “C” 10 amp trouble
contacts for monitoring detector head removal, and the failure of the input supply voltage.
The pilot and alarm visual indicators provided on the front of the DH-98 duct unit, signal the operating status of the
device. A manual test/reset switch is located along side the visual indicators. This switch can be defeated by cutting
a jumper on the PCB.
ENGINEERING SPECIFICATIONS
Air duct smoke detectors shall be HOCHIKI AMERICA DH-98 Series. The detectors shall be listed by Underwriters
Laboratories per UL 268A. The detectors shall operate at air velocities from 300 feet per minute to 4000 feet per minute.
The detectors shall have the ability to interconnect up to 30 units using the same independent power supply.
The duct detector housings shall be of metal construction and complete mechanical installation may be performed
without removal of detector cover. Visual indication of alarm and power must be provided on detector front. A manual
reset switch shall be located on front of the device. Detector heads shall not require additional filters or screens which
must be maintained. The housing shall contain a detector base which will accept photoelectric or ionization detector
heads. Terminal connections shall be of the screw type and be a minimum of # 6 screw. Terminals shall be provided for
remote pilot, remote alarm indication, strobe/horn and remote key switch. All wiring must comply with local codes and
regulations. See
Power
ALARM
CONTACTS
ALARM
CONTACTS
*TROUBLE
CONTACTS
REMOTE
ACCESSORIES
Connections 10.0A @ 115VAC 1A @ 24VDC 10.0A @ 115VAC
WIRING DIAGRAMS
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
24 VDC 60 Hz INPUT
24 VAC 60 Hz INPUT @ 0.1 AMP MAX.(Detector only).
@ 0.1 AMP MAX.(Detector only). UP TO 1.9 AMPS FOR AUXILIARY
UP TO 1.9 AMPS FOR AUXILIARY OUTPUTS (HORNS/STROBES).
OUTPUTS (HORNS/STROBES).
- +
1 2 3 4 5 6 1 2 3 4 5 6
DH-98-I DH-98-I
DH-98-P DH-98-P
24 V.A.C. OPERATION 24 V.D.C. OPERATION
G N H G N H
1 2 3 4 5 6 1 2 3 4 5 6
DH-98-I DH-98-HVI
DH-98-P DH-98-HVP
115 V.A.C. OPERATION 230 V.A.C. OPERATION
INPUT P
POWER
P
Hochiki America Corporation DH-98 Conventional Specifications subject to change without notice.
NSRT / NSTT
SMOKE DETECTOR REMOVAL TOOL / TESTER
STANDARD FEATURES
NSRT
NSTT
SPECIFICATIONS
Detector Tester/Removal Tool
Dimensions
NSRT HEAD: 4.0" D x 2.0" H
NSTT HEAD: 4.0" D x 1.5" H
Material Highly durable PVC
molded plastic
Color Black - provides visible contrast
Alignment
NSRT HEAD: One side for arrow labels for
easy visibility, one side for
removal from base.
NSTT HEAD: One side for sensitivity testing.
NSTT HEAD
Extension Pole
Dimensions Pole extends to 15'
Material Stainless steel with easy grip
black handle
NSTT-A100 WITH 15' POLE
(COMPLETE) Specifications subject to change without notice.
NSTT-A100
The SIJ-24 and SLR-24/-835 series detectors, manufactured with magnetically activated dual reed switches for sensitivity
testing, can be sensitivity tested with the NSTT-A100. This meets the requirements of a UL listed calibrated test
without the use of combustion materials.
The NSTT-A100 is in compliance with the test requirements outlined in the NFPA 72 Inspection, Testing and Maintenance,
Chapter 7.
SPECIFICATIONS
DESCRIPTION
STANDARD FEATURES
The Dual Relay Module (R2M), has been designed to
• Provides two independently configurable Form C provide flexibile and quick response to emergency
contacts per address conditions. The R2M allows independent control of
• Contacts are rated 1.0 Amps @ 30 VDC or 0.5 Amp two form C contacts for a variety of normally open and
@ 125 VAC normally closed contact applications such as fan
• Up to127 devices can be used on each SLC loop operation, elevator recall, door closure, and auxiliary
notification.
• Visible Bi-colored LED is software controlled and
can be programmed to blink red or green when
polled. The LED can be latched on when activated Each R2M module provides independent control of two
Form C contacts while utilizing one SLC (Signaling
• Programming is highly flexible providing 16 priority
Line Circuit) address. The R2M module has a highly
states plus zoning capability
configurable programming algorithm that allows the
user to setup groups of devices (zoning) for simulta-
neous operation of multiple R2M modules. Each
module has 16 priority states that are programmed.
The operating parameters are maintained by the
module and do not require individual communication
with the control panel during the emergency condition
to operate. The control panel broadcasts the control
command on the SLC loop and the R2M modules do
PRODUCT LISTINGS
the rest based on their custom configuration. Since
Underwriters Laboratories: S5694 mechanically latching relays are used within the R2M
Underwriters Laboratories of Canada: CS943 module, a separate 24VDC power source is not
CSFM #: 7300-0410:150 required.
FM#: 3022559
MEA Report # 284-91-E Vol. IV
The contractor shall furnish and install where indicated on the plans, the Hochiki DCP-R2M addressable relay
module. The modules shall be UL listed compatible with Hochiki Digital Communications Protocol (DCP) supporting
control panel loops. The relay module must provide two Form C dry contacts rated at 1A @ 30 VDC or 0.5A @ 125
VAC. The relay module must be suitable for mounting in a standard 4" square electrical box. The relay module
must provide a bi-colored LED for indication of status.
WIRING DIAGRAM
DCP-R2M NO1
OUT TO NEXT MODULE S, SC WIRING SERIAL NO. XXXXXXXXX
POWER LIMITED
COM1 SET 1
2
TB1
POWER
LIMITED
TYPE NOT
USED
COM2 SET 2
S5694
NC2
SIGNALING DEVICE
ISSUE NO. AH-9769 B
The contractor shall furnish and install where indicated on the plans, the Hochiki DCP-SCI short circuit isolator. The
modules shall be UL listed compatible with Hochiki Digital Communications Protocol (DCP) supporting control panel
loops. The isolator module must be suitable for mounting in a standard 4" square electrical box. The isolator
module must provide a yellow LED for indication of status.
WIRING DIAGRAM
TB1
SER. NO. XXXXXXXXX
UL LISTED
SIGNALING DEVICE
ISSUE NO. AH-9774
(IN) S
DCP-SCI
(IN) SC
(OUT) SC
(OUT) S
COMPATIBLE
S5694
CONTROL
PANEL
TB1
SIGNALING DEVICE
ISSUE NO. AH-9774
LISTED
(IN) S
DCP-SCI
(IN) SC
(OUT) S
GROUP OF VARIOUS DCP MODULES
(OUT) SC
-
S5694
(OUT) SC
(OUT) S
(IN) SC
(IN) S
Overview
• This power supply/charger converts a 115VAC / 60Hz input, to a 12VDC
or 24VDC regulating output.
FN-300ULX
• 12VDC or 24VDC @ 2.5 amp.
11.00” 1.20”
1.40”
AC fails.
• Maximum charge current .7 amp. 5.10”
6.50”
3.25”
Agency Approvals
UL 294 UL Listed for Access Control MEA - NYC Department of
System Units. Buildings Approved.
UL 603 UL Listed Standard for Power
Supplies for Use with Burglar-
Alarm Systems. CSFM - California State Fire
Marshal Approved.
UL 1069 UL Listed Hospital Signaling and
Nurse Call Equipment.
UL 1481 UL Listed Standard for Safety for
Fire Protective Signaling Systems.
02/2005
FN-400ULX Data Sheet
Rev. DSFN-400ULX - J24E
Overview
• This power supply/charger converts a 115VAC / 60Hz input, to a
12VDC or 24VDC regulating output.
FN-400ULX
• 12VDC @ 4 amp or 24VDC @ 3 amp supply current.
1.20”
0.5275”
1.40” 1.40”
AC fails. 6.50”
battery backup.
3.25” 11.00” 3.25”
Agency Approvals
UL 294 UL Listed for Access Control MEA - NYC Department of
System Units. Buildings Approved.
UL 603 UL Listed Standard for Power
Supplies for Use with Burglar-
Alarm Systems. CSFM - California State Fire
Marshal Approved.
UL 1069 UL Listed Hospital Signaling and
Nurse Call Equipment.
UL 1481 UL Listed Standard for Safety for FM - Factory Mutual Approved.
Fire Protective Signaling Systems.
02/2005
FN-600ULX Data Sheet
Rev. DSFN-600ULX - J24E
Overview
• This power supply/charger converts a 115VAC / 60Hz input, to a
12VDC or 24VDC regulating output.
FN-600ULX
• 12VDC or 24VDC @ 6 amp supply current.
0.75”
11.00” 1.20”
1.40” 1.40”
6.50”
1.25”
Agency Approvals
UL 294 UL Listed for Access Control CSFM - California State Fire
System Units. Marshal Approved.
UL 1481 UL Listed Standard for Safety for
Fire Protective Signaling Systems
FM - Factory Mutual Approved.
MEA - NYC Department of
Buildings Approved.
02/2005
FN-1024ULX Data Sheet
Rev. DSFN-1024ULX - J24E
Overview
• These power supply/chargers convert a 115VAC / 60Hz input, to a
24VDC regulating output.
FN-1024ULX
• Access Control applications:
24VDC @ 10 amp.
Fire Alarm applications:
24VDC @ 8 amp supply current w/10 amp during alarm.
2"
AC fails.
• Maximum charge current 3.6 amp.
• Zero voltage drop when switched over to
3.25"
15.5"
Agency Approvals
UL 294 UL Listed for Access Control MEA - NYC Department of
System Units. Buildings Approved.
UL 1481 UL Listed Standard for Safety for
Fire Protective Signaling Systems.
CSFM - California State Fire
Marshal Approved.
02/2005
FN-642-ULADA, FN-842-ULADA, FN-1042-ULADA
Data Sheet Rev. FN-642/842/1042-ULADA- J24E
Overview
Continued on back.
02/2005
Agency Approvals Enclosure Dimensions
18"H x 14.5"W x 4.625"D
UL 864 UL Listed Control Units and 14.5"
4.5"
1.5" 6.5" 4.0" 1.5"
1.25" 1.25"
1.0"
1.5"
1.5"
18"
18" 18"
10"
1.0" 1.0"
4.5"
1.25"
277-96-E
6911-1446:103
LISTED
Description: #S5661
The Hochiki VoiceNET High Rise Evacuation
System operates in conjunction with the Fire Alarm
Control Panel (FACP) in a building to provide
automatic response to life safety emergencies.
7051 Village Drive, Suite 100 Buena Park, CA 90621-2268 714.522.2246 www.hochiki.com
FNV-DP Voice Evacuation
Speaker Circuits
Distributed Panel
#18 AWG
F
I
R
E
F
I
R
E
F
I
R
Hochiki VoiceNET
E
F
I
True-Multiplex
R
E
TB1 TB1
TB2 TB2
System
TB3 TB3
Fire Phone
Fire Fire
NetComm Loop:
-Twisted Pair, Category 5
-4,000 Feet between panels
-50,000 Feet Total System Loop
-Data and 6 Audio Channels Simultaneously
-High Speed RS-485 Communications
-Style “4” or Style “7” Field Selectable
FNV-DP
Distributed Panel Voice Evacuation
Speaker Circuits
F
FNV-MP I
R
E
Master Panel
F
I
R
E
PAGING F
CONTROL
I
R
E
TB1 TB1
TB2 TB2
TB3 TB3
Fire Phone
Fire Fire
FNV-25/50/100 FNV-25/50/100
Phone Phone
11th Floor S S
P
AR
S S
10th Floor
P
AR
S S
9th Floor CM FNV-DP
P
AR
S S
8th Floor
P
AR
S S
7th Floor
P
AR
S S
6th Floor
P
AR
S S
5th Floor CM FNV-DP
P
AR
S S
4th Floor
P
AR
S S
3rd Floor P
AR
RS 485
DATA LOOP S S
2nd Floor
P
AR
S S
1st Floor FNV-MP FNV-DP
P
S S
Basement
P
The voice evacuation system shall be Hochiki Series VoiceNET FNV High Rise or approved
equal.
The VoiceNET FNV system shall include one Master Panel and one or more Distributed
Panels. The system shall be microprocessor based, and shall be compatible for use with
contact closures from the Fire Alarm Control Panel, (FACP). The system shall have a high-
speed communication bus and have the capacity for 6 channels of audio and data on a single
pair of wires. The field wiring for the communication bus may be configured for either Style "4"
or Style "7" supervision. The system shall have the capacity for Fire Fighters Phone, Area-of-
Rescue communication and also have the capacity for Fan & Damper control with monitored
feedback. The system shall have a minimum capacity of 2028 monitor and control points.
The Master Panel shall contain an integral microphone, dual channel digital message repeater,
(DMR) and digital tone generator, 120 VAC power supply, and battery charger. The system
shall be modular in design, and shall be expandable such that additional system control points
may be configured. The system shall include integral self-diagnostic routines that shall
continually monitor system status, and shall indicate the precise type of trouble conditions
should they occur in the system. A trouble condition within the system shall cause a trouble
indication to be transmitted to the FACP.
Distributed panels shall provide a minimum of 4 Class "B" speaker circuits, expandable to
sixteen total. Alternately, panel may be configured for 4 Class "A" speaker circuits, up to 8 total.
Panel may be configured for 1 to 8 amplifiers. Panel must provide up to 6 simultaneous audio
channels, up to 8 Fire Phone circuits, up to 4 Area of Refuge circuits and up to two
Control/Monitor loops. Amplifiers will contain their own power supplies, battery chargers and
provide auxiliary power for other components. Speaker circuits shall be supervised for short
and open circuit conditions, and shall be able to withstand transient or continuous short-circuit
conditions without damage to the system.
System may be configured for General Alarm All Call operation, Alarm by Zone or
Floor Above / Floor Below as required. Contact closures shall allow immediate broadcast of an
alarm signal and evacuation message to the appropriate area. Non-Alarm areas may receive
alert tones and messages as required or activated by the FACP.
The alarm signal/evacuation message shall be broadcast until the FACP is reset, or until
emergency personnel interrupt the broadcast with a manual page.
To prevent unauthorized tampering, the voice evacuation system shall disable the microphone
if the microphone is keyed continuously for 3 minutes or more. Systems that do not have this
feature shall not be acceptable.
Description:
LISTED
7051 Village Drive, Suite 100 Buena Park, CA 90621-2268 714.522.2246 www.hochiki.com
FNV MP64/P
Master Panel
Ribbon Cable Connection Detail
MMC
20 Pin Ribbon
1
2 J1
3
TB1
TB1 TB2
MFP P3 P5
SLC SLC P2 P2
2 1
DCC ASC
34 Pin Ribbon P4 P5
P1
P2
4 3
34 Pin Ribbon
34 Pin Ribbon
SSC
1 2 3
1
TB2 2
TB3
M
F PWR-2A TB1 TB2
I I/O
Card
TB1
1 2 3 IOI
Components mounted to
back plate inside of cabinet.
In the Master Panel system components are mounted to a removable back plate. The door and front panel are
removable. This enables field wiring to be installed cleanly.
Connections to the User Interface components ( Switch/LED banks, Mic/System control and Master Fire Phone)
is accomplished with ribbon cables. The front panel mounts separately on a continuous hinge so once installed
the access for system programming is easily accommodated.
NetComm Loop Wiring (Style 4)
IN FROM LAST PANEL RETURN TO MASTER
NetCom Bus
(Supervised)
P3
1
2 J1 P4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 2
3
J1
3
TB1 TB2 TB1 TB1 TB2 TB3 TB4 TB1 TB2
1 2 3 4
LED1
P5 P3
P3
TB5
P2
1 2 3 4
P1 P2 P2
TB6
MFP DCC ASC DCC
1 2 3 4
P5 P4
P4
P1
TB7
P2
MBR
LED1 LED2 LED3
LED1 LED2 LED3 P1 TB3 TB4 TB5
P1 TB3 TB4 TB5 P3 TB9
P3
1
2 J1 P4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 2
3
J1
3
TB1 TB2 TB1 TB1 TB2 TB3 TB4 TB1 TB2
1 2 3 4
LED1
P5 P3
P3
TB5
P2
1 2 3 4
P1 P2 P2
TB6
MFP DCC ASC DCC
1 2 3 4
P5 P4
P4
P1
TB7
P2
MBR
LED1 LED2 LED3
LED1 LED2 LED3 P1 TB3 TB4 TB5
P1 TB3 TB4 TB5 P3 TB9
FNV-SSC Switch Scan Card Included in basic panels, up to 7 additional cards may be
added.
FNV-SLC Switch LED Card 16 Switch LED Bank, up to 8 per FNV-SSC.
FNV-IOI Input Interface Card One included with basic panel, additional cards give 16 control
Technical Characteristics:
1 2 3 4
TB5 P3
1 2 3 4
P2
TB6
DCC
Up to 4 Minute Message Capacity DCC
1 2 3 4
P4
TB7
MBK
8 “B”
AMI
Works with Analog/Addressable and TB8
MBR
P1
TB2 11 TB2 11
J1 10 J1 10
9 9
8 8
1 TB3 7 1 TB3 7
2 6 2 6
3 J2 5 3 J2 5
4 4 4 4
5 YEL FAULT 1 2 3 3 5 YEL FAULT 1 2 3 3
6 2 6 2
7 GRN NORMAL 1 7 GRN NORMAL 1
8 8
RED ALARM RED ALARM
P2 P2
MESSAGE MIC MESSAGE MIC
GAIN GAIN GAIN GAIN
SN1 SN1
7051 Village Drive, Suite 100 Buena Park, CA 90621-2268 714.522.2246 www.hochiki.com
FNV
Distributed Panel
Connection Detail
10K
EOLR
Speaker Circuits
1 2 3 4
AMI
FPI
1 2 3 4
P14
10K
EOLR
1 2 3 4
P15
P3 P2 P1
DCC
MBR
TB3
TB8
P1 1234
TB9 TB11
Set EOLR
TB1 TB1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
TB2 11 TB2 11
J1 10 J1 10
9 9
8 8
1 TB3 7 1 TB3 7
2 6 2 6
3 J2 5 3 J2 5
4 4 4 4
5 YEL FAULT 1 2 3 3 5 YEL FAULT 1 2 3 3
6 2 6 2
7 GRN NORMAL 1 7 GRN NORMAL 1
8 8
RED ALARM RED ALARM
P2 P2
MESSAGE MIC MESSAGE MIC
GAIN GAIN GAIN GAIN
FNV-25E FNV-25E
SN1 SN1
S1 S1
FPI to MBR Connection AMI to Amplifier Connection
To left side
Amplifier
To right side
10 PIN RIBBON Amplifier
MBR J7
E
O
L 2 Eight Class "B" may
F
I
F
I
EOLR also be configured
R
E
R
E as 4 A / B circuits
E
O
L 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 F F
EOLR
I I
R R
E E
F F
I I
TB5 R
E
R
E
1 2 3 4
TB6
1 2 3 4
F F
I I
R R
E E
TB7
1 EOL
2 3 4 EOL
MBK#2
MBK#1
AMI
1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4
MBR TB1 TB2 TB3 TB4
1 2 3 4
TB8 TB5
FNV-MBK Motherboard Relay Card Expands MBR output 8 Class B or 4 Class A speaker circuits
FNV-FPI Fire Phone Interface Card Included in /P panels, up to 3 additional cards may be added
FNV-FPO Fire Phone Output Card Used with additional FNV-FPIs for termination
FNV-AMI Audio Module Interface Card Included with basic panel, additional cards give the ability to control
multiple modules or accommodate full 3 channel operation
Technical Characteristics:
Battery Charging: Maximum charging current from Backbox Dim: 14.5 x 27 x 4“ w•h•d
FNV-25/50 is 800mA. Maximum battery size is 17AHr. Color: Charcoal Grey•std Red•optional
FNV-100 Maximum battery size is 24AHr.
FNV-FJ
Ordering Information:
Model Number Description
LISTED
7051 Village Drive, Suite 100 Buena Park, CA 90621-2268 714.522.2246 www.hochiki.com
10K 1/2W
EOLR
10K 1/2W
EOLR
10K 1/2W
EOLR
EOLR
#22 AWG min.
Fire Phone Fire Phone
Handset Handset
Jack Jack
10K 1/2W
EOLR
(not shown)
1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2
TB1 TB2 TB3 TB
1 2 3 4
TB5
1 2 3 4
TB6
FPO Fire
1 2 3 4
Phone TB7
Loops
(Supervised)
MBR
/
10 Pin Ribbon Cable FPI
Cards plug into slots
available on MBR
First FPI allows 4 Fire Phone
Circuits off of MBR. Adding 2nd
FPI and an FPO allows 4
additional Fire Phone Circuits
(16 circuits max. in any FNV-DP)
277-96-E
6911-1446:103
LISTED
Description: #S5661
The Hochiki VoiceNET High Rise Evacuation
System operates in conjunction with the Fire Alarm
Control Panel (FACP) in a building to provide
automatic response to life safety emergencies.
7051 Village Drive, Suite 100 Buena Park, CA 90621-2268 714.522.2246 www.hochiki.com
FNV-DP Voice Evacuation
Speaker Circuits
Distributed Panel
#18 AWG
F
I
R
E
F
I
R
E
F
I
R
Hochiki VoiceNET
E
F
I
True-Multiplex
R
E
TB1 TB1
TB2 TB2
System
TB3 TB3
Fire Phone
Fire Fire
NetComm Loop:
-Twisted Pair, Category 5
-4,000 Feet between panels
-50,000 Feet Total System Loop
-Data and 6 Audio Channels Simultaneously
-High Speed RS-485 Communications
-Style “4” or Style “7” Field Selectable
FNV-DP
Distributed Panel Voice Evacuation
Speaker Circuits
F
FNV-MP I
R
E
Master Panel
F
I
R
E
PAGING F
CONTROL
I
R
E
TB1 TB1
TB2 TB2
TB3 TB3
Fire Phone
Fire Fire
FNV-25/50/100 FNV-25/50/100
Phone Phone
11th Floor S S
P
AR
S S
10th Floor
P
AR
S S
9th Floor CM FNV-DP
P
AR
S S
8th Floor
P
AR
S S
7th Floor
P
AR
S S
6th Floor
P
AR
S S
5th Floor CM FNV-DP
P
AR
S S
4th Floor
P
AR
S S
3rd Floor P
AR
RS 485
DATA LOOP S S
2nd Floor
P
AR
S S
1st Floor FNV-MP FNV-DP
P
S S
Basement
P
The voice evacuation system shall be Hochiki Series VoiceNET FNV High Rise or approved
equal.
The VoiceNET FNV system shall include one Master Panel and one or more Distributed
Panels. The system shall be microprocessor based, and shall be compatible for use with
contact closures from the Fire Alarm Control Panel, (FACP). The system shall have a high-
speed communication bus and have the capacity for 6 channels of audio and data on a single
pair of wires. The field wiring for the communication bus may be configured for either Style "4"
or Style "7" supervision. The system shall have the capacity for Fire Fighters Phone, Area-of-
Rescue communication and also have the capacity for Fan & Damper control with monitored
feedback. The system shall have a minimum capacity of 2028 monitor and control points.
The Master Panel shall contain an integral microphone, dual channel digital message repeater,
(DMR) and digital tone generator, 120 VAC power supply, and battery charger. The system
shall be modular in design, and shall be expandable such that additional system control points
may be configured. The system shall include integral self-diagnostic routines that shall
continually monitor system status, and shall indicate the precise type of trouble conditions
should they occur in the system. A trouble condition within the system shall cause a trouble
indication to be transmitted to the FACP.
Distributed panels shall provide a minimum of 4 Class "B" speaker circuits, expandable to
sixteen total. Alternately, panel may be configured for 4 Class "A" speaker circuits, up to 8 total.
Panel may be configured for 1 to 8 amplifiers. Panel must provide up to 6 simultaneous audio
channels, up to 8 Fire Phone circuits, up to 4 Area of Refuge circuits and up to two
Control/Monitor loops. Amplifiers will contain their own power supplies, battery chargers and
provide auxiliary power for other components. Speaker circuits shall be supervised for short
and open circuit conditions, and shall be able to withstand transient or continuous short-circuit
conditions without damage to the system.
System may be configured for General Alarm All Call operation, Alarm by Zone or
Floor Above / Floor Below as required. Contact closures shall allow immediate broadcast of an
alarm signal and evacuation message to the appropriate area. Non-Alarm areas may receive
alert tones and messages as required or activated by the FACP.
The alarm signal/evacuation message shall be broadcast until the FACP is reset, or until
emergency personnel interrupt the broadcast with a manual page.
To prevent unauthorized tampering, the voice evacuation system shall disable the microphone
if the microphone is keyed continuously for 3 minutes or more. Systems that do not have this
feature shall not be acceptable.
The base shall permit direct interchange with Hochiki America, SLR-24V photoelectric type smoke detector, SLR-24H
combination photoelectric/heat detector, and/or DCD-135/190 fixed temperature/rate-of-rise heat detectors. The base
shall be appropriate twistlock base NS-4 Series, NS-6 Series, HSC-4R or HSC-(X)R. In the event of partial or complete
retrofit, the SIJ-24 maybe used in conjunction with, or as a replacement for, Hochiki America detectors (SLK-24, SLK-
24FH and the SIH-24F) on most HSB and HSC base applications.
The smoke detector shall have two flashing status LEDs for visual supervision. When the detector is in standby
condition the LEDs will flash Green. When the detector is actuated, the flashing LEDs will latch on Red. The detector
may be reset by actuating the control panel reset switch.
The sensitivity of the detector shall be capable of being measured. It shall be possible to perform a functional test of the
detector without the need of generating smoke. The test method shall simulate effects of products of combustion in the
chamber to ensure testing of the detector electronics.
To facilitate installation, the detector shall be non-polarized. Voltage and RF transient suppression techniques shall be
employed to minimize false alarm potential. Auxiliary SPDT relays shall be installed where indicated.
The vandal-resistant, security locking feature shall be used in those areas as indicated on the drawing. The locking
feature shall be field removable when not required.
WARNING: Conduct testing only under Normal Standby conditions. Abnormal or Low Power conditions may
affect sensitivity. Always reset power prior to testing of next unit.
LED's
Figure 1 Figure 2
The base shall permit direct interchange with Hochiki America SLR-24V photoelectric detector, SIJ-24 ionization type
smoke detector and/or DCD-135/190 fixed temperature/rate-of-rise heat detectors. The base shall be appropriate twist-
lock base NS-4 Series, NS-6 Series, HSC-4R, or HSC-xxx R. In the event of partial or complete retrofit, the SLR-24
maybe used in conjunction with, or as a replacement for, Hochiki America detectors (SLK-24, SLK-24FH and the SIH-
24) on most HSB and HSC base applications.
The smoke detector shall have two flashing status LEDs for visual supervision. When the detector is in standby
condition the LEDs will flash Green. When the detector is outside the UL listed sensitivity window the LEDs will flash
Red. When the detector is actuated, the flashing LEDs will latch on Red. The detector may be reset by actuating the
control panel reset switch.
The sensitivity of the detector shall be capable of being measured. It shall be possible to perform a functional test of the
detector without the need of generating smoke. The sensitivity of the detector shall be monitored automatically and
continuously to verify that it is operating within the listed sensitivity range.
To facilitate installation, the detector shall be non-polarized. Voltage and RF transient suppression techniques shall be
employed to minimize false alarm potential. Auxiliary SPDT relays shall be installed where indicated.
The vandal-resistant, security locking feature shall be used in those areas as indicated on the drawing. The locking
feature shall be field removable when not required.
SLR-24H SENSITIVITY TEST FEATURE
The SLR-24H Photoelectric Smoke Detector has a built-in automatic sensitivity test feature.
4-WIRE OPERATION
(+)
INITIATING LISTED
CIRCUIT END OF LINE
DEVICE
HSC-4R
CONTACTS
(-) H1
H2
YEL
ORN
PUR
HSC-4R HSC-4R
2-WIRE OPERATION
UL LISTED (+)
CONTROL LISTED
PANEL END OF LINE
DEVICE
(-)
PANEL Resistor shown is for example
POWER only. Not all annunciators have
in line resistance.
SUPPLY
(-) NOTE: - WIRING TERMINALS FOR THE NS4
NEGATIVE AND NS6 ARE IDENTICAL
NS4 SERIES NS6 SERIES - BASES WITH THE "W" SUFFIX
Annunciation device must be current limited to 20 mA @ ARE WHITE IN COLOR
24VDC Maximum. Not limiting current could result in
damage to the detector or cause a no alarm condition.
4-WIRE OPERATION
INITIATING LISTED
CIRCUIT END OF LINE
DEVICE
HSC-4R
CONTACTS
H1
H2
YEL
ORN
PUR
UL LISTED
POWER
SUPPLY LISTED
24VDC END OF LINE
RELAY
HA-EOLR-24
HSC-4R HSC-4R
2-WIRE OPERATION
UL LISTED
CONTROL LISTED
PANEL END OF LINE
DEVICE
HSC-(XXX)R (2-WIRE)
COM 6
N/C 5 GRY
BLU
4
GRN
N/O YEL
ORN
HSC-RELAY SERIES N/O 3 PUR
APPLICATION
SPECIFICATIONS The HOCHIKI America SLR-835B Series can be used in
all areas where Photoelectric Smoke Detectors are re-
Light Source GaAlAs Infrared LED quired. It is suited for smoldering or flaming fires.
Operating Voltage Nominal: 12 VDC or 24 VDC
Working Voltage 8.0 - 35.0 VDC
OPERATION
(35.0 VDC Max)
Wave Form Filtered DC 15% Ripple Max. The SLR-835B Series photoelectric smoke detector
Alarm Current 150mA Maximum utilizes two bicolored LED's for indication of status. In
a normal standby condition the LED's flash Green every
Surge Current 200µA Maximum (2 wire)
3 seconds. When the detector senses that its sensitivity
Average Stand-By 38µA AVG @12 VDC
has drifted outside the UL listed sensitivity window the
Current 55µA AVG @24 VDC
LED's will flash Red every 3 seconds. When the detector
70µA AVG @35 VDC senses smoke and goes into alarm the status LED's
Ambient Temperature 32° F - 120° F (0° C - 49° C) will latch on Red.
Sensitivity Test Feature Automatic Sensitivity
Window Verification Test The unit is comprised of an LED light source and silicon
Compatibility Identifier HD-6 photo diode receiving element. In a normal standby
Order Codes condition, the receiving element receives no light from
2-Wire Detector & Trim Ring pulsing light source. In the event of fire, smoke enters
Bone SLR-835B-2 the detector and light is reflected from the smoke
White SLR-835B-2W particles to the receiving element. The light received is
converted to an electronic signal. Signals are processed
4-Wire Detector & Trim Ring
Bone SLR-835B-4 Continued on back.
White SLR-835B-4W
PRODUCT LISTINGS
Underwriters Laboratories: S1383
Factory Mutual: 3007144
Specifications subject to change without notice. CSFM #: 7272-0410:107
ENGINEERING SPECIFICATIONS
The contractor shall furnish and install where indicated on the plans HOCHIKI America SLR-835B direct-wire photoelectric
smoke detectors. The detector shall be UL listed compatible (2-wire model) with a UL listed fire alarm panel.
The smoke detector shall have green flashing status LEDs for visual supervision. When the detector is actuated, the
flashing LEDs will turn red and latch on steady. The detector may be reset by actuating the control panel reset switch.
The detector shall have a sensitivity window verification feature. If the sensitivity of the detector drifts outside its
approved window the LEDs will flash red to indicate an out of sensitivity condition.
The vandal resistant, security locking feature shall be used in those areas as indicated on the drawing. The locking
feature shall be field selectable.
It shall be possible to perform a functional test of the detector without the need of generating smoke. The method shall
simulate effects of products of combustion in the chamber to ensure testing of detector circuits.
Voltage and RF transient suppression techniques shall be employed to minimize false alarm potential.
WIRING DIAGRAMS
2-Wire Wiring Diagram
U.L. Listed
Power
Supply
*24VDC Listed
End-of-Line
Relay
12 or 24VDC
U.L. Listed
Power
Supply
*12VDC
* Use either 12 OR 24VDC . They cannot be used simultaneously.
DESCRIPTION
SPECIFICATIONS
The SLR-835BH Series photoelectric smoke detector
Light Source: GaAl AS Infrared LED utilizes two bicolored LEDs for indication of status. In a
Voltage: Nominal: 12 VDC or 24 VDC normal standby condition the LEDs flash Green every 3
Working: 8.0 - 35.0 VDC seconds. When the detector senses that its sensitivity
(35.0 VDC Max) has drifted outside the UL listed sensitivity window the
Wave Form: Filtered DC LEDs will flash Red every 3 seconds. When the detector
15% Ripple Max. senses smoke and goes into alarm the status LEDs
Alarm Current: 150mA Maximum will latch on Red.
Surge Current: 200µA Maximum (2 wire)
The unit is comprised of an LED light source and silicon
Average Stand-By 38µA AVG @12 VDC
photo diode receiving element. In a normal standby
Current: 55µA AVG @24 VDC
condition, the receiving element receives no light from
70µA AVG @35 VDC pulsing light source. In the event of fire, smoke enters
Ambient Temperature: 32° F - 120° F (0° C - 49° C) the detector and light is reflected from the smoke
Sensitivity Test Feature: particles to the receiving element. The light received is
Automatic Sensitivity Window Verification Test converted to an electronic signal. Signals are processed
Compatibility Identifier: HD-6 in the comparator, and when two consecutive signals
Heat Sensor: 135° F exceeding the basic level are received within a specific
period of time, the time delay circuit triggers the SCR
Order Codes: 2-Wire Detector & Trim Ring switch to activate the alarm signal. The Status LED
White: SLR-835BH-2W lights continuously during alarm period.
Bone: SLR-835BH-2
4-Wire Detector & Trim Ring PRODUCT LISTINGS
White: SLR-835BH-4W Underwriters Laboratories: S1383
Bone: SLR-835BH-4 Factory Mutual: 3012444
CSFM #: 7272-690-0410:107
Specifications subject to change without notice. Continued on back.
ENGINEERING SPECIFICATIONS
The contractor shall furnish and install where indicated on the plans HOCHIKI America SLR-835BH baseless photoelectric
smoke detectors. The combination detector head shall be UL listed compatible with an UL listed fire alarm panel.
The smoke detector shall have flashing status LED for visual supervision. When the detector is actuated, the
flashing LED will latch on steady at full brilliance. The detector may be reset by actuating the control panel
reset switch.
The vandal resistant, security locking feature shall be used in those areas as indicated on the drawing. The
locking feature shall be field selectable.
It shall be possible to perform a functional test of the detector without the need of generating smoke. The
method shall simulate effects of products of combustion in the chamber to ensure testing of detector circuits.
Voltage and RF transient suppression techniques shall be employed to minimize false alarm potential.
WIRING DIAGRAMS
U.L. Listed
Power
Supply
*24VDC Listed
End-of-Line
Relay
12 or 24VDC
U.L. Listed
Power
Supply
*12VDC
* Use either 12 OR 24VDC . They cannot be used simultaneously.
SPECIFICATIONS
STANDARD FEATURES
DESCRIPTION
• Flexible application.
• Quick response to emergency conditions. The Supervised Output Module (SOM), has been
• Operation parameters are maintained by the designed to provide application flexibility and quick
module, and individual communication with the response to emergency conditions. Flexibility is
control system during emergency conditions
provided by a wide range of operating modes, including
is not required.
supporting multi-zone operations, and/or functions, up
• Contacts are rated 2.0 Amps @ 30VDC.
to 16 different modulation patterns and multi-state
• Programming is highly flexible providing 16
priority states plus zoning capability. programming. The operating parameters for the SOM
Program status: are maintained by the module and do not require
• LED will flash red or green. individual communication with the control system
• Programmed device output is turned off, silenced, during emergency conditions to operate. The control
or programmed to modulate pattern. panel simply broadcasts system conditions on the
Signaling Line Circuit (SLC) and the SOMs do the rest
based upon the custom configuration. Each SOM
provides a Class B Individual Circuit rated for 2.0 Amp
@ 30 VDC. Each SOM also requires a 24 Volt power
source in addition to the SLC. Provide software
PRODUCT LISTINGS controlled LED indication: blinks green or red when
polled, or can be latched on.
Underwriters Laboratories: S5694
Underwriters Laboratories of Canada: CS943
CSFM #: 7300-0410:150
FM#: 3022559
MEA Report # 284-91-E Vol. IV
The contractor shall furnish and install where indicated on the plans, addressable Supervised Output Module (SOM).
The modules shall be UL listed and compatible with Hochiki FireNET fire alarm control panel. The device address
shall be electrically programmable and stored in EEPROM. A bi-colored LED shall indicate device status.
The SOM shall be supplied with a plastic cover and shall be suitable for mounting to a 4" square or double gang
electrical back box. The SOM shall provide a monitor LED that is visible from outside the cover plate.
WIRING DIAGRAM
U.L. LISTED
0400-01046
DEVICE
NOTIFICATION APPLIANCE CIRCUIT (NAC) E.O.L. DEVICE
E.O.L.
OUTPUT TO
COMPATIBLE
U.L. LISTED
DEVICES FOR
FIRE
PROTECTION
SIGNALING
SERVICE
DCP-SOM
OUT TO NEXT MODULE SER. NO. XXXXXXXXX TB2
U.L. LISTED REGULATED,
TB1 OUT TO POWER LIMITED SUPPLY FOR
2
24+
FIRE PROTECTION
NEXT SIGNALING SERVICE FOR
U.L. LISTED
SC MODULE AUDIBLE DEVICES. REFER
COMPATIBLE GND
TO CONTROL PANEL
FIRE CONTROL S MANUFACTURER'S
INSTALLATION
PANEL OUT+ INSTRUCTIONS.
1
WARNING!!!
USE ONLY FPL, FPLR, OR
FPLP WIRING IN ACCORDANCE
WITH ARTICLE 760 OF THE
NATIONAL ELECTRICAL CODE.
SPECIFICATIONS
DESCRIPTION
STANDARD FEATURES
The Hochiki Dual Monitor Module (DIMM) is designed
• Fast, reliable contact monitoring utilizing the for use on the FireNET analog addressable system.
Hochiki DCP (Digital Communications Protocol) It provides two independent contact monitoring cir-
• 127 devices can be used per DCP loop cuits while only utilizing one address on the SLC loop.
• Bi-colored indicating LED provides module status Up to 127 devices can be placed on a single SLC
loop. The device address is uniquely stored on an
• Dual input contact monitor
onboard EEPROM. The module can be programmed
• Can be programmed to monitor Normally Open to monitor normally open (NO) or normally closed
(NO) or Normally Closed (NC) contacts (NC) contact fire alarm and supervisory devices. The
• Operates on Class A or Class B SLC loop interrupt driven Digital Communication Protocol (DCP)
• Accepts up to 14 AWG wire combines maximum communication reliability and
• Mounts to 4" square gang box fast response to emergency conditions. The module
has a single bi-colored LED to indicate device sta-
tus. It fits into a standard 4" square or double gang
electrical back box.
PRODUCT LISTINGS
Underwriters Laboratories: S5694
CSFM #: 7300-0410:150
The contractor shall furnish and install where indicated on the plans, addressable contact monitoring modules
Hochiki DIMM. The modules shall be UL listed and compatible with the Hochiki FireNET fire alarm control panel.
The device address shall be electrically programmable and stored in EEPROM. A bi-colored LED shall indicate
device status.
WIRING DIAGRAM
U.L. LISTED
E.O.L. DEVICE 22K DCP-DIMM OUT TO NEXT MODULE
PART NUMBER Dual Input Monitor Module
0400-01000 TB2
TYPICAL WIRING FOR N/O CONTACTS ONLY
SER. NO. XXXXXXXXX -
+ +
TB1
Input A
E.O.L. DEVICE 22K
PART NUMBER
0400-01000 - S + + U.L. LISTED
COMPATIBLE
+ SC - - FIRE CONTROL
ANY NUMBER OF UL LISTED N/O CONTACT CLOSURE
DEVICES MAY BE USED . Input B PANEL
-
TYPICAL WIRING FOR N/C CONTACTS ONLY
S5694
CAUTION!
DO NOT CONNECT MORE
THAN ONE N/C CONTACT
TO AN INPUT!
alarm obscuration reference level, a fire signal is produced. A trouble signal is generated if the beam is more than 90%
obstructed (as opposed to partially obscured by smoke).
The microprocessor also provides compensation for a change in received signal value, with time, caused by contamination
of the optics. Since such a change with time appears as a slow change in the beam signal, the microcomputer
compensates in such a manner that the signal moves closer to the reference data at a rate approximately +1% per
hour. When this compensating capability reaches a limit, the microcomputer automatically generates a trouble signal.
A calibrated test filter is available upon request to test and verify the sensitivity setting of the projected beam smoke
detectors.
ENGINEERING SPECIFICATIONS
The contractor shall furnish and install, where indicated on the plans, HOCHIKI America SPB-24N Projected Beam
Smoke Detector. The detector shall have a range of 32.8 feet to 328 feet. The projected beam smoke detector shall be
field adjustable to one of the three obscuration settings of 25%, 50% or 70% per span. These settings shall be capable
of being verified with calibrated filters. Side to side spacing shall be a maximum of 60 feet on center.
The projected beam smoke detector shall posses circuitry that automatically compensates for normal ambient changes
in the intensity of the emitted beam strength. The microprocessor shall provide compensation for a change in received
signal value, with time, caused by contamination of the optics. Since such a change with time appears as a slow
change in the beam signal, the microcomputer compensates in such a manner that the signal moves closer to the
reference data at a rate of approximately +1% per hour. When this compensating capability reaches a limit, the
microcomputer automatically generates a trouble signal.
The projected beam smoke detector(s) shall also signal a trouble condition if the beam has a blockage of 90% or more
than 20 seconds and automatically resets to normal when blockage is removed.
The projected beam smoke detector(s) shall be UL listed for these applications. Voltage and RF transient protection
shall be integral to the internal circuitry of the projected beam smoke detector so as to minimize false alarm potential.
To facilitate easy installation and setup, the projected beam smoke detectors shall employ signal strength indicating
LED's. Alignment shall be facilitated by turning an alignment adjustment wheel and monitoring the relative signal
strength based upon which LEDs are illuminated.
The detectors shall also illuminate a red LED, which is visible externally, when an alarm condition is indicated.
The projected beam smoke detector shall provide a Form "A" dry contact for alarm and Form "B" dry contact for trouble.
INSTALLATION
The HOCHIKI America SPB-24N Projected Beam Smoke Detector shall be installed in accordance with the Installation
Instruction Guide provided with every unit. Refer to the applicable NFPA Standards for additional guidance on spacing,
irregular ceiling surfaces and other design considerations.
EOL-24
End of Line
24V + 24V 24V 24V 24V Resistor
24V - 0V 0V 0V 0V
F1 F1 F1 F1
Zone +
Zone - F2 F2 F2 F2
T1 T2 T1 T2
Control
Panel NOTE: EOLR-24 required
for power supervision.
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The Photoelectric reflective beam detector consists of
STANDARD FEATURES the SRA-24 unit and a reflector, which face each other
• Detector spacing from 25ft-100ft. at a distance of between 25ft and 100ft.
• Pulsed beam to reduce overall consumption and In the event of fire the smoke generated will decrease
improve the noise rejection characteristics. the amount of near infrared light energy on the
• Small flat reflector. SRA-24, this decrease is electronically interpreted to
• Automatic drift compensation.
identify the occurrence of fire. An important feature of
• Fire detection sensitivity can be set to 20% or
the detector is that it monitors the protected space
30% obscuration.
linearly. This enables the detector to identify a fire
before it spreads, even when the smoke is scattered
over a large area.
SPECIFICATIONS
The fire detection sensitivity is factory set at 20%
Operating Voltage 15-33Vdc
beam obscuration and it can be changed to 30% with
Stand-by Current 350µA at 24Vdc
a sensitivity switch.
Max Current In Alarm 50mA at 24Vdc
Operating Range 25ft - 100ft The status of the unit is indicated by three LEDs
Sensitivity 20% or 30% which are viewed through a unique lens that allows
Compensation 1% per Hr. ±50% good visibility from any viewing angle, particularly from
Reflector mounting ±10% beneath the unit. The LEDs indicate, Normal, Setup,
angle Fault and Fire Condition, so the user can verify which
unit is in alarm.
Operating Temp. Range 32°F to +100°F
Storage Temp. Range -22°F to +158°F The unit indicates a fault on the zone under the
Maximum Humidity 95%RH - Non condensing following conditions:
(at 104°F)
Color & Case Material Ivory ABS
• Compensation limit exceeded
Size: SRA-24 6" x 4.8" x 3.1"
• Total obscuration of beam
Reflector 7.5" x 7.5" x.1"
• Beam detector unit removed from zone
Weight: SRA-24 1.9 lbs (Including termination module)
Reflector 1.6 oz. PRODUCT LISTINGS
Underwriters Laboratories: S1383
Factory Mutual:
CSFM #: 7260-0410:158
The contractor shall furnish and install, where indicated on the plans, HOCHIKI America SRA-24 Reflective
Beam Detector. The detector shall have a range of 25 feet to 100 feet. The beam smoke detector shall be
field adjustable to one of the two obscuration settings of 20%, or 30% per span. These settings shall be
capable of being verified with calibrated filters. Side to side spacing shall be a maximum of 60 feet on
center.
The reflective beam detector shall posses circuitry that automatically compensates for normal ambient
changes in the intensity of the emitted beam strength. The microprocessor shall provide compensation for
a change in received signal value, with time, caused by contamination of the optics. Since such a change
with time appears as a slow change in the beam signal, the microcomputer compensates in such a manner
that the signal moves closer to the reference data at a rate of approximately +1% per hour. When this
compensating capability reaches a limit, the microcomputer automatically generates a trouble signal.
The reflective beam detector(s) shall also signal a trouble condition if the beam has a blockage of 90% for
more than 20 seconds and automatically resets to normal when blockage is removed.
The reflective beam detector(s) shall be UL listed for these applications. Voltage and RF transient protec-
tion shall be integral to the internal circuitry of the reflective beam detector so as to minimize false alarm
potential.
To facilitate easy installation and setup, the reflective beam detectors shall employ signal strength indicat-
ing LED's. Alignment shall be facilitated by turning an alignment adjustment screws and monitoring the
relative signal strength based upon which LEDs are illuminated.
The detectors shall also illuminate a red LED, which is visible externally, when an alarm condition is indi-
cated.
The reflective beam detector shall provide a Form "A" dry contact for alarm and Form "B" dry contact for
trouble.
INSTALLATION
The HOCHIKI America SRA-24 Reflective Beam Detector shall be installed in accordance with the Instal-
lation Instruction Guide provided with every unit. Refer to the applicable NFPA Standards for additional
guidance on spacing, irregular ceiling surfaces and other design considerations.
TYPICAL WIRING
Reflector Reflector
End of Line
24V + 24V 24V 24V 24V Resistor
24V - 0V 0V 0V 0V
F1 F1 F1 F1
Zone +
Zone - F2 F2 F2 F2
T1 T2 T1 T2
Control
Panel
NOTE: End of line relay and trouble contacts are closed when power is applied.
DWG. # HA-06-100
Page 1 of 19 3/02
Part # 1700-10160
Contents
Contents ............................................................................................................1
1. Overview .......................................................................................................3
1.1. General Description ......................................................................3
1.2. Detection principle........................................................................3
2. Installing The Detector .................................................................................4
2.1. Sighting .........................................................................................4
2.2. Installation.....................................................................................5
2.3. Opening the detector cover ...........................................................5
2.4. Field wiring ...................................................................................6
2.5. Reflector - Installation Procedure .................................................7
2.6. Adjustment & Calibration procedure............................................8
2.7 Testing the SRA-24........................................................................9
3. Maintenance..................................................................................................10
3.1. General ..........................................................................................10
3.2. Visual check..................................................................................10
3.3. Operation checks...........................................................................10
3.4. Precautions for insulation resistance checking .............................10
3.5. Re-initialization after cleaning or re-adjustment ..........................10
4. Summary OfTthe SRA-24's Functions...........................................................11
4.1. Alarm signal output and indicator lamp........................................11
4.2. Fault signal output and indicator lamp..........................................11
4.3. Indication of normal operation......................................................11
4.4. Total obscuration of the beam.......................................................11
4.5. Automatic compensation for change of SRA-24's signal
strength……………………………………………………………… 11
5. Specification..................................................................................................12
6. Troubleshooting ............................................................................................13
6.1. Monitor LED fails to flash............................................................13
6.2. Fire signal continues after reset ....................................................13
6.3. Fault signal cannot be reset……………………….......................13
6.4. Beam detector generates a fire but panel does not register the
condition….…………………………………………………………. 13
6.5. Beam detector generates a fault but panel does not register the
condition…………………………………………………………….. 13
7. Installation Guide Lines ...............................................................................14
7.1. General installation conditions .....................................................14
7.2. Installation in Saw-tooth type ceilings..........................................15
7.3. Installation in circular type ceilings..............................................15
7.4. Installation in sloped ceilings........................................................16
7.5. Installation in a monitor roof ........................................................16
7.6. Installation in corridors or aisles...................................................17
7.7. Installation precautions .................................................................18
7.8. Smoke patterns appropriate to the consideration of beam detector
installation…………………………………………………………… 19
DWG. # HA-06-100
Page 2 of 19 3/02
Part # 1700-10160
1. Overview
1.1. General Description
The Photoelectric reflective beam detector consists of the SRA-24 unit and a reflector, which face
each other at a distance of between 25ft and 100ft.
In the event of fire the smoke generated will decrease the amount of near infrared light energy on the
SRA-24, this decrease is electronically interpreted to identify the occurrence of fire. An important
feature of the detector is that it monitors the protected space linearly. This enables the detector to
identify a fire before it spreads, even when the smoke is scattered over a large area.
The fire detection sensitivity is factory set at 20% beam obscuration and it can be changed to 30%
with a sensitivity switch.
1.2. Detection Principle
A near infrared pulsed beam generated by the SRA-24 and is reflected back to the unit, where it is
converted into an electrical signal. This signal is then amplified and applied via an A/D converter to a
micro-processor. The normal state signal (the initial beam data) once stored in the micro-processor is
used as a reference for comparison with subsequent beam signals.
When there is sufficient difference between actual beam strength and stored reference data to indicate
the occurrence of a fire, then a fire signal is produced.
The micro-processor also provides compensation for a change in received signal value with time,
caused by contamination of the optics or slight alignment changes. The processed signal is adjusted at
a rate of ±1% towards the reference data every hour. When the limit of compensation is reached the
micro-processor will automatically produce a fault signal.
DWG. # HA-06-100
Page 3 of 19 3/02
Part # 1700-10160
2. Installing The Detector
2.1. Sighting
Select a suitable position for the installation of both SRA-24 and reflector, such that there are no
visible obstructions between them. Remember that the beam detector works on the principle of
reduction of light between the SRA-24 and reflector. If there is any possibility of an object remaining
within the beam for a few seconds then the sighting of the detector is unsuitable.
For mounting either the SRA-24 or reflector it is important to establish that the mounting place such as
the wall is solid and that the beam detector alignment will be rigid. The wall may appear to be solid, but
may be subject to twisting or other changes when the temperature outside the building varies greatly
during one day, for instance on cold, frosty days. The installer must ensure that the beam will not be
subject to misalignment due to changes in the building itself.
Warning
The SRA-24 is not solar blind, therefore the SRA-24 or reflector should not be installed where
they can be subjected to direct or reflected sunlight, i.e. via adjacent walls and reflective
surfaces. It is recommended that in these locations or where the beam detector may be
surrounded by glass, the SPB-24N should be fitted.
DWG. # HA-06-100
Page 4 of 19 3/02
Part # 1700-10160
2.2. Installation
Please check that the beam detector contains the following components so installation can be carried
out:
# 1 SRA-24
# 1 Reflector (enclosed in packaging)
# 1 Mask
# 1 Installation manual
# 2 Installation Screws
# 1 SRA-24 mounting plate (termination module PCB on the back)
The termination module is designed to facilitate the installation of the SRA-24 beam detector to fire
cables using a standard surface/flush double gang installation box.
DWG. # HA-06-100
Page 5 of 19 3/02
Part # 1700-10160
2.4. Field Wiring
The connection of this unit requires the use of a double gang installation box, either flush mount or
surface mount. Many equivalent type are usable providing that it has a minimum depth of 1.2 inches.
This item should be firmly fixed to the wall or other suitable mounting point first.
With reference to the wiring diagram Figure 2 & Figure 3 ensure that the field wiring is terminated
into the dual gang installation box.
24 V- 0V 0V 0V 0V
F1 F1 F1 F1
Zone+
F2 F2 F2 F2
Zone-
T1 T2 T1 T2
C ontrol
Panel
1 24V
2 24V
3 0V
4 0V
5 F1
6 F1
7 F2
8 F2
9 T1
10 T2
Install the wires into the 10 position black connector of the Termination PCB (Figure 3).
DWG. # HA-06-100
Page 6 of 19 3/02
Part # 1700-10160
Install the wires into the PCB then connect the pre-wired ribbon cable assembly to the socket on
the back plate (Figure 4-1), the back plate should then be screwed to the back box. Fix the beam
assembly to this by fitting the locating slots under the installation screws (Figure 4-2) and
pushing the beam up until the locating tabs can be dropped into the back plate (Figure 4-3). The
top installation screws should then be tightened, and the cover fitted to the beam detector once
the adjustment and calibration procedure has been completed see section 2.6.
4-2
4-1
4-3
Figure 4 Termination module
assembly
2” x 2”
Reflector
Reflector mask
Figure 5 Figure 6
If the SRA-24 is being used over a distance of 25ft-50ft then the mask should be fitted to the reflector
(figure 5). From distances of 50ft-100ft then the mask must not be fitted to the reflector (figure 6).
DWG. # HA-06-100
Page 7 of 19 3/02
Part # 1700-10160
2.6. Adjustment & Calibration Procedure
The adjustment procedure should be carried out by powering up the SRA-24 and setting the switch to
calibrate, at this time the yellow LED will start to flash, Then using the sight holes and alignment
adjustment screws, the detector should be adjusted so the reflector can be seen in the center of the
sight hole. If the reflector is being used with the mask then the detector must be adjusted until the
black dot on the reflector is in the center of the sight hole.
When setting the SRA-24 up the set up switch must be set to calibrate, once alignment is completed
as above then the switch must be returned to the normal position.
Calibration LEVEL1
Set the sensitivity to the correct value using sensitivity switch. The sensitivity setting for the position
is shown below.
DWG. # HA-06-100
Page 8 of 19 3/02
Part # 1700-10160
The set up switch should now be set to the normal position, at this time the yellow and green
operating LED’s will be flashing this should last for one minute as the detector automatically adjusts.
When this has been completed the yellow LED will extinguish and the green LED will continue to
flash. If the adjustment isn’t completed satisfactorily then the yellow LED will flash on its own. The
cover should now be fitted and operation tests should now be carried out as described in section 2.7.
The SRA-24 has three LED’s mounted underneath the unit, these are yellow, green and red and are
illuminated depending on the current state of the SRA-24. Please find below a table showing the
various states of the SRA-24 and which LED’s will be illuminated.
Note: In order to avoid the influence of reflection of the test filter itself, insert the test filter within ½
inch from the surface of the detector.
DWG. # HA-06-100
Page 9 of 19 3/02
Part # 1700-10160
3. Maintenance
3.1. General
The detector contains an automatic compensation function, which allows the detector to operate
correctly even when the amount of signal reaching the SRA-24 has changed (the compensation rate is
±1%/hour). This means that minor changes due to contamination and beam alignment will not affect
the sensitivity of the detector. There is of course a limit that the detector can compensate for and this
is -50% and +50% of the initial setting. In order to maintain proper performance the detector should
be checked every six months.
3.2. Visual Check
Check the condition of both the reflector and SRA-24 for physical damage or any other condition that
might impair proper operation. Ensure that both the SRA-24 and reflector are still firmly secured to
the wall or other mounting point.
If necessary clean the lens cover or reflector with a damp soft cloth. Washing liquid, alcohol or
detergent must not be used.
3.3. Operation Checks
Perform the sensitivity check function as defined in section 2.7.
3.4. Precautions For Insulation Resistance Checking
If the wiring to a beam detector is to be tested for insulation resistance using a high voltage tester
such as a Megger, the wiring to the beam detector must be disconnected from the detector by
disconnecting the white terminal connector from the PCB will enable testing to be carried out.
DWG. # HA-06-100
Page 10 of 19 3/02
Part # 1700-10160
4. Summary Of The SRA-24's Functions
4.1. Alarm Signal Output And Indicator Lamp
When the beam is obscured by an amount that exceeds the sensitivity setting of the detector then a
fire signal is produced lighting the red LED on the SRA-24. It should be noted that the SRA-24 has a
sophisticated processing and analyzing circuit and therefore a fire will not occur immediately the
obscuration exceeds the sensitivity value, but will take typically 11 to 16 seconds to produce the fire
signal. The fire decision is based on an averaging technique and therefore the time to fire alarm will
vary depending on the level of obscuration and the sensitivity setting.
4.2. Fault Signal Output And Indicator Lamp
4.2.1. General
The beam detector may produce a fault condition for one of many different reasons, which will
depend on whether the detector has just been set up or is in normal operation, when this occurs the
yellow fault LED on the SRA-24 will be illuminated and flash.
4.2.2. After adjustment/re-initialization
The beam detector will produce a fault after or during adjustment for one of the following reasons:
⌦ The set up switch was left in the calibrate position
⌦ The signal strength is too high or too low.
4.2.3. During normal operation
The beam detector will produce a fault during normal operation for one of the following reasons:
⌦ The limit of contamination has been reached. The detector is only able to compensate for
contamination or alignment change up to a certain point.
⌦ The obscuration is greater than 90%.
⌦ The signal level increased rapidly from initial value.
4.3. Indication Of Normal Operation
When the SRA-24 has been set up correctly then the green LED mounted underneath the case will
flash every 3 seconds to confirm that the detector is operating satisfactorily.
4.4. Total Obscuration Of The Beam
If the beam detector is totally obscured, the green LED will continue flash and the yellow fault LED
will flash, a fault signal will then be produced at the fire alarm panel.
4.5. Automatic Compensation For Change of SRA-24's Signal Strength
From the time that the beam detector is initialized, the signal at the SRA-24 is checked every 60
minutes for variation and will be altered by ±1% back towards the original stored value. The beam
detector will store the initialization value, when the set up switch is moved from calibrate to normal.
DWG. # HA-06-100
Page 11 of 19 3/02
Part # 1700-10160
5. Specification
Installation Environment Indoor use only
Principle of Operation Light beam obscuration (near infra-red)
Rated voltage 24V (nominal)
Operating voltage range 15.0 ~ 33V dc
Peak surge voltage 42V
Current in alarm 50mA
Quiescent current 350µA
Compensation method 1% every hour. towards initial value
Compensation limits +50% to -50% of the initial value
Fire condition Red fire LED on SRA-24 illuminated
Fault condition Yellow fire LED on SRA-24 flashes
Monitor condition Set up condition: Both green and yellow LED's flash
Normal operation: Green LED flashes
DWG. # HA-06-100
Page 12 of 19 3/02
Part # 1700-10160
6. Troubleshooting
The following conditions relate to the SRA-24 itself.
6.1. Monitor LED Fails To Flash
The monitor LED should flash every 3 seconds if it does not the reason may be as follows:
⌦ Power supply voltage to the SRA-24 less than 15V
⌦ SRA-24 is damaged
Ensure that the SRA-24 has been powered for more than 60 seconds and that the power at the SRA-
24 is greater than 15V.
Note: If the set up switch position is “Calibration”, or power supply voltage is less than 15V, only
yellow LED will flash.
6.2. Fire Signal Continues After Reset
When a fire has occurred there may be certain circumstances that will prevent the beam detector from
resetting. These are:
⌦ There is an obstruction of the optical path between reflector and SRA-24. Ensure there is
no obstruction.
⌦ The optical axis has been altered suddenly. The beam will need re-alignment.
⌦ Insufficient time between fire and reset. At least 3 seconds are required before resetting
the beam after the fire signal has occurred.
6.3. Fault Signal Cannot Be Reset
If a fault has been generated without any obvious reason, it has occurred due to one of the following
reasons:
⌦ Contamination limit has been exceeded (light received has changed by more than 50%)
To clear this condition the set up and adjustment procedure should be repeated after
cleaning detector and reflector.
⌦ Beam detector has totally been obscured or light received has rapidly increased. The
reason will be the same as for 6.2 above.
6.4. Beam Detector Generates a Fire But Panel Does Not Register the Condition
⌦ The zone is incorrectly wired to the beam detector. The wiring must be done in
accordance with the relevant wiring diagram
6.5. Beam Detector Generates a Fault But Panel Does Not Register the
Condition
⌦ The zone is incorrectly wired to the beam detector. The wiring must be done in
accordance with the relevant wiring diagram.
DWG. # HA-06-100
Page 13 of 19 3/02
Part # 1700-10160
7. Installation Guide Lines
The Hochiki SRA-24 beam detector must be installed according to the requirements laid out in
National or local standards. The following guidelines for installation are provided to give information
in certain installation conditions where no advise or regulations are provided by the relevant standard.
DWG. # HA-06-100
Page 14 of 19 3/02
Part # 1700-10160
7.2. Installation in Saw-Tooth Type Ceilings
In installations where there is a saw-tooth shape to the ceiling the detectors should be mounted with
the axis either in condition A or condition B according to Figure 8. If the height of the ceiling 'a' is
greater than 0.2'H' do not install with the axis according to line B.
DWG. # HA-06-100
Page 15 of 19 3/02
Part # 1700-10160
7.4. Installation In Sloped Ceilings
The installation for a sloped type roof or ceiling will be as shown in Figure 10. Either position A or B
is acceptable for installation of the SRA-24.
DWG. # HA-06-100
Page 16 of 19 3/02
Part # 1700-10160
7.6. Installation In Corridors Or Aisles
7.6.1. Closed corridor
When the detector is installed in a corridor with a closed corner it is possible to use just one detector
as shown in Figure 12 providing that the distance L is less than 24ft.
DWG. # HA-06-100
Page 17 of 19 3/02
Part # 1700-10160
7.6.3. Corridor with corners
When the detector is installed in a corridor with a bend and an aisle as shown in Figure 14 it will be
necessary to use at least 2 beam detectors to cover the corridors. If the distance P is greater than 50ft
then another beam detector will need to be installed at point C.
DWG. # HA-06-100
Page 18 of 19 3/02
Part # 1700-10160
7.8. Smoke Patterns Appropriate To The Consideration of Beam Detector
Installation
Height in feet
131
98
65
32
[A] This pattern is produced by hotter burning fires and is very narrow at ground
level. Therefore, it may be easier to detect at a higher level or at the ceiling.
[B] This type of smoke produced by a smouldering fire will not rise above 50ft
and therefore to cover this type of risk it is necessary to install the detector
below 50ft.
[C] This smoke pattern will be detected by detectors installed at any height.
Technical Support
Tel: (800) 845-6692
Fax: (714) 690-7890
E-MAIL: technicalsupport@hochiki.com
DWG. # HA-06-100
Page 19 of 19 3/02
Part # 1700-10160
SZA-NA(FM) HIGH SENSITIVITY SMOKE
DETECTION SYSTEM
DESCRIPTION
The Hochiki America SZA-NA(FM) high sensitivity
smoke detection system is capable of detecting
minute particles of smoke. The SZA-NA(FM) is ideal
for applications where response time is critical. It
provides the earliest response to fires available. The
SZA-NA(FM) provides a detection solution for rooms
with high air flow, and rooms with large open spaces.
SPECIFICATIONS
Power Supply 24 VDC ± 10% 0.5A or less
STANDARD FEATURES Current Output
4-20mA DC output (Receiving resistance: 100 ohm or less)
• Detects very low density smoke Contact Output
• 200 m2 detection area (2150 ft2) Alarm 1 output, Alarm 2 output , Alarm 3 output,
• No filter necessary & System Fault output
• N/O or N/C alarm contacts form A, form B Contact Capacity
• Automatic and manual laser tests 24 VDC, 0.5A or less (each contact output)
• Four selectable sensitivity ranges:
Contact Output Logic
*Sensitivity 1: 0.005 to 0.1%/m (0.002 to 0.03%/ft)
NO (form A) or NC (form B) selectable
*Sensitivity 2: 0.01 to 0.2%/m (0.003 to 0.06%/ft)
by a jumper pin
*Sensitivity 3: 0.025 to 0.5%/m (0.008 to 0.15%/ft)
AC Power Supply Monitoring Input
*Sensitivity 4: 0.25 to 5.0%/m (0.08 to 1.55%/ft)
NO (form A) or NC (form B) selectable
• 3 alarm levels: by system setting
*Alarm 1 (low)
Internal Wiring Heat-resistance shielded wires
*Alarm 2 (medium)
*Alarm 3 (high) Materials
Body & panel: Steel plate of 0.8 mm thick, baked painting
Display operating panel: Steel plate of 1.0 mm thick
Colors
Body & panel: Munsell 2.5Y9/1 or equivalent
Display operating panel: Munsell 5Y6/0.5 or equivalent
Weight Approximately 8.2 lbs. (3.7kg.)
Dimensions 12.48" W x 8.86" H x 4.00" D
317mm x 225mm x 102mm
Exploded View of Front Panel Operating Temperature 14°F to 122°F
(-10 ºC to +50 ºC)
PRODUCT LISTINGS
Installation Indoor (Non-condensing)
Accessory Dedicated flexible pipe
3026973
Continued on back.
Specifications subject to change without notice.
An aspirating smoke detection system continuously draws air from the monitored area into the sampling pipes. The
air is drawn from the sampling pipes into the main sampling unit. In the main sampling unit, the air is analyzed by
very sensitive laser detection components. The laser detection components constantly monitor for the presence of
smoke particles.
If smoke particles are detected, the unit will activate the alarm output relays in accordance with the sensitivity
selected and the alarm level reached. The SZA-NA(FM) High Sensitivity Smoke Detector is between 20 and 1000
times more sensitive than spot-type smoke detectors. The SZA-NA(FM) has three alarm stages. Alarm 1 is the
lowest obscuration alarm (high sensitivity), activating when very small amounts of smoke are detected. The Orange
Alarm 1 LED will light, and the Alarm 1 relay will activate. As the smoke density reaches alarm level 2, the Red
Alarm 2 LED will light and Alarm 2 relay will activate. As the smoke density reaches alarm level 3, the Red Alarm 3
LED will flash and the Alarm 3 relay will activate.
The SZA-NA(FM) is ideal for use in areas such as computer server rooms, clean rooms, telecommunication
equipment rooms, medical equipment/operating rooms, power generation plants, and many other applications. By
continuously sampling the area, the SZA-NA(FM) can provide the earliest warning of the presence of smoke, even
before the smoke is visible to the human eye.
4
3
APPLICATION
This module will be connected to a SLC loop utilizing
the Hochiki DCP (digital communications protocol).
The DCP-SRM will provide a supervised 24 VDC output
to a fire alarm releasing solenoid or squib agent
release supervision circuit.
OPERATION
There are separate wiring terminals provided for both
STANDARD FEATURES the Solenoid and Agent Release Module (ARM)
• Solenoid output with supervision for open and short devices. Although there are two sets of terminals, this
circuit conditions. Check on supervised status module can only be used for one type at a time. The
occurs upon receipt of an A-D command ARM end-of-line (EOL) resistor must be removed when
• Output relay rate to supply 2A @ 30 VDC for the used with a solenoid. A panel command allows the
solenoid load user to choose which type of device is being controlled
• Addressable FET switch used to control output for and supervised. In the event of an alarm condition, the
extra security in releasing functions module will be activated to supply up to 2 amps of
• Activation pulse time from 1-127seconds in 1 current to the solenoid or ARM devices. The solenoid
second intervals or 1-127 minutes in 1 minute activation time is programmable at the DCP control
intervals. panel.
• Visible Bi-colored LED is software controlled and can
be programmed to blink red or green when polled. Solenoid activating pulse time can be programmed
The LED can be latched on when activated. from 1 second to 127 second in 1 second intervals or
• Programmed with DCP expansion mode commands from 1 minute to 127 minutes in 1 minute intervals.
or with a handheld programmer The output can also be latched on until commanded to
SPECIFICATIONS be turned off by the control panel.
Absolute Max Applied Voltage: S, SC: 41VDC
AUX+, AUX-: 26VDC
Supply Voltage Nominal: S, SC : 33VDC
AUX+, AUX-: 24VDC
Normal Current Consumption (S, SC): 220µA
Maximum Current Consumption (S, SC): 300µA PRODUCT LISTINGS
Normal AUX+, AUX- Consumption: 1.2mA Underwriters Laboratories: S5694
(Max. 2Amp load) Underwriters Laboratories of Canada: CS943
Maximum Output Current to SOL+, SOL-: 2A @ 30VDC CSFM #: 7300-0410:150
End Of Line Device: 2.7K Ohm MEA Report # 284-91-E Vol. IV
Dimensions: 4.2"W x 4.7"H x 0.85"D
Ambient Temperature: 32°F (0°C) ~ 120°F (49°C)
Humidity: 90% RH, Non-Condensing
Specifications subject to change without notice.
Mounting: 4" square electrical box
The contractor shall furnish and install where indicated on the plans, the Hochiki addressable Solenoid Releasing
Module (SRM). The modules shall be UL listed compatible with the Hochiki HAX-2000 fire alarm control panel.
The device address shall be electrically programmable and stored in EEPROM. A bi-colored LED shall indicate
device status.
The SRM shall fit inside a single gang electrical back box. The SRM shall be supplied with a plastic cover and
shall be suitable for mounting to a 4" square or double gang electrical back box. The SRM shall provide a monitor
LED that is visible from outside the cover plate.
APPLICATION
ADDRESS SETTING:
SPECIFICATIONS
Rated Voltage: 9 VDC
Battery: 9 VDC
Weight: 0.34 lbs
PRODUCT PARTS
Length: 6 1/4"
• 9 Volt Battery
Color: White
• Remote Programming Cables
Continued on back
Programming Buttons
Display
PROGRAMMING BUTTONS:
LEFT GRAY BUTTON Power on. Automatically reads the addresss of a sensor.
Subsequent operations will advance the device address by ten.
RIGHT GRAY BUTTON Power off. Advances the device address by one.
RED BUTTON Stores the displayed address to the device and is used to read sensor analog
levels.
To Remote
Programming Jack
Values out of these ranges indicate that the sensor chamber has become contaminated. Refer to technical
bulletin “HA-96” for proper servicing instructions or return sensor to factory for servicing.
DISPLAY MESSAGES:
bAt- On upon power up (battery check). Also on when battery is low. Low battery good for up to 3,000
address setting operation.
E0 - Attempting to set an address beyond 127.
E1 - Attempting to program an address with no device connected.
E2 - Can not find device after power up.
E3 - Invalid sensor response.
E4 - Can not find the device program.
E5 - Device read error.
E6 - Fail during Analog value reading
Hochiki America Corporation • TCH-B100 Hand-Held Programmer Specifications subject to change without notice.
TRT-A100 SMOKE DETECTOR TESTER/REMOVAL TOOL
APPLICATION
The HOCHIKI America TRT-A100 Smoke Detector Tester/
Removal Tool enables the user to access, test, remove
and reinstall the SIH and SLK series smoke detectors.
The detectors, manufactured with a magnetically
activated dual reed switch for sensitivity testing, can be
sensitivity tested. This meets the requirements of a UL
listed calibrated test without the use of combustion
materials.
OPERATION
Test Procedure
3. If the detector does alarm when the removal/test tool is placed in this position, the detector is not within specified
sensitivity limits and may require service.
4. Rotate the TRT-A100 one-half circle (180°). Align white arrow shown on tester tool with tamper resistant set
screw.
5. Wait six to eight seconds. Detector SHOULD alarm and the indicator LED should remain lit.
6. If detector does not alarm when the TRT-A100 is positioned correctly, may not within specified sensitivity limits
and may require service. See Technical Bulletin HA-88 (November '96) for more information.
Removal Procedure
This section explains how to use the HOCHIKI America TRT-A100 Tester/Removal Tool to remove smoke detectors
from their bases.
1. Flip the TRT-A100 so the five small arrows located beneath the white orange arrows are point upward.
2. Fit the TRT-A100 to the detector and lock into place.
3. To remove a detector, rotate the TRT-A100 to the left (counterclockwise).
4. To install a detector, rotate the TRT-A100 to the right (clockwise).
OPERATION
STANDARD FEATURES 1. Pull out the measuring unit drawer to expose the
• Tests the sensitivity of Hochiki's previous model meters and AC plug connector.
photoelectric and ionization smoke detectors. 2. Remove the AC cord. Connect one end to the AC
plug connector and the other end to a 120VAC
• Lightweight and portable for easy use in the field.
electrical outlet.
• Obscuration/sensitivity testing similar to that of a 3. Turn the AC source switch on. The circulating fan
UL 268 Smoke Box. starts.
• Voltage Adjustment Knob easily changes tester 4. Allow five minutes for warm-up to ensure stability
voltage to the rated voltage of the detector. of the testing circuits.
• Indicator lamp automatically lights at completion 5. Open the top cover and locate the wire leads and
of testing. clip.
6. If you are using a detector base, connect the wire
leads to this base and mount the base to the
wooden installation plate provided.
Terminal Markings: Source cable (not used)
Signal line (+)
Common line (-)
SPECIFICATIONS
Configuring the TSA-B110
Rated Voltage 120 V AC, 50/60 Hz
Source Voltage 108V - 132V AC 7. Use the photo/ion change-over switch to
choose the type of detector (ION or PHOTO) which
Smoke Generating is to be tested.
Material SM-101-P Punk Stick 8. Use the voltage adjustment knob to adjust the
Operating Temperature voltage to agree with the rated voltage of the detec-
Range 50°F to 86°F tor being tested (for SLK-12 use 17.0 VDC).
9. Use the densitometer “0” adjustment knob to
Dimensions 15.74" x 11.02" x 7.87" set the pointer to zero (0).
Continued on back.
Weight 13 Lbs.
Testing a Detector
10. Place a detector to be tested into the base in the sensitivity tester’s smoke chamber and close the lid.
11. Insert an ignited punk stick into the smoke-producing chamber on the lower right side. When the detector
alarms, an indicator lamp lights, the meter locks, and a buzzer sounds.
12. Observe the value indicated by the meter (a holding circuit locks the meter in place for about one minute).
13. Remove the punk stick and open the top cover.
14. Remove the detector. Smoke will be exhausted and the densitometer meter will reset to “0”. The lamp and
buzzer function will clear at this time.
AC SOURCE SWITCH
VOLTAGE ADJUSTMENT
KNOB
DENSITOMETER “0”
ADJUSTMENT KNOBS
SMOKE-PRODUCING
PHOTO/ION
CHAMBER
CHANGE-OVER SWITCH
MAINTENANCE
Maintaining the TSA-B110 will assure many years of reliable use. It is recommended the maintenance be
performed by qualified personnel every two years. Consult with your Hochiki distributor for a technician in your area.
NOTE: Hochiki America Corporation recommends returning the TSA-B110 to the factory every two years for
calibration to ensure optimum performance.
fast
efficient
convenient
innovative
safe
patented
30ft reach
CAT™
Heat Detector Testing: Why and How ?
National standards require that heat detectors are tested regularly by application of a heat source.
The SOLO™ range includes two professional, alternative Or, for those seeking a lower cost solution,
solutions to meet that requirement:
2. The SOLO 409 provides a powerful heat source
1. The cordless SOLO 461, incorporating the innovative contained within the transparent cup, which enables a view
CAT™ (Cross Air Technology), activates 95% of all spot of the illuminated LED upon successful activation.
type heat detectors (fixed temperature, rate of rise and
combination) within seconds and many times faster While the SOLO 409 does need a power cord, it is nonetheless a
than previous designs. professional heat detector testing tool, designed for safe use in
the appropriate environment without causing damage to the
The rechargeable Battery Batons™, mounted inside the heat detector.
access pole, enable safe and efficient testing without any
trailing cords or the need for a safety transformer.
SOLO 409
HEAT TESTER
The SOLO 409 is a professional and robust tool for testing heat
detectors fitted at heights up to 30ft. Unlike the SOLO 461, it
does require a power cord lead but, conversely, does not require any
special energy saving features.
Suitable detector types : Spot type, Rate of Rise, Fixed Temperature and Combination up to 194ºF
Maximum detector size : Any - so long as the sensing element can be targeted by the heat source
Number of test: Typically 50 tests of 30 secs duration per Battery BatonTM
Limitless, if using one Battery Baton™ while charging another
Maximum height: Up to 10ft using SOLO 461 alone. Up to 30ft using SOLO extension poles
Approvals: CE Mark
UL listed (charger)
Safety Features: Battery over-current cut-out
Element safety cut out after 120 seconds
Auto power off after 5 mins
Operating features: Color coded LED user feedback
Automatic infrared sensing of detector
Multi position head
1 hour recharge time for Battery Baton™ (car - 12V DC or 110 / 120V AC)
Other interchangeable equipment available in Environment: Operating temperature 40ºF to 115ºF
the range includes: Storage Temperature 15ºF to 120ºF
Humidity: 0-85% RH non-condensing
● Functional smoke detector tester.
Relevant Weights and Dimensions
● A single universal detector removal / Weight Dimensions
extraction tool. Solo 460: 21oz Inside diameter 4in approx
Solo 720: 18oz Diameter 1.15in, Length 19.3in
● Telescopic access pole to 20ft.
Solo 724: 2lb 10oz 3in (w) X 5.3in (l) X 2.6in(h)
● Further extension poles to 30ft.
Suitable detector types: Spot type, Rate of Rise, Fixed Temperature and Combination up to 90ºC / 194ºF
Maximum height: Up to 30ft using SOLO extension poles
Operating voltages: 110 / 120V AC
Power: 600W approx
Frequency: 50 / 60 Hz
Cable length: 20in nominal
Type of connector: CEE 17 Industrial
Weight: 1lb 14oz
Dimensions: Inside diameter 4.5in approx, working depth 3in approx
Smoke detector sensitivity Safety: Thermal cut out, electrically fused, double insulated
testing instrument
Ordering Information
Part No Description
Solo 409: 110 / 120V AC Corded Heat Detector Tester
Solo 460: Cordless “Head Unit” - note: requires Solo 720 and Solo724
Solo 461: Cordless Heat Detector Test kit including:
1x Solo 460 CAT™ Cordless Heat Detector Tester
2x Solo 720 Battery Baton™
1x Solo 724 Universal Battery Charger
Solo 720: Battery Baton™ for Solo 460
Solo 724: Universal Fast Charger for Battery Batons™
TSE-A100 SELF-CONTAINED SMOKE GENERATOR
APPLICATION
The Hochiki America TSE-A100 is one of the most
advanced units of its kind and is the result of extensive
research and development aimed at making the job of
testing detectors a simple and efficient operation .
OPERATION
Preparation
1. Remove the TSE-A100 from its carrying case.
2. Unscrew the combustion chamber from the
bottom of the TSE-A100.
3. Unscrew the punk stick holder retainer from
the combustion chamber.
4. Insert a punk stick into the punk stick holder in
the combustion chamber.
5. Light the punk stick with a flame.
STANDARD FEATURES 6. Reassemble the combustion chamber.
• Tests all types of smoke detectors. 7. Screw the combustion chamber back into the
• Completely self contained and portable. bottom of the TSE-A100
• Extends from 5.25 feet to 14.1 feet. 8. Extend the telescopic pole of the TSE-A100 to
• Internal Smoke Source. a length which enables you to reach the
• Non-Toxic Smoke Source. detector you wish to test.
• Unit includes shoulder sling carrying case.
• Optional adapter for high velocity conditions. Testing a Detector
Once you have prepared the TSE-A100, follow the steps
• Exhaust function to clear detector.
in this section to test smoke detectors.
• Built-in filter to prevent tar residue from adhering to
the surface of the detector. NOTE: Allow 30 to 60 seconds after igniting punk stick
for sufficient smoke generation.
SPECIFICATIONS
Continued on back
Rated Voltage 3 VDC
Battery 2 - "D" Batteries
PRODUCT PARTS
Combustion Material Punk Stick
(7 mm diameter, 150 mm long) • TSE-A100 Self-Contained Smoke Generator
Weight 5 Lbs. • Punk Stick (Part No. TSE-P100)
Length 5.25 to 14.1 feet
Color Brown
Specifications subject to change without notice.
NOTE
Combustion Chamber
Punk Stick
Instruction Label
Tool
You will need:
Hochiki America's NSRT-A100 Cover Removal Tool
Soap solution (1 teaspoon of Lemon Joy to 1 gallon clean water)
Soap bristled brush
Clean dry compressed air
Distilled water
Vacuum
Tool
You will need:
Hochiki America's NSRT-A100 tool
NSRT-A100
Testing a detector
Once you have prepared the TSE-A100, follow the steps in this section
to test smoke detectors.
NOTE: Allow 30 to 60 seconds after igniting punk stick for sufficient
smoke generation. For proper airflow, observe battery polarity.
1. Rotate the combustion chamber so the #2 arrow lines up with the
power indicator screw. The fan powers on and a steady flow of smoke
is released from the tip of the TSE-A100.
2. Raise the extended tip of the TSE-A100 to within 6-8" of the sensor.
TSE-A100 specifications The sensor should alarm.
Rated Voltage 3 VDC
Battery D size (2) Storing the TSE-A100
Combustion material Punk stick (7mm diameter, 150mm long) This section explains how to store the TSE-A100 after use.
Weight 5 pounds 1. Rotate the combustion chamber to the #1 position to turn the power
Maximum length 14.1 feet off.
2. Compress the telescopic pole to its shortest length.
3. Replace the TSE-A100 in its carrying case.
4. Store in a cool, dry place.
5. For extended storage, remove the batteries.
TECHNICAL BULLETIN HA-96
6 DECEMBER 2003
The TTA-1H Heat Sensor Tester ATG-EA
View of TTA-1H
The TTA-1H is a state of the art heat sensor tester. It is the most in relationship
advanced heat testing device of its kind. It is the result of intense to sensor
research and developement aimed at making the job of testing self
restoring heat devices a simple and efficient operation.
Lightweight Head
Features with built in
Quick response ceramic heater element. circulation fan
Built in circulation fan for even distribution of heat.
Swivel mounted head for easy access to heat sensor.
Rubber contact points to protect the heat sensor, yet allowing
good contact for rapid testing.
Inline switch between test pole and battery pack adding to the
simple and easy operation.
Power indicating LED on bottom of test head.
Three section pole with friction power locks.
Use of portable battery pack with belt mount. Adjustable
Optional use shoulder strap for battery pack. aluminum pole
Battery pack protected by a 10A circuit breaker.
Special calibration plate provided so as to perform a quick
periodic calibration check.
WARNING:
DO NOT USE THIS DEVICE ON NON-RESTORABLE
HEAT SENSORS OR DETECTORS!!!!
Battery Pack
Battery type NICAD 12V. 2.8Ah
Life 500 charges (minimum)
Number of sensors tested 200 max. (5sec. ON - 60sec. OFF)
per charge 150 max. (10sec. ON - 60sec. OFF)
Weight 2.2 lbs.
Dimensions 8.03in.L X 2.99in.W X 2.17D
Charger 12VDC 350mA
TECHNICAL BULLETIN HA-96
DECEMBER 2003 7
Reactions to particle size
The following table shows how photoelectric and ionization sensors react to materials of varying particle size. The
solid lines indicate absolute size. The dashed lines identify areas to consider when engineering a job using Hochiki
sensors.
Particle Size in Microns
1000 100 10 1 0.1 0.01 0.001
Rain Fine Rain Mist Wood Smoke
Carbon Powder
Pigments
Ammonia Vapor
Gas Molecules
Chimney Smoke
Factory Dust
Bacteria Viruses
Particles Visible
To naked eye Through microscope Through high power microscope
Hochiki Sensors
Photoelectric Smoke Sensors
Ionization Smoke Sensors
Features Remote
The TCH-B100-NS is a compact unit and easy to use. Programming Jack
The TCH-B100-NS provides address setting and reading.
Has the diagnostic ability to display the analog value.
Use 9V battery
Automatically increments the address ready to set the address of
the next sensor.
Automatically switches the power off after use
Programming
Programming Buttons Buttons Display
Left Gray Button: Power on. Automatically reads the address of a
sensor. Subsequent operations will advance the
device address by ten.
Right Gray Button: Power off. Advances the device address by
one.
Red Button: Stores the displayed address to the device and is
used to read sensor analog levels.
Address Setting
Remote Programming Cable
1. Install sensor onto programmer, ensuring that sensor protrusion (All Modules except DCP-FRCME-S
aligns with programmer grooves. and FRCME-P)
2. Press the left gray button to switch programmed on. A battery
check message will appear followed by the devices address
( un-programmed sensors will read address 127). To Remote
3. Set the required address by incrementing the left and right gray Programming
buttons (the display will show three red flashing dots if the address Jack
being programmed is different from the device's current address).
4. When the desired address is present press the red button to store
that address. The three red dots on the display will no longer be Remote Programming Cable
(DCP-FRCME-P)
present.
Display Message:
bAt - On upon power up ( battery check). Also on when battery is
low. Low battery good for up to 3,000 address setting
operation.
E0 - Attempting to set an address beyond 127.
E1 - Attempting to program an address with no device connected.
E2 - Can not find device after power up.
E3 - Invalid sensor response
E4 - Can not find the device program.
E5 - Device read error.
E6 - Fail during Analog value reading.
Tools
You will need:
Hochiki America's NSRT-A100 Cover Removal Tool
A small soft-bristled artist's paint brush
Denatured alcohol
Clean dry compressed air
Disassembly Procedure
SCREWDRIVER HEAD
1. Remove the detector from the trim ring.
3. Place the second screwdriver under the next adjacent TAB DIRECTION TO
pushing it the direction shown in Diagram 1. MOVE TAB
DIAGRAM 1
4. Push the screwdriver outward from the center of the
detector and lift the Enclosure upward.
Cleaning Procedure
DIAGRAM 2
Tools
You will need:
Small blade type screw driver.
Soap solution (1 teaspoon of Lemon Joy to 1 gallon clean water)
Soft bristled brush
Clean dry compressed air
Distilled water
Vacuum
NOTE: If, after testing, the detector is not working within the prescribed
range, then return it to the manufacturer for servicing.
ENCLOSURE KEYS
(4 TOTAL TWO ARE HIDDEN)
CONTACT BLADE
Tools
You will need:
Hochiki America's NSRT-A100 tool
ALIGN
LOCATOR
HERE
MOUNTING
EARS
ROTATE
TO
REMOVE
COVER
ALIGN
LOCATOR
HERE
NSRT-A100
WARNING:
DO NOT USE THIS DEVICE ON NON-RESTORABLE
HEAT SENSORS OR DETECTORS.
Battery Pack
Battery type NICAD 12V. 2.8Ah
Life 500 charges (minimum)
Number of detectors tested 200 max. (5sec. ON - 60sec. OFF)
per charge 150 max. (10sec. ON - 60sec. OFF)
Weight 2.2 lbs.
Dimensions 8.03in.L X 2.99in.W X 2.17D
Charger 12VDC 350mA
TECHNICAL BULLETIN HA-97
OCTOBER 2002
Page 7 of 7
Reactions to particle size
The following table shows how photoelectric and ionization detectors react to materials of varying particle size. The
solid lines indicate absolute size. The dashed lines identify areas to consider when engineering a job using Hochiki
detectors.
Particle Size in Microns
Carbon Powder
Pigments
Ammonia Vapor
Gas Molecules
Chimney Smoke
Factory Dust
Bacteria Viruses
Particles Visible
To naked eye Through microscope Through high power microscope
Hochiki Detectors
Photoelectric Smoke Detectors
Ionization Smoke Detectors
ADT
2-Wire Compatibility Listings
PANEL MODEL ZONE MODEL ZONE LOOP MAX EOL DETECTOR DETECTOR BASE MODEL BASE ID
ID STYLE DET MODEL ID
ADT-XP XPM-8 A B;D 60 2.2K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-2-RB HB-10
ADT-XP XPM-8 A B;D 60 2.2K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
ADT-XP XPM-8 A B;D 60 2.2K SIH-24F HD-3 HSB-220 HB-56
ADT-XP XPM-8 A B;D 60 2.2K SIH-24F HD-3 HSB-224 HB-53
ADT-XP XPM-8 A B;D 60 2.2K SIH-24F HD-3 YBA-M22 HB-3
ADT-XP XPM-8 A B;D 60 2.2K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-2-RB HB-10
ADT-XP XPM-8 A B;D 60 2.2K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
ADT-XP XPM-8 A B;D 60 2.2K SLK-24F HD-3 HSB-220 HB-56
ADT-XP XPM-8 A B;D 60 2.2K SLK-24F HD-3 HSB-224 HB-53
ADT-XP XPM-8 A B;D 60 2.2K SLK-24F HD-3 YBA-M22 HB-3
ADT-XP XPM-8 A B;D 60 2.2K SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-2-RB HB-10
ADT-XP XPM-8 A B;D 60 2.2K SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
ADT-XP XPM-8 A B;D 60 2.2K SLK-24FH HD-3 HSB-220 HB-56
ADT-XP XPM-8 A B;D 60 2.2K SLK-24FH HD-3 HSB-224 HB-53
ADT-XP XPM-8 A B;D 60 2.2K SLK-24FH HD-3 YBA-M22 HB-3
UNIMODE 4-16 IZ4;8W/WO IZE-A A B;D 35 4.7K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-2-RB HB-10
UNIMODE 4-16 IZ4;8W/WO IZE-A A B;D 35 4.7K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
UNIMODE 4-16 IZ4;8W/WO IZE-A A B;D 35 4.7K SIH-24F HD-3 HSB-220 HB-56
UNIMODE 4-16 IZ4;8W/WO IZE-A A B;D 35 4.7K SIH-24F HD-3 HSB-224 HB-53
UNIMODE 4-16 IZ4;8W/WO IZE-A A B;D 35 4.7K SIH-24F HD-3 YBA-M22 HB-3
UNIMODE 4-16 IZ4;8W/WO IZE-A A B;D 35 4.7K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-2-RB HB-10
UNIMODE 4-16 IZ4;8W/WO IZE-A A B;D 35 4.7K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
UNIMODE 4-16 IZ4;8W/WO IZE-A A B;D 35 4.7K SLK-24F HD-3 HSB-220 HB-56
UNIMODE 4-16 IZ4;8W/WO IZE-A A B;D 35 4.7K SLK-24F HD-3 HSB-224 HB-53
UNIMODE 4-16 IZ4;8W/WO IZE-A A B;D 35 4.7K SLK-24F HD-3 YBA-M22 HB-3
UNIMODE 4-16 IZ4;8W/WO IZE-A A B;D 35 4.7K SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-2-RB HB-10
UNIMODE 4-16 IZ4;8W/WO IZE-A A B;D 35 4.7K SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
UNIMODE 4-16 IZ4;8W/WO IZE-A A B;D 35 4.7K SLK-24FH HD-3 HSB-220 HB-56
UNIMODE 4-16 IZ4;8W/WO IZE-A A B;D 35 4.7K SLK-24FH HD-3 HSB-224 HB-53
UNIMODE 4-16 IZ4;8W/WO IZE-A A B;D 35 4.7K SLK-24FH HD-3 YBA-M22 HB-3
UNIMODE 4-16 IZ4;9W/WO IZE-A A B;D 35 4.7K SLK-24F HD-3 YBA-M22 HB--3
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
ADVANTOR
2-Wire Compatibility Listings
PANEL MODEL ZONE MODEL ZONE LOOP MAX EOL DETECTOR DETECTOR BASE MODEL BASE ID
ID STYLE DET MODEL ID
ULF 3000-24 N/A ULF1 A 10 6.8K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-200D HB-20
ULF 3000-24 N/A ULF1 A 10 6.8K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
ULF 3000-24 N/A ULF1 A 10 6.8K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-221D HB-4
ULF 3000-24 N/A ULF1 A 10 6.8K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-224D HB-5
ULF 3000-24 N/A ULF1 A 10 6.8K SIH-24F HD-3 HSB-200 HB-55
ULF 3000-24 N/A ULF1 A 10 6.8K SIH-24F HD-3 HSB-220 HB-56
ULF 3000-24 N/A ULF1 A 10 6.8K SIH-24F HD-3 HSB-221 HB-54
ULF 3000-24 N/A ULF1 A 10 6.8K SIH-24F HD-3 HSB-224 HB-53
ULF 3000-24 N/A ULF1 A 10 6.8K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-200D HB-20
ULF 3000-24 N/A ULF1 A 10 6.8K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
ULF 3000-24 N/A ULF1 A 10 6.8K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-221D HB-4
ULF 3000-24 N/A ULF1 A 10 6.8K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-224D HB-5
ULF 3000-24 N/A ULF1 A 10 6.8K SLK-24F HD-3 HSB-200 HB-55
ULF 3000-24 N/A ULF1 A 10 6.8K SLK-24F HD-3 HSB-220 HB-56
ULF 3000-24 N/A ULF1 A 10 6.8K SLK-24F HD-3 HSB-221 HB-54
ULF 3000-24 N/A ULF1 A 10 6.8K SLK-24F HD-3 HSB-224 HB-53
ULF 3000-24 N/A ULF1 A 10 6.8K SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-200D HB-20
ULF 3000-24 N/A ULF1 A 10 6.8K SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
ULF 3000-24 N/A ULF1 A 10 6.8K SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-221D HB-4
ULF 3000-24 N/A ULF1 A 10 6.8K SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-224D HB-5
ULF 3000-24 N/A ULF1 A 10 6.8K SLK-24FH HD-3 HSB-200 HB-55
ULF 3000-24 N/A ULF1 A 10 6.8K SLK-24FH HD-3 HSB-220 HB-56
ULF 3000-24 N/A ULF1 A 10 6.8K SLK-24FH HD-3 HSB-221 HB-54
ULF 3000-24 N/A ULF1 A 10 6.8K SLK-24FH HD-3 HSB-224 HB-53
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
ANSUL
2-Wire Compatibility Listings
PANEL MODEL ZONE MODEL ZONE LOOP MAX EOL DETECTOR DETECTOR BASE MODEL BASE ID
ID STYLE DET MODEL ID
AUTOPULSE FOUR 415413 REV.4 B 45 417213 DCA-135 N/A HSC-21L HB-60
AUTOPULSE FOUR 415413 REV.4 B 45 417213 DCA-190 N/A HSC-21L HB-60
AUTOPULSE FOUR 415413 REV.4 B 45 417213 SIH-24F HD-3 HS-21D HB-2
AUTOPULSE FOUR 415413 REV.4 B 45 417213 SIH-24F HD-3 HSB-21 HB-51
AUTOPULSE FOUR 415413 REV.4 B 45 417213 SIH-24F HD-3 HSC-224R HB-73
AUTOPULSE FOUR 415413 REV.4 B 45 417213 SLK-24F HD-3 YBA-M21 HB-2
AUTOPULSE FOUR 415413 REV.4 B 45 417213 SLK-24F HD-3 HS-21D HB-2
AUTOPULSE FOUR 415413 REV.4 B 45 417213 SLK-24F HD-3 HSB-21 HB-51
AUTOPULSE FOUR 415413 REV.4 B 45 417213 SLK-24F HD-3 HSB-21 HB-51
AUTOPULSE FOUR 415413 REV.4 B 45 417213 SLK-24F HD-3 HSC-224R HB-73
AUTOPULSE FOUR 415413 REV.4 B 45 417213 SLK-24FH HD-3 YBA-M21 HB-2
AUTOPULSE FOUR 415413 REV.4 B 45 417213 SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-21D HB-2
AUTOPULSE FOUR 415413 REV.4 B 45 417213 SLK-24FH HD-3 HSB-21 HB-51
AUTOPULSE FOUR 415413 REV.4 B 45 417213 SLK-24FH HD-3 HSC-224R HB-73
AUTOPULSE FOUR 415413 REV.4 B 45 417213 DCA-135 N/A YBA-M21 HB-2
AUTOPULSE FOUR 416610 REV. 1 D 45 417213 DCA-190 N/A HSC-21L HB-60
AUTOPULSE FOUR 416610 REV. 1 D 45 417213 SIH-24F HD-3 HSC-21L HB-60
AUTOPULSE FOUR 416610 REV. 1 D 45 417213 SIH-24F HD-3 HS-21D HB-2
AUTOPULSE FOUR 416610 REV. 1 D 45 417213 SIH-24F HD-3 HSB-21 HB-51
AUTOPULSE FOUR 416610 REV. 1 D 45 417213 SIH-24F HD-3 HSC-224R HB-73
AUTOPULSE FOUR 416610 REV. 1 D 45 417213 SLK-24F HD-3 YBA-M21 HB-2
AUTOPULSE FOUR 416610 REV. 1 D 45 417213 SLK-24F HD-3 HS-21D HB-2
AUTOPULSE FOUR 416610 REV. 1 D 45 417213 SLK-24F HD-3 HSB-21 HB-51
AUTOPULSE FOUR 416610 REV. 1 D 45 417213 SLK-24F HD-3 HSC-224R HB-73
AUTOPULSE FOUR 416610 REV. 1 D 45 417213 SLK-24F HD-3 YBA-M21 HB-2
AUTOPULSE FOUR 416610 REV. 1 D 45 417213 SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-21D HB-2
AUTOPULSE FOUR 416610 REV. 1 D 45 417213 SLK-24FH HD-3 HSB-21 HB-51
AUTOPULSE FOUR 416610 REV. 1 D 45 417213 SLK-24FH HD-3 HSC-224R HB-73
AUTOPULSE FOUR 416610 REV. 1 D 45 417213 SLK-24FH HD-3 YBA-M21 HB-2
AUTOPULSE IQ301 MMX-2, M3-TW A B 24 3.9K 1400 A N/A N/A
AUTOPULSE IQ301 MMX-2, M3-TW A B 20 3.9K 1451 A B401 A
AUTOPULSE IQ301 MMX-2, M3-TW A B 20 3.9K 1451 A B401B A
AUTOPULSE IQ301 MMX-2, M3-TW A B 1 3.9K 1451 A B406B A
AUTOPULSE IQ301 MMX-2, M3-TW A B 20 3.9K 1451DH A DH400 A
AUTOPULSE IQ301 MMX-2, M3-TW A B 20 3.9K 1851DH A DH1851DC A
AUTOPULSE IQ301 MMX-2, M3-TW A B 20 3.9K 2400 A N/A N/A
AUTOPULSE IQ301 MMX-2, M3-TW A B 1 3.9K 2400AIT A N/A N/A
AUTOPULSE IQ301 MMX-2, M3-TW A B 1 3.9K 2400AT A N/A N/A
AUTOPULSE IQ301 MMX-2, M3-TW A B 20 3.9K 2400TH A N/A N/A
AUTOPULSE IQ301 MMX-2, M3-TW A B 20 3.9K 2451 A B401 A
AUTOPULSE IQ301 MMX-2, M3-TW A B 20 3.9K 2451 A B401B A
AUTOPULSE IQ301 MMX-2, M3-TW A B 20 3.9K 2451 A DH400 A
AUTOPULSE IQ301 MMX-2, M3-TW A B 20 3.9K 2451TH A B401 A
AUTOPULSE IQ301 MMX-2, M3-TW A B 20 3.9K 2451TH A B401B A
AUTOPULSE IQ301 MMX-2, M3-TW A B 1 3.9K 2451TH A B406B A
AUTOPULSE IQ301 MMX-2, M3-TW A B 20 3.9K 2851DH A DH2851DC A
AUTOPULSE IQ301 MMX-2, M3-TW A B 1 3.9K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-2-RB HB-10
AUTOPULSE IQ301 MMX-2, M3-TW A B 25 3.9K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
AUTOPULSE IQ301 MMX-2, M3-TW A B 25 3.9K SIH-24F HD-3 YBA-M22 HB-3
AUTOPULSE IQ301 MMX-2, M3-TW A B 1 3.9K SLD-24F HD-3 HS-2-RB HB-10
AUTOPULSE IQ301 MMX-2, M3-TW A B 25 3.9K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
AUTOPULSE IQ301 MMX-2, M3-TW A B 1 3.9K SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-2-RB HB-10
AUTOPULSE IQ301 MMX-2, M3-TW A B 25 3.9K SLK-24FH HD-3 YBA-M22 HB-3
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
C & K SYSTEMS
2-Wire Compatibility Listings
PANEL MODEL ZONE MODEL ZONE LOOP MAX EOL DETECTOR DETECTOR BASE MODEL BASE ID
ID STYLE DET MODEL ID
238,2316 ZONE 8 NONE A 10 2.2K SLK-12 HD-4 HSB-12-1 HB-80
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 5-Mar-2003
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
CADDX
2-Wire Compatibility Listings
PANEL MODEL ZONE MODEL ZONE LOOP MAX EOL DETECTOR DETECTOR BASE MODEL BASE ID
ID STYLE DET MODEL ID
NX6, NX8 3800-0001 MDL NO A 20 680 OHMS SLR-835,-835W HD-3 NS4-220,NS6-220 HB-3
NX6,NX8 3800-0001 MDL NO A 20 680 OHMS SLR-835B-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
NX8-E 3800-0020 MDL NO A 20 680 OHMS SLR-835,-835W HD-3 NS4-220,NS6-220 HB-3
NX8-E 3800-0020 MDL NO A 20 680 OHMS SLR-835B-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
CHEMETRON
2-Wire Compatibility Listings
PANEL MODEL ZONE MODELZONE LOOP MAX EOL DETECTOR DETECTOR BASE MODEL BASE ID
ID STYLE DET MODEL ID
MICRO 1-EV A A D 60 N/A SIH-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
MICRO 1-EV A A D 60 N/A SIH-24F HD-3 HS-224D HB-5
MICRO 1-EV A A D 60 N/A SIH-24F HD-3 HS-224RB HB-12
MICRO 1-EV A A D 50 N/A SLK-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
MICRO 1-EV A A D 50 N/A SLK-24F HD-3 HS-220RB HB-12
MICRO 1-EV A A D 50 N/A SLK-24F HD-3 HS-224D HB-5
MICRO 1-EV A A D 50 N/A SLK-24F HD-3 HS-224RB HB-14
MICRO 1-EV A A D 50 N/A SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
MICRO 1-EV A A D 50 N/A SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-220RB HB-12
MICRO 1-EV A A D 50 N/A SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-224D HB-5
MICRO 1-EV A A D 50 N/A SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-224RB HB-14
MICRO1-EV N/A 4 B,D 14 2.7K OHM DCD-135, DCD-190 HD-3 HSC-224L HB-62
MICRO1-EV N/A 4 B,D 14 2.7K OHM DCD-135, DCD-190 HD-3 HSC-224L HB-62
MICRO1-EV N/A 4 B,D 14 2.7K OHM DFE-190 HD-3 HSC-220L HB-64
MICRO1-EV N/A 4 B,D 14 2.7K OHM DFE-190 HD-3 HSC-220L HB-64
MICRO1-EV N/A 4 B,D 14 2.7K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 NS4-224,NS6-224 HB-5
MICRO1-EV N/A 4 B,D 14 2.7K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 NS4-224,NS6-224 HB-5
MICRO1-EV N/A 4 B,D 14 2.7K OHM SLR-24 HD-3 NS4-224,NS6-224 HB-5
MICRO1-EV N/A 4 B,D 14 2.7K OHM SLR-24,-24H HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
MICRO1-EV N/A 4 B,D 14 2.7K OHM SLR-24,-24H HD-3 NS4-220,NS6-220 HB-3
MICRO1-EV N/A 4 B,D 14 2.7K OHM SLR-24, SLR-24H HD-3 HSC-224R HB-73
MICRO1-EV N/A 4 B,D 14 2.7K OHM SLR-24, SLR-24H HD-3 HSC-224R HB-73
MICRO1-EV N/A 4 B,D 14 2.7K OHM SLR-24H HD-3 NS4-224,NS6-224 HB-5
MICRO1-EV N/A 4 B,D 14 2.7K OHM SLR-835B-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
MICRO1-EV CLASS N/A 4 B,D 10 2.7K OHM DCD-135 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
MICRO1-EV CLASS N/A 4 B,D 10 2.7K OHM DCD-135 HD-3 NS4-220,NS6-220 HB-3
MICRO1-EV CLASS N/A 4 B,D 10 2.7K OHM DCD-190 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
MICRO1-EV CLASS N/A 4 B,D 10 2.7K OHM DCD-190 HD-3 NS4-220,NS6-220 HB-3
MICRO1-EV CLASS N/A 4 B,D 10 2.7K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
MICRO1-EV CLASS N/A 4 B,D 10 2.7K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 NS4-220,NS6-220 HB-3
MICRO1-EV CLASS N/A 4 B,D 10 2.7K OHM SLR-24 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
MICRO1-EV CLASS N/A 4 B,D 10 2.7K OHM SLR-24 HD-3 NS4-220,NS6-220 HB-3
SG N/A 1 B 33 4.7K OHM SIF-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
SG N/A 1 B 33 4.7K OHM SIH-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
SG N/A 1 B 33 4.7K OHM SLK-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
SG N/A 1 B 33 4.7K OHM SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
DETECTION SYS.
2-Wire Compatibility Listings
PANEL MODEL ZONE MODEL ZONE LOOP MAX EOL DETECTOR DETECTOR BASE MODEL BASE ID
ID STYLE DET MODEL ID
DS9400I, DS9400M N/A A B 20 2.2K OHM DCD-135,-190 HD-3 HSC-220L HB-64
DS9400I, DS9400M N/A A B 20 2.2K OHM DCD-135,-190 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
DS9400I, DS9400M N/A A B 20 2.2K OHM DCD-135,-190 HD-3 NS4-220,NS6-220 HB-3
DS9400I, DS9400M N/A A B 20 2.2K OHM DCD-135,-190 HD-3 HSC-220L HB-64
DS9400I, DS9400M N/A A B 20 2.2K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
DS9400I, DS9400M N/A A B 20 2.2K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 NS4-220,NS6-220 HB-3
DS9400I, DS9400M N/A A B 20 2.2K OHM SLR-24H,-24V HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
DS9400I, DS9400M N/A A B 20 2.2K OHM SLR-24H,-24V HD-3 NS4-100,NS6-100 HB-55
DS9400I, DS9400M N/A A B 20 2.2K OHM SLR-24H,-24V HD-3 NS4-220,NS6-220 HB-3
DS9400I, DS9400M N/A A B 20 2.2K OHM SLR-835 HD-3 NS4-100,NS6-100 HB-55
DS9400I, DS9400M N/A A B 20 2.2K OHM SLR-835 HD-3 NS4-220,NS6-220 HB-3
DS9400I, DS9400M N/A A B 20 2.2K OHM SLR-835B-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
DS9400I, DS9400M N/A A B 20 2.2K OHM SLR-835H HD-5 HSC-220R HB-72
DS9400I, DS9400M N/A A B 20 2.2K OHM SLR-835H HD-5 NS4-220,NS6-220 HB-3
DS9400I, DS9400M N/A A B 1 2.2K OHM SLR-835,-835W HD-5 SBC-2R,SBC-2RW HB-85
DS9400I, DS9400M N/A A B 1 2.2K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 SBC-2 HB-85
DS9400I, DS9400M N/A A B 1 2.2K OHM SLR-24V HD-3 SBC-2 HB-85
DS9400I, DS9400M N/A A B 1 2.2K OHM SLR-24V HD-3 SBC-2R HB-86
UPDATED 9/11/03
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
DIGITAL MONITOR
2-Wire Compatibility Listings
PANEL MODEL ZONE MODEL ZONE LOOP MAX EOL DETECTOR DETECTOR BASE MODEL BASE ID
ID STYLE DET MODEL ID
XR5FC 2--5 A A 22 3.3k SLK12 HD-4 HSB-12-1,-12-1N HB-80
XR5FC 2--5 A A 7 3.3k SLK-835,-835H HD-5 HSB-200,-200N HB-55
XR5SL 2--5 A A 22 3.3k SLK-12 HD-4 HSB-12-1,-12-1N HB-80
XR5SL 2--5 A A 7 3.3k SLK-835,-835H HD-5 HSB-200,-200N HB-55
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
DMP
2-Wire Compatibility Listings
PANEL MODEL ZONE MODEL ZONE LOOP MAX EOL DETECTOR DETECTOR BASE MODEL BASE ID
ID STYLE DET MODEL ID
XR10 10 ON XR10 A A 22 3.3K SLK-12 HD-4 HSB-12-1,-12-1N HB-80
XR10 10 ON XR10 A A 7 3.3K SLK-835,-835H HD-5 HSB-200,-200N HB-55
XR10 10 ON XR10 A A 7 3.3K SLR-835 HD-3 NS6-100 HB-55
XR20 10 ON XR20 A A 22 3.3K SLK-12 HD-4 HSB-12-1,-12-1N HB-80
XR20 10 ON XR20 A A 7 3.3K SLK-835,-835H HD-5 HSB-200,-200N HB-55
XR20 10 ON XR20 A A 7 3.3K SLR-835 HD-3 NS6-100 HB-55
XR20 10 ON XR20 A A 7 3.3K SLR-835B HD-6 NA NA
XR20 715 A A 7 3.3K SLR-835 HD-3 NS6-100 HB-55
XR20 715,-16 A A 7 3.3K SLR-835B HD-6 NA NA
XR20 715,-16,-8 A A 7 3.3K SLK-835,-835H HD-5 HSB-200,-200N HB-55
XR20 715,-16-,-8 A A 22 3.3K SLK-12 HD-4 HSB-12-1,-12-1N HB-80
XR20 715-16 A A 7 3.3K SLR-835 HD-3 NS6-100 HB-55
XR20 715-8 A A 7 3.3K SLR-835 HD-3 NS6-100 HB-55
XR20 715-8 A A 7 3.3K SLR-835B HD-6 NA NA
XR200 10 ON XR200 A A 7 3.3K SLK-835,-835H HD-5 HSB-200,-200N HB-55
XR200 715 A A 22 3.3K SLK-12 HD-4 HSB-12-1,-12-1N HB-80
XR200 715 A A 7 3.3K SLK-835,-835H HD-5 HSB-200,-200N HB-55
XR200 715 OR Z 9 &10 A A 22 3.3K SLK-12 HD-4 HSB-12-1,-12-1N HB-80
XR200 715, 715-16 A A 7 3.3K SLK-835,-835H HD-5 HSB-200,-200N HB-55
XR200 715,-16 A A 7 3.3K SLR-835 HD-3 NS6-100 HB-55
XR200 715,-16 A A 7 3.3K SLR-835B HD-6 NA NA
XR200 715,-16,-8 A A 22 3.3K SLK-12 HD-4 HSB-12-1,-12-1N HD-4
XR200 715-8 A A 7 3.3K SLK-835,-835H HD-5 HSB-200,-200N HB-55
XR200 715-8 A A 7 3.3K SLR-835 HD-3 NS6-100 HB-55
XR200 9 & 10 ON XR200 A A 22 3.3K SLK-12 HD-4 HSB-12-1,-12-1N HB-80
XR200 9 ON XR200 A A 7 3.3K SLK-835,-835H HD-5 HSB-200,-200N HB-55
XR200 9,10 ON XR200 A A 7 3.3K SLR-835 HD-3 NS6-100 HB-55
XR200 9,10 ON XR200 A A 7 3.3K SLR-835B HD-6 NA NA
XR200 XR200 A A 22 3.3K SLK-12 HD-4 HSB-12-1,-12-1N HB-80
XR200 XR200 A A 7 3.3K SLK-835,-835H HD-5 HSB-200,-200N HB-55
XR5FC 2-5 ON XR5FC A A 22 3.3K SLK-12 HD-4 HSB-12-1,-12-1N HB-80
XR5FC 2-5 ON XR5FC A A 7 3.3K SLK-835,-835H HD-5 HSB-200,-200N HB-55
XR5FC 2-5 ON XR5FC A A 7 3.3K SLR-835 HD-6 NA NA
XR5FC 2-5 ON XR5FC A A 7 3.3K SLR-835 HD-3 NS6-100 HB-55
XR5SL 2-5 ON XR5SL A A 22 3.3K SLK-12 HD-4 HSB-12-1,-12-1N HB-80
XR5SL 2-5 ON XR5SL A A 7 3.3K SLK-835,-835H HD-5 HSB-200,-200N HB-55
XR5SL 2-5 ON XR5SL A A 7 3.3K SLR-835 HD-3 NS6-100 HB-55
XR5SL 2-5 ON XR5SL A A 7 3.3K SLR-835B HD-6 NA NA
XR6 6 ON XR6 A A 7 3.3K SLR-835 HD-3 NS6-100 HB-55
XR6 6 ON XR6 A A 7 3.3K SLR-835B HD-6 NA NA
XR6 715 A A 7 3.3K SLR-835B HD-6 NA NA
XR6 715 ON XR6 A A 7 3.3K SLR-835 HD-3 NS6-100 HB-55
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
DSC
2-Wire Compatibility Listings
PANEL MODEL ZONE MODEL ZONE LOOP MAX EOL DETECTOR DETECTOR BASE MODEL BASE ID
ID STYLE DET MODEL ID
PC1555 UA000 PC15-1 B 30 2.2K OHM SLR-835, 835W HD-3 NS4-220,NS6-220 HB-3
PC1555 UA000 PC15-1 B 30 2.2K OHM SLR-835B-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
PC1555 UA000 PC15-1 B 30 2.2K OHM SLR-835BH-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
PC4020CF PC4701 PM-2 B 30 2.2K OHM SLR-835, 835W HD-3 NS4-220,NS6-220 HB-3
PC4020CF PC4701 PM-2 B 30 2.2K OHM SLR-835B-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
PC4020CF PC4701 PM-2 B 30 2.2K OHM SLR-835BH-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
PC5010 PC5010 PC5-1 B 30 2.2K OHM SLR-835, 835W HD-3 NS4-220,NS6-220 HB-3
PC5010 PC5010 PC5-1 B 30 2.2K OHM SLR-835B-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
PC5010 PC5010 PC5-1 B 30 2.2K OHM SLR-835BH-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
PC5020 PC5020 PC5-2 B 30 2.2K OHM SLR-835, 835W HD-3 NS4-220,NS6-220 HB-3
PC5020 PC5020 PC5-2 B 30 2.2K OHM SLR-835B-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
PC5020 PC5020 PC5-2 B 30 2.2K OHM SLR-835BH-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
EDWARDS
2-Wire Compatibility Listings
PANEL MODEL ZONE MODEL ZONE LOOP MAX EOL DETECTOR DETECTOR BASE MODEL BASE ID
ID STYLE DET MODEL ID
5783B N/A 001 B 33 4.7K OHM SIF-24F HD-2 HS-220D HB-3
5783B N/A 001 B 33 4.7K OHM SIH-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
5783B N/A 001 B 33 4.7K OHM SLK-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
5783B N/A 001 B 33 4.7K OHM SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
F.A.S.T. INC.
2-Wire Compatibility Listings
PANEL MODEL ZONE MODEL ZONE LOOP MAX EOL DETECTOR MODEL DETECTOR BASE MODEL BASE ID
ID STYLE DET ID
RZB12-6MFC 240204 5389 B 15 PN260001 SIF-24F HD-2 HS-22D HB-3
RZB12-6MFC 240204 5389 B 15 PN260001 SIF-24F HD-3 YBA-M22 HB-3
RZB12-6MFC 240204 5389 B 15 PN260001 SLK-24F HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
RZB12-6MFC 240204 5389 B 15 PN260001 SLK-24F HD-3 YBA-M22 HB-3
RZB12-6MFC 240204 5389 B 15 PN260001 SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
RZB12-6MFC 240204 5389 B 15 PN260001 SLK-24FH HD-3 YBA-M22 HB-3
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
FARADAY
2-Wire Compatibility Listings
PANEL MODEL ZONE MODEL ZONE LOOP MAX EOL DETECTOR MODEL DETECTOR BASE MODEL BASE ID
ID STYLE DET ID
852 N/A FOS1 B 30 3.9K OHM DCA-135 N/A HS-224L HB-18
852 N/A FOS1 B 30 3.9K OHM DCA-190 N/A HS-224L HB-18
852 N/A FOS1 B 30 3.9K OHM DCA-190 N/A HS-224L HB-18
852 N/A FOS1 B 30 3.9K OHM DFE-135 N/A HS-224L HB-18
852 N/A FOS1 B 30 3.9K OHM DFE-190 N/A HS-224L HB-18
854 N/A FOS1 B 30 3.9K OHM DCA-135 N/A HS-224L HB-18
854 N/A FOS1 B 30 3.9K OHM DCA-190 N/A HS-224L HB-18
854 N/A FOS1 B 30 3.9K OHM DFE-135 N/A HS-224L HB-18
854 N/A FOS1 B 30 3.9K OHM DFE-190 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15108AL N/A FOS2 B 30 5.6K OHM DCA-135 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15108AL N/A FOS2 D 30 N/A DCA-135 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15108AL N/A FOS2 B 30 5.6K OHM DCA-190 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15108AL N/A FOS2 D 30 N/A DCA-190 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15108AL N/A FOS2 B 30 5.6K OHM DFE-135 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15108AL N/A FOS2 B 30 5.6K OHM DFE-135 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15108AL N/A FOS2 D 30 N/A DFE-135 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15108AL N/A FOS2 D 30 N/A DFE-135 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15108AL N/A FOS2 B 30 5.6K OHM DFE-190 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15108AL N/A FOS2 B 30 5.6K OHM DFE-190 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15108AL N/A FOS2 D 30 N/A DFE-190 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15108AL N/A FOS2 D 30 N/A DFE-190 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15112AL N/A FOS2 B 30 5.6K OHM DCA-135 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15112AL N/A FOS2 B 30 5.6K OHM DCA-135 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15112AL N/A FOS2 D 30 N/A DCA-135 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15112AL N/A FOS2 D 30 N/A DCA-135 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15112AL N/A FOS2 B 30 5.6K OHM DCA-190 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15112AL N/A FOS2 B 30 5.6K OHM DCA-190 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15112AL N/A FOS2 D 30 N/A DCA-190 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15112AL N/A FOS2 D 30 N/A DCA-190 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15112AL N/A FOS2 B 30 5.6K OHM DFE-135 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15112AL N/A FOS2 B 30 5.6K OHM DFE-135 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15112AL N/A FOS2 D 30 N/A DFE-135 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15112AL N/A FOS2 D 30 N/A DFE-135 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15112AL N/A FOS2 B 30 5.6K OHM DFE-190 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15112AL N/A FOS2 B 30 5.6K OHM DFE-190 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15112AL N/A FOS2 D 30 N/A DFE-190 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15112AL N/A FOS2 D 30 N/A DFE-190 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15116AL N/A FOS2 B 30 5.6K OHM DCA-135 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15116AL N/A FOS2 B 30 5.6K OHM DCA-135 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15116AL N/A FOS2 D 30 N/A DCA-135 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15116AL N/A FOS2 D 30 N/A DCA-135 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15116AL N/A FOS2 B 30 5.6K OHM DCA-190 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15116AL N/A FOS2 B 30 5.6K OHM DCA-190 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15116AL N/A FOS2 D 30 N/A DCA-190 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15116AL N/A FOS2 D 30 N/A DCA-190 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15116AL N/A FOS2 B 30 5.6K OHM DFE-135 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15116AL N/A FOS2 B 30 5.6K OHM DFE-135 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15116AL N/A FOS2 D 30 N/A DFE-135 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15116AL N/A FOS2 D 30 N/A DFE-135 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15116AL N/A FOS2 B 30 5.6K OHM DFE-190 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15116AL N/A FOS2 B 30 5.6K OHM DFE-190 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15116AL N/A FOS2 D 30 N/A DFE-190 N/A HS-224L HB-18
15116AL N/A FOS2 D 30 N/A DFE-190 N/A HS-224L HB-18
19000A N/A B B 30 5.6K OHM DCA-135 N/A HS-224L HB-18
19000A N/A B B 30 5.6K OHM DCA-135 N/A HS-224L HB-18
19000A N/A B D 30 N/A DCA-135 N/A HS-224L HB-18
19000A N/A B D 30 N/A DCA-135 N/A HS-224L HB-18
19000A N/A B B 30 5.6K OHM DCA-190 N/A HS-224L HB-18
19000A N/A B B 30 5.6K OHM DCA-190 N/A HS-224L HB-18
19000A N/A B D 30 N/A DCA-190 N/A HS-224L HB-18
19000A N/A B D 30 N/A DCA-190 N/A HS-224L HB-18
19000A N/A B B 30 5.6K OHM DFE-135 N/A HS-224L HB-18
19000A N/A B B 30 5.6K OHM DFE-135 N/A HS-224L HB-18
19000A N/A B D 30 N/A DFE-135 N/A HS-224L HB-18
19000A N/A B D 30 N/A DFE-135 N/A HS-224L HB-18
19000A N/A B B 30 5.6K OHM DFE-190 N/A HS-224L HB-18
19000A N/A B B 30 5.6K OHM DFE-190 N/A HS-224L HB-18
19000A N/A B D 30 N/A DFE-190 N/A HS-224L HB-18
Page 1 of 2
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
Page 2 of 2
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
FIKE
2-Wire Compatibility Listings
PANEL MODEL ZONE MODEL ZONE LOOP MAX EOL DETECTOR MODEL DETECTOR BASE MODEL BASE ID
ID STYLE DET ID
RHINO 10-2141, 10-2144 DET220 B, D 50 3.3K OHM DFE-135, -190 N/A HSC-220L HB-64
RHINO 10-2141, 10-2144 DET220 B, D 50 3.3K OHM SLR-24H HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
RHINO 10-2141, 10-2144 DET220 B, D 50 3.3K OHM SLR-24H HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
RHINO 10-050 10-2141, -2144 DET220 B, D 50 3.3K OHM SLR-835B-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
RHINO 10-050 10-2141, 10-2144 DET470 B 30 3.3K OHM DCD-135 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
RHINO 10-050 10-2141, 10-2144 DET470 B 30 3.3K OHM DCD-135 HD-3 HSC-221R HB-71
RHINO 10-050 10-2141, 10-2144 DET470 B 30 3.3K OHM DCD-135 HD-3 HSC-224R HB-73
RHINO 10-050 10-2141, 10-2144 DET470 B 30 3.3K OHM DCD-135 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
RHINO 10-050 10-2141, 10-2144 DET470 B 30 3.3K OHM DCD-135 HD-3 NS4-221, NS6-221 HB-4
RHINO 10-050 10-2141, 10-2144 DET470 B 30 3.3K OHM DCD-135 HD-3 NS4-224, NS6-224 HB-5
RHINO 10-050 10-2141, 10-2144 DET470 B 30 3.3K OHM DCD-190 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
RHINO 10-050 10-2141, 10-2144 DET470 B 30 3.3K OHM DCD-190 HD-3 HSC-221R HB-71
RHINO 10-050 10-2141, 10-2144 DET470 B 30 3.3K OHM DCD-190 HD-3 HSC-224R HB-73
RHINO 10-050 10-2141, 10-2144 DET470 B 30 3.3K OHM DCD-190 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
RHINO 10-050 10-2141, 10-2144 DET470 B 30 3.3K OHM DCD-190 HD-3 NS4-221, NS6-221 HB-4
RHINO 10-050 10-2141, 10-2144 DET470 B 30 3.3K OHM DCD-190 HD-3 NS4-224, NS6-224 HB-5
RHINO 10-050 10-2141, 10-2144 DET470 B 30 3.3K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
RHINO 10-050 10-2141, 10-2144 DET470 B 30 3.3K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 HSC-221R HB-71
RHINO 10-050 10-2141, 10-2144 DET470 B 30 3.3K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 HSC-224R HB-73
RHINO 10-050 10-2141, 10-2144 DET470 B 30 3.3K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
RHINO 10-050 10-2141, 10-2144 DET470 B 30 3.3K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 NS4-221, NS6-221 HB-4
RHINO 10-050 10-2141, 10-2144 DET470 B 30 3.3K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 NS4-224, NS6-224 HB-5
RHINO 10-050 10-2141, 10-2144 DET470 B 30 3.3K OHM SLR-24 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
RHINO 10-050 10-2141, 10-2144 DET470 B 30 3.3K OHM SLR-24 HD-3 HSC-221R HB-71
RHINO 10-050 10-2141, 10-2144 DET470 B 30 3.3K OHM SLR-24 HD-3 HSC-224R HB-73
RHINO 10-050 10-2141, 10-2144 DET470 B 30 3.3K OHM SLR-24 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
RHINO 10-050 10-2141, 10-2144 DET470 B 30 3.3K OHM SLR-24 HD-3 NS4-221, NS6-221 HB-4
RHINO 10-050 10-2141, 10-2144 DET470 B 30 3.3K OHM SLR-24 HD-3 NS4-224, NS6-224 HB-5
SHP 10-051 10-2171 102171 B 25 4.3K OHM DCD-135 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
SHP 10-051 10-2171 102171 B 25 4.3K OHM DCD-135 HD-3 HSC-221R HB-71
SHP 10-051 10-2171 102171 B 25 4.3K OHM DCD-135 HD-3 HSC-224R HB-73
SHP 10-051 10-2171 102171 B 25 4.3K OHM DCD-135 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
SHP 10-051 10-2171 102171 B 25 4.3K OHM DCD-135 HD-3 NS4-221, NS6-221 HB-4
SHP 10-051 10-2171 102171 B 25 4.3K OHM DCD-135 HD-3 NS4-224, NS6-224 HB-5
SHP 10-051 10-2171 MDL. NO B, D 25 4.3K OHM DCD-135, DCD-190 HD-3 NS4-221, NS6-221 HB-4
SHP 10-051 10-2171 102171 B 25 4.3K OHM DCD-190 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
SHP 10-051 10-2171 102171 B 25 4.3K OHM DCD-190 HD-3 HSC-221R HB-71
SHP 10-051 10-2171 102171 B 25 4.3K OHM DCD-190 HD-3 HSC-224R HB-73
SHP 10-051 10-2171 102171 B 25 4.3K OHM DCD-190 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
SHP 10-051 10-2171 102171 B 25 4.3K OHM DCD-190 HD-3 NS4-221, NS6-221 HB-4
SHP 10-051 10-2171 102171 B 25 4.3K OHM DCD-190 HD-3 NS4-224, NS6-224 HB-5
SHP 10-051 10-2171 102171 B 25 4.3K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
SHP 10-051 10-2171 102171 B 25 4.3K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 HSC-221R HB-71
SHP 10-051 10-2171 102171 B 25 4.3K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 HSC-224R HB-73
SHP 10-051 10-2171 102171 B 25 4.3K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
SHP 10-051 10-2171 MDL. NO B, D 25 4.3K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 NS4-221, NS6-221 HB-4
SHP 10-051 10-2171 102171 B 25 4.3K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 NS4-221, NS6-221 HB-4
SHP 10-051 10-2171 102171 B 25 4.3K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 NS4-224, NS6-224 HB-5
SHP 10-051 10-2171 102171 B 25 4.3K OHM SLR-24 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
SHP 10-051 10-2171 102171 B 25 4.3K OHM SLR-24 HD-3 HSC-221R HB-71
SHP 10-051 10-2171 102171 B 25 4.3K OHM SLR-24 HD-3 HSC-224R HB-73
SHP 10-051 10-2171 102171 B 25 4.3K OHM SLR-24 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
SHP 10-051 10-2171 102171 B 25 4.3K OHM SLR-24 HD-3 NS4-221, NS6-221 HB-4
SHP 10-051 10-2171 MDL NO B, D 25 4.3K OHM SLR-24 HD-3 NS4-221, NS6-221 HB-4
SHP 10-051 10-2171 102171 B 25 4.3K OHM SLR-24 HD-3 NS4-224, NS6-224 HB-5
SHP 10-051 10-2171 MDL. NO B, D 25 4.3K OHM SLR-835B-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
10-038 N/A 038000 B 87 1.5K OHM SIH-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
10-038 N/A 038000 D 87 N/A SIH-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
10-038 N/A 038000 B 87 1.5K OHM SIH-24F HD-3 YBA-M220 HB-3
10-038 N/A 038000 D 87 N/A SIH-24F HD-3 YBA-M220 HB-3
10-038 N/A 038000 B 87 1.5K OHM SLK-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
10-038 N/A 038000 D 87 N/A SLK-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
10-038 N/A 038000 D 87 N/A SLK-24F HD-3 HS-220RB HB-12
10-038 N/A 038000 B 87 1.5K OHM SLK-24F HD-3 HS-220RB HB-12
10-038 N/A 038000 B 87 1.5K OHM SLK-24F HD-3 YBA-M220 HB-3
10-038 N/A 038000 D 87 N/A SLK-24F HD-3 YBA-M220 HB-3
10-039 N/A 038000 D 87 N/A SIH-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
10-039 N/A 038000 B 87 1.5K OHM SIH-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
Page 1 of 2
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
Page 2 of 2
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
FIRELITE
2-Wire Compatibility Listings
PANEL MODEL ZONE MODEL ZONE LOOP MAX EOL DETECTOR MODEL DETECTOR BASE MODEL BASE ID
ID STYLE DET ID
MP-12 N/A A B, D 11 2.2K LPSD-12 HD-4 BLP-12-R HB-83
MP-12 N/A A B, D 11 2.2K LPSD-12 HD-4 BLP-12-RN HB-83
MP-12 N/A A B, D 15 2.2K OHM SLR-835 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
MP-12 N/A A B, D 15 2.2K OHM SLR-835B-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
MP-24 N/A A B 15 2.2K OHM DCD-135, -190 HD-3 HSC-220L HB-64
MP-24 N/A A B 15 2.2K OHM DCD-135, -190 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
MP-24 N/A A B 15 2.2K OHM DCD-135, -190 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
MP-24 N/A A B 15 2.2K OHM DFE-135, -190 HD-3 HSC-220L HB-64
MP-24 N/A A B 15 2.2K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
MP-24 N/A A B 15 2.2K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
MP-24 N/A A B 15 2.2K OHM SLR-24H, -24V HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
MP-24 N/A A B 15 2.2K OHM SLR-24H, -24V HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
MP-24 N/A A B 15 2.2K OHM SLR-835 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
MP-24 N/A A B 15 2.2K OHM SLR-835B-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
MS-4012 N/A A B 11 2.2K LPSD-12 HD-4 BLP-12-R HB-83
MS-4012 N/A A B 11 2.2K LPSD-12 HD-4 BLP-12-RN HB-83
MS-4412B N/A A B 15 2.2K OHM DCD-135, -190 HD-3 HSC-220L HB-64
MS-4412B N/A A B 15 2.2K OHM DCD-135, -190 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
MS-4412B N/A A B 15 2.2K OHM DCD-135, -190 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
MS-4412B N/A A B 15 2.2K OHM DFE-135, -190 HD-3 HSC-220L HB-64
MS-4412B N/A A B 15 2.2K LPSD-12 HD-4 BLP-12-R HB-83
MS-4412B N/A A B 15 2.2K LPSD-12 HD-4 BLP-12-RN HB-83
MS-4412B N/A A B 15 2.2K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
MS-4412B N/A A B 15 2.2K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
MS-4412B N/A A B 15 2.2K OHM SLR-24H, -24V HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
MS-4412B N/A A B 15 2.2K OHM SLR-24H, -24V HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
MS-4412B N/A A B 15 2.2K OHM SLR-835 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
MS-4412B N/A A B 15 2.2K OHM SLR-835B-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
MS4412B N/A A B 10 2.2K OHM SLR-835BH-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
MS4412B N/A A B 10 2.2K OHM SLR-835H HD-5 NS4-220,NS6-220 HB-3
MS-5012 N/A A B 15 2.2K OHM DCD-135, -190 HD-3 HSC-220L HB-64
MS-5012 N/A A B 15 2.2K OHM DCD-135, -190 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
MS-5012 N/A A B 15 2.2K OHM DCD-135, -190 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
MS-5012 N/A A B 15 2.2K OHM DFE-135, -190 HD-3 HSC-220L HB-64
MS-5012 N/A A B 15 2.2K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
MS-5012 N/A A B 15 2.2K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
MS-5012 N/A A B 15 2.2K OHM SLR-24H, -24V HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
MS-5012 N/A A B 15 2.2K OHM SLR-24H, -24V HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
MS-5012 N/A A B 10 2.2K OHM SLR-835H HD-5 NS4-220,NS6-220 HB-3
MS-5012 N/A A B 15 2.2K OHM SLR-835 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
MS-5012 N/A A B 15 2.2K OHM SLR-835B-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
MS-5012 ZONE 2, 3 A B 11 2.2K LPSD-12 HD-4 BLP-12-R HB-83
MS-5012 ZONE 2, 3 A B 11 2.2K LPSD-12 HD-4 BLP-12-RN HB-83
MS-5024, -5024UD N/A A B, D 15 4.7K OHM DCD-135, -190 HD-3 HSC-220L HB-64
MS-5024, -5024UD N/A A B, D 15 4.7K OHM DCD-135, -190 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
MS-5024, -5024UD N/A A B, D 15 4.7K OHM DCD-135, -190 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
MS-5024, -5024UD N/A A B, D 15 4.7K OHM DFE-135, -190 HD-3 HSC-220L HB-64
MS-5024, -5024UD N/A A B, D 15 4.7K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
MS-5024, -5024UD N/A A B, D 15 4.7K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
MS-5024, -5024UD N/A A B, D 15 4.7K OHM SLR-24H, -24V HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
MS-5024, -5024UD N/A A B, D 15 4.7K OHM SLR-24H, -24V HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
MS-5024, -5024UD N/A A B, D 15 4.7K OHM SLR-835 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
MS-5024, -5024UD N/A A B, D 15 4.7K OHM SLR-835B-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
MS-5024,-5024UD N/A A B 10 4.7K OHM SLR-835H HD-5 HSC-220R HB-72
MS-5024,-5024UD N/A A B 10 4.7K OHM SLR-835H HD-5 NS4-220,NS6-220 HB-3
MS-5024,-5024UD N/A A B,D 1 4.7K OHM SLR-835,-835W HD-5 SBC-2,SBC-2W HB-85
MS-5024,-5024UD N/A A B,D 1 4.7K OHM SLR-835,-835W HD-5 SBC-2R,SBC-2RW HB-85
MS-5024,-5024UD N/A A B,D 1 4.7K OHM SLR-835H,-835HW HD-5 SBC-2R,SBC-2RW HB-85
MS-5024,-5024UD N/A A B,D 1 4.7K OHM SLR-835H,-835HW HD-5 SBC-2,SBC-2W HB-85
MS-5024,-5024UD N/A A B,D 1 4.7K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 SBC-2 HB-85
MS-5024,-5024UD N/A A B,D 1 4.7K OHM SLR-24V HD-3 SBC-2 HB-85
MS-5024,-5024UD N/A A B,D 1 4.7K OHM SLR-24V HD-3 SBC-2R HB-85
MS-5210UD CAC-10E A B,D 10 4.7K OHM SLR-835BH-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
MS-5210UD CAC-10E A B,D 10 4.7K OHM SLR-835H HD-5 HSC-220R HB-72
MS-5210UD CAC-10E A B,D 10 4.7K OHM SLR-835H HD-5 NS4-220,NS6-220 HB-3
MS-5210UD N/A A B, D 15 4.7K OHM DCD-135, -190 HD-3 HSC-220L HB-64
MS-5210UD N/A A B, D 15 4.7K OHM DCD-135, -190 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
MS-5210UD N/A A B, D 15 4.7K OHM DCD-135, -190 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
MS-5210UD N/A A B, D 15 4.7K OHM DFE-135, -190 HD-3 HSC-220L HB-64
MS-5210UD N/A A B, D 15 4.7K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
MS-5210UD N/A A B, D 15 4.7K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
Page 1 of 2
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
UPDATED 9/11/03
Page 2 of 2
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
FIRESCAN
2-Wire Compatibility Listings
PANEL MODEL ZONE MODEL ZONE LOOP MAX EOL DETECTOR MODEL DETECTOR BASE MODEL BASE ID
ID STYLE DET ID
SHP 10-2171 MDL NO B/D 25 4.3K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-221D HB-4
SHP 10-2171 MDL NO B/D 25 4.3K SIH-24F HD-3 HSB-220 HB-56
SHP 10-2171 MDL NO B/D 25 4.3K SIH-24F HD-3 HSB-224 HB-53
SHP 10-2171 MDL NO B/D 25 4.3K SIH-24F HD-3 YBA-220 HB-3
SHP 10-2171 MDL NO B/D 25 4.3K SIH-24F HD-3 YBA-M224 HB-5
SHP 10-2171 MDL NO B/D 25 4.3K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-221D HB-4
SHP 10-2171 MDL NO B/D 25 4.3K SLK-24F HD-3 HSB-220 HB-56
SHP 10-2171 MDL NO B/D 25 4.3K SLK-24F HD-3 HSB-224 HB-53
SHP 10-2171 MDL NO B/D 25 4.3K SLK-24F HD-3 YBA-M220 HB-3
SHP 10-2171 MDL NO B/D 25 4.3K SLK-24F HD-3 YBA-M224 HB-5
SHP 10-2171 MDL NO B/D 25 4.3K SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-221D HB-4
SHP 10-2171 MDL NO B/D 25 4.3K SLK-24FH HD-3 HSB-220 HB-56
SHP 10-2171 MDL NO B/D 25 4.3K SLK-24FH HD-3 HSB-224 HB-53
SHP 10-2171 MDL NO B/D 25 4.3K SLK-24FH HD-3 YBA-M220 HB-3
SHP 10-2171 MDL NO B/D 25 4.3K SLK-24FH HD-3 YBA-M224 HB-5
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
Page 1 of 3
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
Page 2 of 3
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
Page 3 of 3
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
GRINNELL
2-Wire Compatibility Listings
PANEL MODEL ZONE MODEL ZONE LOOP MAX EOL DETECTOR MODEL DETECTOR BASE MODEL BASE ID
ID STYLE DET ID
C200 NA 24F B 30 7628 SIH-24F HD-3 HS-224D/HSB-224 HB-5
C200 NA 24F B 30 7628 SLK-24F,-FH HD3 HS-224D HB-5
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
UPDATED 9/11/03
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
ISI WIRELESS
2-Wire Compatibility Listings
PANEL MODEL ZONE MODEL ZONE LOOP MAX EOL DETECTOR MODEL DETECTOR BASE MODEL BASE ID
ID STYLE DET ID
FMS 1000 4ZID 4ZID D 66 N/A SIF-24F HD-2 HS-220 HB-3
FMS 1000 4ZID 4ZID D 66 N/A SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-220 HB-3
FMS 1000 4ZM 4ZMB B 66 4.7K OHM SIF-24F HD-2 HS-220 HB-3
FMS 1000 4ZM 4ZMA B 15 22K OHM SIF-24F HD-2 HS-220 HB-3
FMS 1000 4ZM 4ZMB B 66 4.7K OHM SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-220 HB-3
FMS 1000 4ZM 4ZMA B 15 22K OHM SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-220 HB-3
FMS 500 4ZID 4ZID D 66 N/A SIF-24F HD-2 HS-220 HB-3
FMS 500 4ZID 4ZID D 66 N/A SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-220 HB-3
FMS 500 4ZM 4ZMA B 15 22K OHM SIF-24F HD-2 HS-220 HB-3
FMS 500 4ZM 4ZMB B 66 4.7K OHM SIF-24F HD-2 HS-220 HB-3
FMS 500 4ZM 4ZMA B 15 22K OHM SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-220 HB-3
FMS 500 4ZM 4ZMB B 66 4.7K OHM SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-220 HB-3
FMS 500-96 4ZID 4ZID D 66 N/A SIF-24F HD-2 HS-220 HB-3
FMS 500-96 4ZID 4ZID D 66 N/A SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-220 HB-3
FMS 500-96 4ZM 4ZMA B 15 22K OHM SIF-24F HD-2 HS-220 HB-3
FMS 500-96 4ZM 4ZMB B 66 4.7K OHM SIF-24F HD-2 HS-220 HB-3
FMS 500-96 4ZM 4ZMA B 15 22K OHM SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-220 HB-3
FMS 500-96 4ZM 4ZMB B 66 4.7K OHM SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-220 HB-3
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
MIRCOM
2-Wire Compatibility Listings
PANEL MODEL ZONE MODEL ZONE LOOP MAX EOL DETECTOR MODEL DETECTOR BASE MODEL BASE ID
ID STYLE DET ID
FA-1000 N/A A B, D 30 3.9K OHM DEF-135, -190 N/A HSC-220L HB-64
FA-1000 N/A A B, D 30 3.9K OHM SLR-24H HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FA-1000 N/A A B, D 30 3.9K OHM SLR-24H HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
FA-101U N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM DCD-135 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FA-101U N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM DCD-135 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
FA-101U N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM DCD-190 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FA-101U N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM DCD-190 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
FA-101U N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FA-101U N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
FA-101U N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM SLR-24 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FA-101U N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM SLR-24 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
FA-101U, FA-1020U N/A A B, D 30 3.9K OHM DEF-135, -190 N/A HSC-220L HB-64
FA-101U, FA-1020U N/A A B, D 30 3.9K OHM SLR-24H HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FA-101U, FA-1020U N/A A B, D 30 3.9K OHM SLR-24H HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
FA-1025U N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM DCD-135 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FA-1025U N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM DCD-135 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
FA-1025U N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM DCD-190 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FA-1025U N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM DCD-190 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
FA-1025U N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM DFE-135, -190 N/A HSC-220L HB-64
FA-1025U N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FA-1025U N/A A B,D 30 3.9K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
FA-1025U N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM SLR-24 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FA-1025U N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM SLR-24 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
FA-1025U N/A A B,D 30 3.9K OHM SLR-24H HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FA-102U N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM SLR-24H HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
FA-102U N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM DCD-135 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FA-102U N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM DCD-135 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
FA-102U N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM DCD-190 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FA-102U N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM DCD-190 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
FA-102U N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FA-102U N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
FA-102U N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM SLR-24 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FA-102U N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM SLR-24 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
FA-104/8U N/A A B, D 30 3.9K OHM DEF-135, -190 N/A HSC-220L HB-64
FA-104/8U N/A A B, D 30 3.9K OHM SLR-24H HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FA-104/8U N/A A B, D 30 3.9K OHM SLR-24H HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
FA-104/8U, 8UX N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM SLR-24H HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FA-104/8U, 8UX N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM SLR-24H HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
FA-104/8U, 8UX N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM DCD-135 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FA-104/8U, 8UX N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM DCD-135 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
FA-104/8U, 8UX N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM DCD-190 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FA-104/8U, 8UX N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM DCD-190 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
FA-104/8U, 8UX N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FA-104/8U, 8UX N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
FA-104/8U, 8UX N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM SLR-24 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FA-104/8U, 8UX N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM SLR-24 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
FA-104/BUX N/A A B, D 30 3.9K OHM DEF-135, -190 N/A HSC-220L HB-64
FA-104/BUX N/A A B, D 30 3.9K OHM SLR-24H HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FA-104/BUX N/A A B, D 30 3.9K OHM SLR-24H HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
FA-200 N/A A B, D 30 3.9K OHM DEF-135, -190 N/A HSC-220L HB-64
FA-200 N/A A B, D 30 3.9K OHM SLR-24H HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FA-200 N/A A B, D 30 3.9K OHM SLR-24H HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
FA-200 N/A A B, D 30 3.9K OHM SLR-835B-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
FA-200, FA-1000 N/A A B, D 30 3.9K OHM DCD-135 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FA-200, FA-1000 N/A A B, D 30 3.9K OHM DCD-135 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
FA-200, FA-1000 N/A A B, D 30 3.9K OHM DCD-190 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FA-200, FA-1000 N/A A B, D 30 3.9K OHM DCD-190 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
FA-200, FA-1000 N/A A B, D 30 3.9K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FA-200, FA-1000 N/A A B, D 30 3.9K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
FA-200, FA-1000 N/A A B, D 30 3.9K OHM SLR-24 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FA-200, FA-1000 N/A A B, D 30 3.9K OHM SLR-24 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
FA-1000 N/A A B, D 30 3.9K OHM SLR-835B-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
SERIES 100 N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM DCD-135 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
SERIES 100 N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM DCD-135 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
SERIES 100 N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM DCD-190 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
SERIES 100 N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM DCD-190 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
SERIES 100 N/A A B, D 30 3.9K OHM DEF-135, -190 N/A HSC-220L HB-64
SERIES 100 N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
SERIES 100 N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
SERIES 100 N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM SLR-24 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
SERIES 100 N/A A B 30 3.9K OHM SLR-24 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
SERIES 100 N/A A B, D 30 3.9K OHM SLR-24H HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
SERIES 100 N/A A B, D 30 3.9K OHM SLR-24H HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
MODULAR PROT.
2-Wire Compatibility Listings
PANEL MODEL ZONE MODEL ZONE LOOP MAX EOL DETECTOR MODEL DETECTOR BASE MODEL BASE ID
ID STYLE DET ID
RP-1002M N/A A B, D 30 4.7K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-2-RB HB-10
RP-1002M N/A A B, D 30 4.7K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
RP-1002M N/A A B, D 30 4.7K SIH-24F HD-3 HSB-220 HB-56
RP-1002M N/A A B, D 30 4.7K SIH-24F HD-3 HSB-224 HB-53
RP-1002M N/A A B, D 30 4.7K SIH-24F HD-3 YBA-M22 HB-3
RP-1002M N/A A B, D 30 4.7K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-2-RB HB-10
RP-1002M N/A A B, D 30 4.7K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
RP-1002M N/A A B, D 30 4.7K SLK-24F HD-3 HSB-220 HB-56
RP-1002M N/A A B, D 30 4.7K SLK-24F HD-3 HSB-224 HB-53
RP-1002M N/A A B, D 30 4.7K SLK-24F HD-3 YBA-M22 HB-3
RP-1002M N/A A B, D 30 4.7K SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-2-RB HB-10
RP-1002M N/A A B, D 30 4.7K SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
RP-1002M N/A A B, D 30 4.7K SLK-24FH HD-3 HSB-220 HB-56
RP-1002M N/A A B, D 30 4.7K SLK-24FH HD-3 HSB-224 HB-53
RP-1002M A B, D 30 SLK-24FH HD-3 YBA-M22 HB-3
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
NAPCO
2-Wire Compatibility Listings
PANEL MODEL ZONE MODEL ZONE LOOP MAX EOL DETECTOR MODEL DETECTOR BASE MODEL BASE ID
ID STYLE DET ID
GEM-3200,-P9600 NA GEM-PS B 10 2.2K OHM SLR-835BH-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
GEM-P1632 NA MDL NO B 10 2.2K SLR-835B-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
GEM-P1632 NA NA B,D 10 2.2K OHM SLR-835BH-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
GEM-P3200 NA GEM-PF B 10 2.2K SLR-835B-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
GEM-P800 NA XP-S B 10 2.2K SLR-835B-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
GEM-P800,-P800E NA XP-S B 10 2.2K OHM SLR-835BH-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
GEM-P800E,P801 NA XP-S B 10 3.9K OHM SLR-835B-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
GEM-P801 NA XP-S B 10 2.2K OHM SLR-835BH-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
GEM-P816, V2,V3 GEM-P816 MDL NO B 10 2.2K OHM SLR-835BH-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
GEM-P816, V2,V3 NA XP-S B 10 2.2K OHM SLR-835B-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
GEM-P9600 NA GEM-PS B 10 2.2K SLR-835B-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
MA3000,SS5500 NA MDL NO B 10 2.2K SLR-835B-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
MA3000/SS5500 NA MDL NO B 10 2.2K OHM SLR-835BH-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
SS-P3200 NA GEM-PS B 10 2.2K OHM SLR-835BH-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
SS-P3200,-P9600 NA GEM-PS B 10 2.2K SLR-835B-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
SS-P9600 NA GEM-PS B 10 2.2K OHM SLR-835BH-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
XP-400, XP-600 NA XP-S B 10 2.2K SLR-835B-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
XP400, XP600 NA XP-S B 10 2.2K OHM SLR-835BH-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
NOTIFIER
2-Wire Compatibility Listings
PANEL MODEL ZONE MODEL ZONE LOOP MAX EOL DETECTOR MODEL DETECTOR BASE MODEL BASE ID
ID STYLE DET ID
AFM-200 MMX-2, M3-TW A BD 1 3.9K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-2-RB HB-10
AFM-200 MMX-2, M3-TW A BD 25 3.9K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
AFM-200 MMX-2, M3-TW A BD 25 3.9K SIH-24F HD-3 YBA-M22 HB-3
AFM-200 MMX-2, M3-TW A BD 1 3.9K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-2-RB HB-10
AFM-200 MMX-2, M3-TW A BD 25 3.9K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
AFM-200 MMX-2, M3-TW A BD 1 3.9K SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-2-RB HB-10
AFM-200 MMX-2, M3-TW A BD 25 3.9K SLK-24FH HD-3 YBA-M22 HB-3
AFP-1010 MMX-2, M3-TW A BD 1 3.9K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-2-RB HB-10
AFP-1010 MMX-2, M3-TW A BD 1 3.9K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-2-RB HB-10
AFP-1010 MMX-2, M3-TW A BD 25 3.9K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
AFP-1010 MMX-2, M3-TW A BD 25 3.9K SIH-24F HD-3 YBA-M22 HB-3
AFP-1010 MMX-2, M3-TW A BD 1 3.9K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-2-RB HB-10
AFP-1010 MMX-2, M3-TW A BD 25 3.9K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
AFP-1010 MMX-2, M3-TW A BD 1 3.9K SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-2-RB HB-10
AFP-1010 MMX-2, M3-TW A BD 25 3.9K SLK-24FH HD-3 YBA-M22 HB-3
AFP-200 MMX-2, M3-TW A BD 1 3.9K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-2-RB HB-10
AFP-200 MMX-2, M3-TW A BD 25 3.9K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
AFP-200 MMX-2, M3-TW A BD 25 3.9K SIH-24F HD-3 YBA-M22 HB-3
AFP-200 MMX-2, M3-TW A BD 1 3.9K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-2-RB HB-10
AFP-200 MMX-2, M3-TW A BD 25 3.9K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
AFP-200 MMX-2, M3-TW A BD 1 3.9K SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-2-RB HB-10
AFP-200 MMX-2, M3-TW A BD 25 3.9K SLK-24FH HD-3 YBA-M22 HB-3
AM 2020 MMX-2, M3-TW A BD 1 3.9K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-2-RB HB-10
AM 2020 MMX-2, M3-TW A BD 25 3.9K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
AM 2020 MMX-2, M3-TW A BD 25 3.9K SIH-24F HD-3 YBA-M22 HB-3
AM 2020 MMX-2, M3-TW A BD 1 3.9K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-2-RB HB-10
AM 2020 MMX-2, M3-TW A BD 25 3.9K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
AM 2020 MMX-2, M3-TW A BD 1 3.9K SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-2-RB HB-10
AM 2020 MMX-2, M3-TW A BD 25 3.9K SLK-24FH HD-3 YBA-M22 HB-3
MMX-2 MMX-2 A BD 25 3.9K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-220 HB-56
MMX-2 MMX-2 A BD 25 3.9K SLK-24F/FH HD-3 HS-220 HB-56
RP-1001 N/A A BD 30 4.7K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-220 HB-56
RP-1001 N/A A BD 30 4.7K SIH-24F HD-3 HSB-224 HB-53
RP-1001 N/A A BD 30 4.7K SLK-24F/FH HD-3 HS-220 HB-56
RP-1001 N/A A BD 30 4.7K SLK-24F/FH HD-3 HS-220 HB-56
RP-1001 N/A A BD 30 4.7K SLK-24F/FH HD-3 HSB-224 HB-53
RP-1002 N/A A BD 30 4.7K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-220 HB-56
RP-1002 N/A A BD 30 4.7K SIH-24F HD-3 HSB-224 HB-53
RP-1002 N/A A BD 30 4.7K SLK-24F/FH HD-3 HS-220 HB-56
RP-1002 N/A A B, D 30 4.7K SLK-24F/FH HD-3 HSB-224 HB-53
S 5000 IZ-4,IZM-8 A B, D 15 4.7K OHM DFE-135,-190 N/A HSC-220L HB-64
S 5000 IZ-4,IZM-8 A B, D 15 4.7K OHM SLR-24H HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
S 5000 IZ-4,IZM-8 A B, D 15 4.7K OHM SLR-24H HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
S 5000 IZ-4,IZM-8 A B, D 20 4.7K OHM SLR-835B-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
S 5000 IZM-8 A B, D 10 4.7K OHM DCD-135,-190 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
S 5000 IZM-8 A B, D 10 4.7K OHM DCD-135,-190 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
S 5000 IZM-8 A B, D 10 4.7K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
S 5000 IZM-8 A B, D 10 4.7K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
S 5000 IZM-8 A B, D 10 4.7K OHM SLR-24 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
S 5000 IZM-8 A B, D 10 4.7K OHM SLR-24 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
S 5000 IZM-8, IZE-A A B 30 4.7K OHM SIF-24F HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
S 5000 IZM-8, IZE-A A D 30 N/A SIF-24F HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
S 5000 IZM-8, IZE-A A D 30 N/A SIF-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
S 5000 IZM-8, IZE-A A B 30 4.7K OHM SIF-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
S 5000 IZM-8, IZE-A A D 30 N/A SIF-24F HD-3 YBA-M22 HB-3
S 5000 IZM-8, IZE-A A B 30 4.7K OHM SIF-24F HD-3 YBA-M22 HB-3
S 5000 IZM-8, IZE-A A B 30 4.7K OHM SIF-24F HD-3 YBA-M220 HB-3
S 5000 IZM-8, IZE-A A D 30 N/A SIF-24F HD-3 YBA-M220 HB-3
S 5000 IZM-8, IZE-A A B 30 4.7K OHM SIH-24F HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
S 5000 IZM-8, IZE-A A D 30 N/A SIH-24F HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
S 5000 IZM-8, IZE-A A B 30 4.7K OHM SIH-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
S 5000 IZM-8, IZE-A A D 30 N/A SIH-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
S 5000 IZM-8, IZE-A A B 30 4.7K OHM SIH-24F HD-3 YBA-M22 HB-3
S 5000 IZM-8, IZE-A A D 30 N/A SIH-24F HD-3 YBA-M22 HB-3
S 5000 IZM-8, IZE-A A D 30 N/A SIH-24F HD-3 YBA-M220 HB-3
S 5000 IZM-8, IZE-A A B 30 4.7K OHM SIH-24F HD-3 YBA-M220 HB-3
S 5000 IZM-8, IZE-A A B 30 4.7K OHM SLK-24F HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
S 5000 IZM-8, IZE-A A D 30 N/A SLK-24F HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
Page 1 of 3
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
Page 2 of 3
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
Page 3 of 3
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
PARADOX SECURITY SYSTEMS
POTTER ELECTRIC
2-Wire Compatibility Listings
PANEL MODEL ZONE MODEL ZONE LOOP MAX EOL DETECTOR MODEL DETECTOR BASE MODEL BASE ID
ID STYLE DET ID
PFC-100 NRC N/A A B, D 25 5.1K SLK-24FH HD3 HS-221D HB4
PFC 100 RC N/A A B, D 1 5.1K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-221D HB-2
PFC 100 RC N/A A B, D 1 5.1K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-221D HB-4
PFC 100 RC N/A A B, D 25 5.1K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-21D HB-2
PFC 100 RC N/A A B, D 25 5.1K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-221 RB HB-13
PFC 100 RC N/A A B, D 25 5.1K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-221D HB-4
PFC 100 RC N/A A B, D 25 5.1K SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-21D HB-2
PFC 100 RC N/A A B, D 25 5.1K SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-221 RB HB-13
PFC-100 RC N/A A B, D 25 5.1K SIH-24F HD-3 HSB-221 HB-54
PFC-100 RC N/A A B, D 25 5.1K SIH-24F HD-3 HSB-221N HB-54
PFC-100 RC N/A A B, D 25 5.1K SIH-24F HD-3 HSB-221R HB-71
PFC-100 RC N/A A B, D 25 5.1K SLK-24F HD-3 HSB-221 HB-54
PFC-100 RC N/A A B, D 25 5.1K SLK-24F HD-3 HSB-221N HB-54
PFC-100 RC N/A A B, D 25 5.1K SLK-24F HD-3 HSB-221R HB-71
PFC-100 RC N/A A B, D 25 5.1K SLK-24FH HD-3 HSB-221 HB-54
PFC-100 RC N/A A B, D 25 5.1K SLK-24FH HD-3 HSB-221N HB-54
PFC-100 RC N/A A B, D 25 5.1K SLK-24FH HD-3 HSC-221R HB-71
PFC-2000 RC N/A A B, D 25 5.1K SIH-24F HD-3 HSB-221 HB-54
PFC-2000 RC N/A A B, D 25 5.1K SIH-24F HD-3 HSB-221N HB-54
PFC-2000 RC N/A A B, D 25 5.1K SIH-24F HD-3 HSC-221R HB-71
PFC-2000 RC N/A A B, D 25 5.1K SLK-24F HD-3 HSB-221 HB-54
PFC-2000 RC N/A A B, D 25 5.1K SLK-24F HD-3 HSB-221N HB-54
PFC-2000 RC N/A A B, D 25 5.1K SLK-24F HD-3 HSC-221R HB-71
PFC-2000 RC N/A A B, D 25 5.1K SLK-24FH HD-3 HSB-221 HB-54
PFC-2000 RC N/A A B, D 25 5.1K SLK-24FH HD-3 HSB-221N HB-54
PFC-2000 RC N/A A B, D 25 5.1K SLK-24FH HD-3 HSC-221R HB-71
PFC-4410 N/A A B, D 25 5.1K SIH-24F HD-3 HSB-221 HB-54
PFC-4410 N/A A B, D 25 5.1K SIH-24F HD-3 HSB-221N HB-54
PFC-4410 N/A A B, D 25 5.1K SLK-24F HD-3 HSB-221 HB-54
PFC-4410 N/A A B, D 25 5.1K SLK-24F HD-3 HSB-221N HB-54
PFC-4410 N/A A B, D 25 5.1K SLK-24FH HD-3 HSB-221 HB-54
PFC-4410 N/A A B, D 25 5.1K SLK-24FH HD-3 HSB-221N HB-54
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
PROTECTOWIRE
2-Wire Compatibility Listings
PANEL MODEL ZONE MODEL ZONE LOOP MAX EOL DETECTOR MODEL DETECTOR BASE MODEL BASE ID
ID STYLE DET ID
ACR-1600 SERIES ZM-2200 MDL NO AD 20 ELR-1A SIF-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
ACR-1600 SERIES ZM-2200 MDL NO AD 20 ELR-1A SIF-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
ACR-1600 SERIES ZM-2200 MDL NO AD 20 ELR-1A SLK-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
ACR-1600 SERIES ZM-2200 MDL NO AD 20 ELR-1A SLK-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
ACR-1600 SERIES ZM-2200 MDL NO AD 20 ELR-1A SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
ACR-1600 SERIES ZM-2200 MDL NO AD 20 ELR-1A SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
FS2000 ZC-91, ZC-91M MDL NO B, D 30 4.7K OHM DCD-135 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FS2000 ZC-91, ZC-91M MDL NO B, D 30 4.7K OHM DCD-135 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
FS2000 ZC-91, ZC-91M MDL NO B, D 30 4.7K OHM DCD-190 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FS2000 ZC-91, ZC-91M MDL NO B, D 30 4.7K OHM DCD-190 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
FS2000 ZC-91, ZC-91M MDL NO B, D 30 4.7K OHM DFE-135,-190 N/A HSC-220L HB-64
FS2000 ZC-91, ZC-91M MDL NO B, D 30 4.7K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FS2000 ZC-91, ZC-91M MDL NO B, D 30 4.7K OHM SIJ-24 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
FS2000 ZC-91, ZC-91M MDL NO B, D 30 4.7K OHM SLR-24 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FS2000 ZC-91, ZC-91M MDL NO B, D 30 4.7K OHM SLR-24 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
FS2000 ZC-91, ZC-91M MDL NO B, D 30 4.7K OHM SLR-24H HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FS2000 ZC-91, ZC-91M MDL NO B, D 30 4.7K SLR-24H HD-3 NS4-220 HB-3
FS2000 ZC-91, ZC-91M MDL NO B, D 30 4.7K OHM SLR-24H HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
FS2000 ZC-91, ZC-91M MDL NO B, D 30 4.7K OHM SLR-835B-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
FS2000 SERIES ZC-91 ZC-91 BD 30 4.7K OHM SIH-24F HD-S HS-220D HB-3
FS2000 SERIES ZC-91 ZC-91 BD 30 4.7K OHM SIH-24F HD-S HS-220D HB-3
FS2000 SERIES ZC-91 ZC-91 BD 30 4.7K OHM SLK-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
FS2000 SERIES ZC-91M ZC-91 BD 30 4.7K OHM SLK-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
RADIONICS
2-Wire Compatibility Listings
PANEL MODEL ZONE MODEL ZONE LOOP MAX EOL DETECTOR MODEL DETECTOR BASE MODEL BASE ID
ID STYLE DET ID
D2012,D2112 2 WIRE POINT1 A 40 1.8K OHM SLR-835B-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
D2212 ZONE 1 221201 A 15 2K D262 HD-4 D261A HB-80
D2212, D2412 2 WIRE POINT1 A 40 1.8K OHM SLR-835B-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
D2212B 1 B A 15 15- D262 HD-4 D261A HB-80
D2212B ZONE 1 221201 A 15 2K D262 HD-4 D261A HB-80
D2212BE 1 B A 15 15- D262 HD-4 D261A HB-80
D2412UE 1 B A 15 15- D262 HD-4 D261A HB-80
D2812 1 B A 15 15 D262 HD-4 D261A HB-80
D2812,D2812U 2 WIRE POINT1 A 40 1.8K OHM SLR-835B-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
D4112 N/A B A 20 1.8K OHM SLK-12 HD-4 HSB-12-1 HB-80
D4112 N/A B A 20 1.8K OHM SLK-12 HD-4 HSB-12-1N HB-80
D4112 N/A 1 A 20 D104F SLK-12 HD-4 YBC-RL/12 HB-40
D6112 N/A B A 20 1.8K OHM SLK-12 HD-4 HSB-12-1 HB-80
D6112 N/A B A 20 1.8K OHM SLK-12 HD-4 HSB-12-1N HB-80
D6112 N/A 2 A 20 D104F SLK-12 HD-4 YBC-RL/12 HB-40
D7112 D125B A A 20 1.8K OHM SLK-12 HD-4 HSB-12-1 HB-80
D7112 D125B A A 20 1.8K OHM SLK-12 HD-4 HSB-12-1N HB-80
D7212 D125B A A 20 1.8K OHM SLK-12 HD-4 HSB-12-1 HB-80
D7212 D125B A A 20 1.8K OHM SLK-12 HD-4 HSB-12-1N HB-80
D7212 OWB/125B 24VDC MDL NO A 80 1.8K SIH-24F HD-3 HS224D HB-5
D7212 OWB/D125B 24VDC MDL NO A 80 1.8K SIH-24F HD-3 HS224D HB-5
D7212 OWB/D125B 24VDC MDL NO A 80 1.8K SLK-24F HD-3 HS224D HB-5
D7212,D7412 D125B D125B A 40 1.8K OHM DFE-135,-190 N/A HSC-220L HB-64
D7212,D7412 D125B D125B A 40 1.8K OHM SLR-24H HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
D7212,D7412 D125B D125B A 40 1.8K OHM SLR-24H HD-3 NS4-100, NS6-100 HB-55
D7212,D7412 D125B D125B A 40 1.8K OHM SLR-24H HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
D7212,D7412 D125B D125B A 40 1.8K OHM SLR-24H HD-3 NS4-224, NS6-224 HB-5
D7212,D7412 D125B D125B A 40 1.8K OHM SLR-835B-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
D7212,D7412 ZONE 1 D125B A 40 1.8K OHM DCD-135,DCD-190 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
D7212,D7412 ZONE 1 D125B A 40 1.8K OHM DCD-135,DCD-190 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
D7212,D7412 ZONE 1 D125B A 40 1.8K OHM SIJ-24,SLR-24 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
D7212,D7412 ZONE 1 D125B A 40 1.8K OHM SIJ-24,SLR-24 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
D7412 ONBOARD W/125B MDL NO A 80 1.8K SIH-24F HD-3 HS224D HB-5
D7412 ONBOARD W/D125B MDL NO A 80 1.8K SIH-24F HD-3 HS224D HB-5
D7412 ONBOARD W/D125B MDL NO A 15 1.8K SLK-12 HD-4 YBC-AL/12 HB-40
D7412 ONBOARD W/D125B MDL NO A 80 1.8K SLK-24F HD-3 HS224D HB-5
D8112 D8112 W/D125B MDL NO A 20 1.8K OHM SLK-12 HD-4 HSB-12-1 HB-80
D8112 D8112 W/D125B MDL NO A 20 1.8K OHM SLK-12 HD-4 HSB-12-1N HB-80
D8112 N/A 2 TO 8 A 20 D108 SLK-12 HD-4 YBC-RL/12 HB-40
D8112,D9112 ZONE NO D125B A 40 1.8K OHM SLR-835B--2 HD-6 N/A N/A
D9112 D125B A A 20 1.8K OHM SLK-12 HD-4 HSB-12-1 HB-80
D9112 D125B A A 20 1.8K OHM SLK-12 HD-4 HSB-12-1N HB-80
D9112,D9412 ZONE 1 D125B A 40 1.8K OHM DCD-135,DCD-190 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
D9112,D9412 ZONE 1 D125B A 40 1.8K OHM DCD-135,DCD-190 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
D9112,D9412 ZONE 1 D125B A 40 1.8K OHM SIJ-24,SLR-24 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
D9112,D9412 ZONE 1 D125B A 40 1.8K OHM SIJ-24,SLR-24 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
D9112B,D9124 D125B D125B A 40 1.8K OHM DFE-135,-190 N/A HSC-220L HB-64
D9112B,D9124 D125B D125B A 40 1.8K OHM SLR-24H HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
D9112B,D9124 D125B D125B A 40 1.8K OHM SLR-24H HD-3 NS4-100, NS6-100 HB-55
D9112B,D9124 D125B D125B A 40 1.8K OHM SLR-24H HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
D9112B,D9124 D125B D125B A 40 1.8K OHM SLR-24H HD-3 NS4-224, NS6-224 HB-5
D9112B,D9124 D125B D125B A 40 1.8K OHM SLR-835B--2 HD-6 N/A N/A
D9412 D125B D125B A 40 1.8K OHM DFE-135,-190 N/A HSC-220L HB-64
D9412 D125B D125B A 40 1.8K OHM SLR-24H HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
D9412 D125B D125B A 40 1.8K OHM SLR-24H HD-3 NS4-100, NS6-100 HB-55
D9412 D125B D125B A 40 1.8K OHM SLR-24H HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
D9412 D125B D125B A 40 1.8K OHM SLR-24H HD-3 NS4-224, NS6-224 HB-5
D9412 D125B D125B A 40 1.8K OHM SLR-835B--2 HD-6 N/A N/A
D9412 ONBOARD W/D125B MDL NO A 80 1.8K SIH-24F HD-3 HS224D HB-5
D9412 ONBOARD W/D125B MDL NO A 15 1.8K SLK-12 HD-4 YBC-AL/12 HB-40
D9412 ONBOARD W/D125B MDL NO A 80 1.8K SLK-24F HD-3 HS224D HB-5
D9412 ONBOARD W/D125B MDL NO A 80 1.8K SLK-24F HD-3 HS224D HB-5
1 of 1
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
RAULAND-BORG
2-Wire Compatibility Listings
PANEL MODEL ZONE MODEL ZONE LOOP MAX EOL DETECTOR MODEL DETECTOR BASE MODEL BASE ID
ID STYLE DET ID
FA3002 FA3002 LP01 A 50 3.3K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
FA3002 FA3002 LP02 A 50 3.3K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
FA3002 FA3002 LP01 A 50 3.3K SIH-24F HD-3 HSB-220 HB-56
FA3002 FA3002 LP02 A 50 3.3K SIH-24F HD-3 HSB-220 HB-56
FA3002 FA3002 LP01 A 50 3.3K SIH-24F HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FA3002 FA3002 LP02 A 50 3.3K SIH-24F HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FA3002 FA3002 LP01 A 50 3.3K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
FA3002 FA3002 LP02 A 50 3.3K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
FA3002 FA3002 LP02 A 50 3.3K SLK-24F HD-3 HSB-220 HB-56
FA3002 FA3002 LP01 A 50 3.3K SLK-24F HD-3 HSB-220 HB-56
FA3002 FA3002 LP02 A 50 3.3K SLK-24F HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FA3002 FA3002 LP01 A 50 3.3K SLK-24F HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FA3002 FA3002 LP01 A 50 3.3K SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
FA3002 FA3002 LP02 A 50 3.3K SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
FA3002 FA3002 LP02 A 50 3.3K SLK-24FH HD-3 HSB-220 HB-56
FA3002 FA3002 LP01 A 50 3.3K SLK-24FH HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FA3002 FA3002 LP02 A 50 3.3K SLK-24FH HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
FA3002 FA3120,FA3125 CZ02 A 1 30K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
FA3002 FA3120,FA3125 CZ01 A 1 20K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
FA3002 FA3120,FA3125 CZ02 A 1 30K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
FA3002 FA3120,FA3125 CZ01 A 1 20K SIH-24F HD-3 HSB-220 HB-56
FA3002 FA3120,FA3125 CZ01 A 1 20K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
FA3002 FA3120,FA3125 CZ01 A 1 20K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
FA3002 FA3120,FA3125 CZ01 A 1 20K SLK-24F HD-3 HSB-220 HB-56
FA3002 FA3120,FA3125 CZ02 A 3 30K SLK-24F HD-3 HSB-220 HB-56
FA3002 FA3120,FA3125 CZ01 A 1 20K SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
FA3002 FA3120,FA3125 CZ02 A 1 30K SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
FA3002 FA3120,FA3125 CZ02 A 3 30K SLK-24FH HD-3 HSB-220 HB-56
FA3002 FA3120,FA3125 CZ01 A 1 20K SLK-24FH HD-3 HSB-220 HB-56
FA3002 FA3120,FA3125 CZ02 A 3 30K SIH-24F HD-3 HSB-220 HB-56
FA3002 FA3120,FAP3125 CZ02 A 1 30K SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
FA3002 FA3130,FAP3135 CZ02 A 1 30K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
FA3002 FA3130,FAP3135 CZ01 A 1 20K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
FA3002 FA3130,FAP3135 CZ02 A 3 30K SIH-24F HD-3 HSB-220 HB-56
FA3002 FA3130,FAP3135 CZ01 A 1 20K SIH-24F HD-3 HSB-220 HB-56
FA3002 FA3130,FAP3135 CZ02 A 1 30K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
FA3002 FA3130,FAP3135 CZ01 A 1 20K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
FA3002 FA3130,FAP3135 CZ01 A 1 20K SLK-24F HD-3 HSB-220 HB-56
FA3002 FA3130,FAP3135 CZ02 A 3 30K SLK-24F HD-3 HSB-220 HB-56
FA3002 FA3130,FAP3135 CZ02 A 1 30K SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
FA3002 FA3130,FAP3135 CZ02 A 3 30K SLK-24FH HD-3 HSB-220 HB-56
FA3002 FA3130,FAP3135 CZ01 A 1 20K SLK-24FH HD-3 HSB-220 HB-56
FIRE PLEX FA3001 LPO1 2 A 50 1344 SIH-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
FIRE PLEX FA3001 LPO1 2 A 50 1344 SLK-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
FIRE PLEX FA3130,FAP3135 CZ01 A 1 1346 SLK-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
FIRE PLEX FA3130,FAP3135 CZ01 A 1 1346 SIH-24F HD-3 HS-220D HB-3
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
SECURTON
2-Wire Compatibility Listings
PANEL MODEL ZONE MODEL ZONE LOOP MAX EOL DETECTOR MODEL DETECTOR BASE MODEL BASE ID
ID STYLE DET ID
MR-2600 MR-2600 MDL NO B 29 MRD-2904 SIH-24F HD-2 HS-221D HB-4
MR-2600 MR-2600 MDL NO B 29 MRD-2904 SIH-24F HD-2 YBA-M221 HB-4
MR-2600 MR-2600 MDL NO B 25 MRD-2904 SIH-24F HD-3 HS-221D HB-4
MR-2600 MR-2600 MDL NO B 25 MRD-2904 SIH-24F HD-3 YBA-M221 HB-4
MR-2600 MR-2600 MDL NO B 22 MRD-2904 SLK-24F HD-3 HS-221D HB-4
MR-2600 MR-2600 MDL NO B 22 MRD-2904 SLK-24F HD-3 YBA-M221 HB-4
MR-2600 MR-2600 MDL NO B 22 MRD-2904 SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-221D HB-4
MR-2600 MR-2600 MDL NO B 22 MRD-2904 SLK-24FH HD-3 YBA-M221 HB-4
MR-2900 MR-2928 A B, C 34 MRD-2904 SIH-24F HD-2 HS-221D HB-4
MR-2900 MR-2928 A B, C 34 MRD-2904 SIH-24F HD-2 YBA-M221 HB-4
MR-2900 MR-2928 A B, C 26 MRD-2904 SIH-24F HD-3 HS-221D HB-4
MR-2900 MR-2928 A B, C 26 MRD-2904 SIH-24F HD-3 YBA-M221 HB-4
MR-2900 MR-2928 A B, C 24 MRD-2904 SLK-24F HD-3 HS-221D HB-4
MR-2900 MR-2928 A B, C 24 MRD-2904 SLK-24F HD-3 HS-221D HB-4
MR-2900 MR-2928 A B, C 24 MRD-2904 SLK-24F HD-3 YBA-M221 HB-4
MR-2900 MR-2928 A B, C 24 MRD-2904 SLK-24FH HD-3 YBA-M221 HB-4
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
SILENT KNIGHT
2-Wire Compatibility Listings
PANEL MODEL ZONE MODEL ZONE LOOP MAX EOL DETECTOR MODEL DETECTOR BASE MODEL BASE ID
ID STYLE DET ID
5204 N/A 24C B 30 7628 DFE-135,-190 N/A HSC-220L HB-64
5204 N/A 24C B 30 7628 SLR-24H HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
5204 N/A 24C B 30 7628 SLR-24H HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
5204 12 VOLT N/A N/A A 20 7628 SLK-24F HD-3 HS-224D HB-5
5204 12 VOLT N/A N/A A 20 7628 SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-224D HB-5
5207 5210 24A B 30 7628 DCD-135 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
5207 5210 24A B 30 7628 DCD-135 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
5207 5210 24A B 30 7628 DCD-190 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
5207 5210 24A B 30 7628 DCD-190 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
5207 5210 24A B 30 7628 DFE-135,-190 N/A HSC-220L HB-64
5207 5210 24A B 30 7628 SIJ-24 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
5207 5210 24A B 30 7628 SIJ-24 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
5207 5210 24A B 30 7628 SLR-24 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
5207 5210 24A B 30 7628 SLR-24 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
5207 5210 24A B 30 7628 SLR-24H HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
5207 5210 24A B 30 7628 SLR-24H HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
5207 5210 24A B 30 7628 SLR-835 HD-3 NS4-100, NS6-100 HB-55
5207 5210 24A B 30 7628 SLR-835 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
5207 5210 24A B 30 7628 SLR-835B-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
5207 5210 24A B 10 7628 SIH-24F HD-3 HS-224D/HSB-224 HB-5
5207 5210 24A B 10 7628 SLK-24F HD-3 HS-224D/HSB-224 HB-5
5207 N/A 24D B 30 7628 DCD-135 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
5207 N/A 24D B 30 7628 DCD-135 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
5207 N/A 24D B 30 7628 DCD-190 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
5207 N/A 24D B 30 7628 DCD-190 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
5207 N/A 24D B 30 7628 DFE-135,-190 N/A HSC-220L HB-64
5207 N/A 24D B 30 7628 SIJ-24 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
5207 N/A 24D B 30 7628 SIJ-24 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
5207 N/A 24B A 40 7628 4.7 SLK-24F HD-3 HS-224D HB-5
5207 N/A 24A B 20 7628 SLK-24F HD-3 HS-224D HB-5
5207 N/A 24B A 40 7628 4.7 SLK-24FH HD-5 HS-224C HB-5
5207 N/A 24B A 40 7628 4.7 SLK-24FH HD-5 HS-224C HB-5
5207 N/A 24A B 20 7628 SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-224D HB-5
5207 N/A 24D B 30 7628 SLR-24 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
5207 N/A 24D B 30 7628 SLR-24 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
5207 N/A 24D B 30 7628 SLR-24H HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
5207 N/A 24D B 30 7628 SLR-24H HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
5207 N/A 24D B 25 7628 SIH-24F HD-3 HS-224D/HSB-224 HB-5
5207 N/A 24D B 25 7628 SLK-24F HD-3 HS-224D/HSB-224 HB-5
5820, 5828XL N/A 24H B, D 12 7628 DCD-135,-190 HD-3 HSC-220L HB-64
5820, 5828XL N/A 24H B, D 12 7628 DCD-135,-190 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
5820, 5828XL N/A 24H B, D 12 7628 DCD-135,-190 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
5820, 5828XL N/A 24H B, D 12 7628 DFE-135,-190 N/A HSC-220L HB-64
5820, 5828XL N/A 24H B, D 12 7628 SIJ-24 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
5820, 5828XL N/A 24H B, D 12 7628 SIJ-24 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
5820, 5828XL N/A 24H B, D 12 7628 SLR-24H, -24V HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
5820, 5828XL N/A 24H B, D 12 7628 SLR-24H, -24V HD-3 NS4-100, NS6-100 HB-55
5820, 5828XL N/A 24H B, D 12 7628 SLR-24H, -24V HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
5820, 5828XL N/A 24H B, D 12 7628 SLR-835 HD-3 NS4-100, NS6-100 HB-55
5820, 5828XL N/A 24H B, D 12 7628 SLR-835 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
5820, 5828XL N/A 24H B, D 12 7628 SLR-835B-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
7181 N/A B B 30 7628 DCD-135 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
7181 N/A B B 30 7628 DCD-135 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
7181 N/A B B 30 7628 DCD-190 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
7181 N/A B B 30 7628 DCD-190 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
7181 N/A B B 30 7628 DFE-135,-190 N/A HSC-220L HB-64
7181 N/A B B 30 7628 SIJ-24 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
7181 N/A B B 30 7628 SIJ-24 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
7181 N/A B B 18 7628 SLK-12 HD-4 HSB-12-1 HB-80
7181 N/A B B 18 7628 SLK-12 HD-4 HSB-12-1 HB-80
7181 N/A B B 18 7628 SLK-12 HD-4 HSB-12-1N HB-80
7181 N/A B B 18 7628 SLK-12 HD-4 HSB-12-1N HB-80
7181 N/A B B 30 7628 SLR-24 HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
7181 N/A B B 30 7628 SLR-24 HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
7181 N/A B B 30 7628 SLR-24H HD-3 HSC-220R HB-72
7181 N/A B B 30 7628 SLR-24H HD-3 NS4-220, NS6-220 HB-3
7181 N/A 24B B, D 20 7628 SLR-835B-2 HD-6 N/A N/A
SD500-SDM NA 241 B/D 25 7628 SIH-24F HD-3 YBA-M224 HB-5
Page 1 of 3
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
Page 2 of 3
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
UPDATED 9/11/03
Page 3 of 3
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
SIMPLEX
2-Wire Compatibility Listings
PANEL MODEL ZONE MODEL ZONE LOOP MAX EOL DETECTOR MODEL DETECTOR BASE MODEL BASE ID
ID STYLE DET ID
SERIES 4010 4090-9101&-9106 MDL NO B, D 20 3.3K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-221 HB-4
SERIES 4010 4090-9101&-9106 MDL NO B, D 20 3.3K SIH-24F HD-3 HSB-221S HB-54
SERIES 4010 4090-9101&-9106 MDL NO B, D 20 3.3K SLK-24FB HD-3 HS-221 HB-4
SERIES 4010 4090-9101&-9106 MDL NO B, D 20 3.3K SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-221 HB-4
SERIES 4010 4090-9101&-9106 MDL NO B, D 20 3.3K SLK-24FH HD-3 HSB-221S HB-54
SERIES 4010 4090-9101&-9106 MDL NO B, D 20 3.3K SLK-24KB HD-3 HS-221 HB-4
SERIES 4010 4090-9101&-9106 MDL NO B, D 20 3.3K SLK-24KB HD-3 HSB-221S HB-54
SERIES 4010 4090-9101&-9106 MDL NO B, D 20 40909101 SLK-24FB HD-3 HSB-221S HB-54
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
PANEL MODEL ZONE MODEL ZONE LOOP MAX EOL DETECTOR MODEL DETECTOR BASE MODEL BASE ID
ID STYLE DET ID
324 320/LC/OS-24 MDL NO B 15 15 K SIH-24F HD-2 HS-200 D HD-20
324 320/LC/OS-24 MDL NO B 11 15 K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
324 320/LC/OS-24 MDL NO B 13 15 K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
324 320/LC/OS-24 MDL NO B 13 15 K SLK-24FG HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
624/641 MX8/WIB MDL NO B 13 15K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
624/MX ADS MDL NO B 15 15 K SIH-24F HD-2 HS-200 D HD-20
624/MX ADS MDL NO B 11 15 K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
624/MX ADS MDL NO B 13 15 K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
624/MX ADS MDL NO B 13 15 K SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
624/MX ADS-H MDL NO B 50 4.7K SIH-24F HD-2 HS-200 D HD-20
624/MX ADS-H MDL NO B 39 4.7K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
624/MX ADS-H MDL NO B 44 4.7K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
624/MX MX/OSH MDL NO B 50 4.7K SIF-24F HD-2 HS-200 D HD-20
624/MX MX/OSH MDL NO B 40 4.7K OHM SIF-24F HD-2 HS-22D HB-3
624/MX MX/OSH MDL NO B 39 4.7K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
624/MX MX/OSH MDL NO B 44 4.7K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
624/MX MX/OSH MDL NO B 40 4.7K OHM SLK-24F HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
624/MX MX/OSH MDL NO B 44 4.7K SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
624/MX MX/OSH MDL NO B 39 4.7K SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
624/MX MX/OSH MDL NO B 40 4.7K OHM SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
624/MX MX/I0-1O MDL NO B, D 22 15 k SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
624/MX MX/I01O-H MDL NO B 39 4.7K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
624/MX MX/I01O MDL NO B 39 4.7K SIF-24F HD-2 HS-200 D HD-20
624/MX MX/I01O MDL NO B 50 4.7K SIF-24F HD-2 HS-200 D HD-20
624/MX MX/I01O MDL NO B, D 19 15 K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
624/MX MX/I01O MDL NO B, D 22 15 K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
624/MX MX/I01O-H MDL NO B 44 4.7K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
624/MX MX/I01O-H MDL NO B 44 4.7K SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
624/MX MX/I0-1O-H MDL NO B 50 4.7K OHM SIH-24F HD-2 HS-22D HB-3
624/MX MX/I0-1O-H MDL NO B 40 4.7K OHM SLK-24F HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
624/MX MX/I0-1O-H MDL NO B 40 4.7K OHM SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
624/MX MX/OSRP MDL NO B 15 15 K SIF-24F HD-2 HS-200 D HD-20
624/MX MX/OSRP MDL NO B 11 15 K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
624/MX MX/OSRP MDL NO B 13 15 K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
624/MX MX/OSRP MDL NO B 13 15 K SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
640 MX8/WIBH MDL NO B 50 4.7K OHM SIF-24F HD-2 HS-22D HB-3
640 MX8/WIBH MDL NO B 40 4.7K OHM SLK-24F HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
640 MX8/WIBH MDL NO B 40 4.7K OHM SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
640 S2W MDL NO B 50 4.7K OHM SIF-24F HD-2 HS-22D HB-3
640 S2W MDL NO B 40 4.7K OHM SLK-24F HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
640 S2W MDL NO B 40 4.7K OHM SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
640 S2WA MDL NO D 50 N/A SIF-24F HD-2 HS-22D HB-3
640 S2WA MDL NO D 40 N/A SLK-24F HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
640 S2WA MDL NO D 40 N/A SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
640/641 MX8/WIB MDL NO B 15 15 K SIF-24F HD-2 HS-200 D HD-20
640/641 MX8/WIB MDL NO B 50 4.7K SIF-24F HD-2 HS-200 D HD-20
640/641 MX8/WIB MDL NO B 11 15 K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
640/641 MX8/WIB MDL NO B 39 4.7K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
640/641 MX8/WIB MDL NO B 44 4.7K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
640/641 MX8/WIB MDL NO B 44 4.7K SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
640/641 MX8/WIB MDL NO B 13 15 K SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
640/641 S2/OSS MDL NO B 15 15 K SIF-24F HD-2 HS-200 D HD-20
640/641 S2/OSS MDL NO B 11 15 K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
640/641 S2/OSS MDL NO B 13 15 K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
640/641 S21/OSS MDL NO B 13 15 K SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
640/641 S2A MDL NO D 15 15 K SIF-24F HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
640/641 S2A MDL NO D 11 15 K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
640/641 S2A MDL NO D 13 15 K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
640/641 S2A MDL NO D 13 15 K SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
640/641 S2W MDL NO B 50 4.7K SIF-24F HD-2 HS-200 D HD-20
640/641 S2W MDL NO B 44 4.7K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
640/641 S2W MDL NO B 44 4.7K SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
640/641 S2WA MDL NO D 50 4.7K SIF-24F HD-2 HS-200 D HD-20
640/641 S2WA MDL NO D 39 4.7K SIH-24F HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
640/641 S2WA MDL NO D 44 4.7K SLK-24F HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
640/641 S2WA MDL NO D 44 4.7K SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-200 D HD-20
641 MX8/WIBH MDL NO B 50 4.7K OHM SIF-24F HD-2 HS-22D HB-3
641 MX8/WIBH MDL NO B 40 4.7K OHM SLK-24F HD-3 HS-22D HB-3
Page 1 of 2
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
Page 2 of 2
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
UPTIME
2-Wire Compatibility Listings
PANEL MODEL ZONE MODEL ZONE LOOP MAX EOL DETECTOR MODEL DETECTOR BASE MODEL BASE ID
ID STYLE DET ID
1A N/A ZA/B B 30 10K OHM SIF-24F HD-2 HS-21D HB-2
1A N/A ZA/B B 24 10K OHM SLK-24F HD-3 HS-21D HB-2
1A N/A ZA/B B 24 10K OHM SLK-24FH HD-3 HS-21D HB-2
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
VIKING
2-Wire Compatibility Listings
PANEL MODEL ZONE MODEL ZONE LOOP MAX EOL DETECTOR MODEL DETECTOR BASE MODEL BASE ID
ID STYLE DET ID
PAR-3, B-1 N/A A BD 30 71252 SIH-24F HD-3 HSB-220 HB-56
PAR-3, B-1 N/A A BD 30 71252 SIH-24F HD-3 HSB-224 HB-54
PAR-3, B-1 N/A A BD 30 71252 SLK-24F HD-3 HSB-220 HB-56
PAR-3, B-1 N/A A BD 30 71252 SLK-24F HD-3 HSB-224 HB-54
PAR-3, B-1 N/A A BD 30 71252 SLK-24FH HD-3 HSB-220 HB-56
PAR-3, B-1 N/A A BD 30 71252 SLK-24FH HD-3 HSB-224 HB-54
LIST OF COMPATIBLE CONTROL UNITS AND SMOKE DETECTORS 22-Oct-2002
LISTED AFTER MARCH 1, 1989
WORMALD
2-Wire Compatibility Listings
PANEL MODEL ZONE MODEL ZONE LOOP MAX EOL DETECTOR MODEL DETECTOR BASE MODEL BASE ID
ID STYLE DET ID
AUTOPULSE 1000 N/A SZB1 B 75 68710 SLK-24F HD-3 DB-201N HB-2
AUTOPULSE 1000 N/A SZB1 B 75 68710 SLK-24F HD-3 DBR-202N HB-7
AUTOPULSE 2000 N/A M6D1 D 45 N/A SLK-24F HD-3 DB-201N HB-2
AUTOPULSE 2000 N/A M6B1 B 75 70061 SLK-24F HD-3 DB-201N HB-2
AUTOPULSE 2000 N/A M6B1 B 75 70061 SLK-24F HD-3 DBR-202N HB-7
AUTOPULSE 3000 N/A M6D1 D 45 N/A SLK-24F HD-3 DB-201N HB-2
AUTOPULSE 3000 N/A M6B1 B 75 70061 SLK-24F HD-3 DBR-202N HB-7
AUTOPULSE 3000 N/A M6B1 B 75 70061 SLK-24F HD-3 DI-201N HD-2
AUTOPULSE 4000 N/A M20D1 D 40 N/A SLK-24F HD-3 DB-201N HB-2
AUTOPULSE 4000 N/A M20B1 B 75 70061 SLK-24F HD-3 DBR-202N HB-7
AUTOPULSE 4000 N/A M20B1 B 75 70061 SLK-24F HD-3 DI-201N HB-2
MULTIZONE 20M N/A M20D1 D 40 N/A SLK-24F HD-3 DB-201N HB-2
MULTIZONE 20M N/A M20B1 B 75 70061 SLK-24F HD-3 DBR-202N HB-7
MULTIZONE 20M N/A M20B1 B 75 70061 SLK-24F HD-3 DI-201N HB-2
MULTIZONE 20P N/A M20B1 B 75 70061 SLK-24F HD-3 DB-201N HB-2
MULTIZONE 20P N/A M20D1 D 40 N/A SLK-24F HD-3 DB-201N HB-2
MULTIZONE 20P N/A M20B1 B 75 70061 SLK-24F HD-3 DBR-202N HB-7
MULTIZONE 6P N/A M6D1 D 45 N/A SLK-24F HD-3 DB-201N HB-2
MULTIZONE 6P N/A M6B1 B 75 70061 SLK-24F HD-3 DBR-202N HB-7
MULTIZONE 6P N/A M6B1 B 75 70061 SLK-24F HD-3 DI-201N HB-2
CALIFORNIA DEPARTMENT OF FORESTRY & FIRE PROTECTION
OFFICE OF THE STATE FIRE MARSHAL
FIRE ENGINEERING - BUILDING MATERIALS LISTING PROGRAM
LISTING SERVICE
LISTING No. 3240-0410:155 Page 1 of 1
LISTEE: Hochiki America, 7051 Village Drive, Suite 100, Buena Park, CA 90621-2268
*Contact: Bob Misiuk (714) 670-3251 FAX (714) 690-7890
DESIGN: Models DH-98-I, DH-98-P, DH-98-A, DH-98-AR, DH-98-HVI and DH-98-HVP duct smoke
detector units. Each unit consists of a smoke detector head, Models SIJ-24DH (ionization
type), SLR-24DH or ALG-DH (photoelectric type), plastic enclosure, plastic cover, relays,
electrical components, and sampling and exhaust tubes. The smoke detector heads are
not suitable for use as open area detection. Refer to listee's data sheet for additional
detailed product description and operational considerations.
INSTALLATION: In accordance with listee's printed installation instructions, applicable codes & ordinances and
in a manner acceptable to the authority having jurisdiction.
APPROVAL: Listed as duct smoke detector units for use with separately listed compatible fire alarm
control units to detect an abnormal amount of smoke density in the return air ducts of air
conditioning and ventilating system. The air velocity in the duct shall be between 300-
4000 fpm.
NOTE: For duct application only. Not suitable for open area protection.
*Rev. 11-16-2000
This listing is based upon technical data submitted by the applicant. CSFM Fire Engineering staff has reviewed the test results
and/or other data but does not make an independent verification of any claims. This listing is not an endorsement or
recommendation of the item listed. This listing should not be used to verify correct operational requirements or installation
criteria. Refer to listee’s data sheet, installation instructions and/or other suitable information sources.
Date Issued: JUNE 12, 2006 Listing Expires June 30, 2007
LISTING SERVICE
LISTING No. 7120-0410:153 Page 1 of 1
CATEGORY: Annunciators
LISTEE: Hochiki America, 7051 Village Dr., Suite 100, Buena Park, CA 90621
*Contact: Bob Misiuk (714) 670-3251 FAX (714) 690-7890
DESIGN: Model HRAM-208 remote multiplex annunciator and HRTI-1 Remote trouble Indicator.
Refer to listee's data sheet for additional detailed product description and operational
considerations.
INSTALLATION: In accordance with listee's printed installation instructions, applicable codes & ordinances and
in a manner acceptable to the authority having jurisdiction. For indoor use only.
APPROVAL: Listed as annunciator panel for use with listee's separately listed compatible Model HCP-
200 Series fire alarm control unit (CSFM Listing No. 7165-0410:152).
XLF: 7120-1477:108
*Rev. 11-16-2000
This listing is based upon technical data submitted by the applicant. CSFM Fire Engineering staff has reviewed the test results
and/or other data but does not make an independent verification of any claims. This listing is not an endorsement or
recommendation of the item listed. This listing should not be used to verify correct operational requirements or installation
criteria. Refer to listee’s data sheet, installation instructions and/or other suitable information sources.
Date Issued: JUNE 12, 2006 Listing Expires June 30, 2007
LISTING SERVICE
LISTING No. 7120-0410:157 Page 1 of 1
CATEGORY: Annunciators
LISTEE: Hochiki America, 7051 Village Dr., Suite 100, Buena Park, CA 90621
*Contact: Bob Misiuk (714) 670-3251 FAX (714) 690-7890
DESIGN: Model HRA-1000 remote multiplex annunciator panel. The main annunciator module
provides indication for 32 zones. Each adder annunciator module provides indication for
48 additional zones. Unit includes main annunciator chassis HRAM-1032 and adder
annunciator chassis HRAX-1048. Refer to listee's data sheet for additional detailed
product description and operational considerations.
INSTALLATION: In accordance with listee's printed installation instructions, applicable codes & ordinances
and in a manner acceptable to the authority having jurisdiction. For indoor use only.
APPROVAL: Listed as annunciator panel for use with listee's separately listed compatible Model HPC-
1000 fire alarm control unit (CSFM Listing No. 7165-0410:154).
XLF: 7120-1477:107
*Rev. 11-16-2000
This listing is based upon technical data submitted by the applicant. CSFM Fire Engineering staff has reviewed the test results
and/or other data but does not make an independent verification of any claims. This listing is not an endorsement or
recommendation of the item listed. This listing should not be used to verify correct operational requirements or installation
criteria. Refer to listee’s data sheet, installation instructions and/or other suitable information sources.
Date Issued: JUNE 12, 2006 Listing Expires June 30, 2007
LISTING SERVICE
LISTING No. 7150-0410:156 Page 1 of 1
LISTEE: Hochiki America, 7051 Village Dr., Suite 100, Buena Park, CA 90621
Contact: Bob Misiuk (714) 670-3251 FAX (714) 690-7890
DESIGN: Models HMS-401U, HMS-501U noncoded fire alarm manual pull stations; and Model
HMS-DA station adapter. Refer to listee's data sheet for additional detailed product
description and operational considerations.
RATING: 30 VDC, 1A
INSTALLATION: In accordance with listee's printed installation instructions, applicable codes & ordinances and
in a manner acceptable to the authority having jurisdiction.
APPROVAL: Listed as fire alarm manual pull stations for use with separately listed electrically and
functionally compatible fire alarm control units.
XLF: 7150-1477:101
10-02-2000
This listing is based upon technical data submitted by the applicant. CSFM Fire Engineering staff has reviewed the test results
and/or other data but does not make an independent verification of any claims. This listing is not an endorsement or
recommendation of the item listed. This listing should not be used to verify correct operational requirements or installation
criteria. Refer to listee’s data sheet, installation instructions and/or other suitable information sources.
Date Issued: JUNE 12, 2006 Listing Expires June 30, 2007
LISTING SERVICE
LISTING No. 7165-0410:152 Page 1 of 1
LISTEE: Hochiki America, 7051 Village Dr., Suite 100, Buena Park, CA 90621
*Contact: Bob Misiuk (714) 670-3251 FAX (714) 690-7890
DESIGN: Model HCP-201, HCP-202, HCP-204 and HCP-204E fire alarm control units. Non-coded;
automatic, manual, local, remote station, central station, waterflow and sprinkler
supervisory service. System components:
INSTALLATION: In accordance with listee's printed installation instructions, applicable codes & ordinances,
and in a manner acceptable to the authority having jurisdiction.
APPROVAL: Listed as fire alarm control units for use with separately listed electrically and functionally
compatible initiating and indicating devices.
This control unit does not generate a temporal pattern signal. If the distinctive three-pulse
Temporal Pattern Fire Alarm Evacuation Signal (for total evacuation) in accordance with
NFPA 72, 1999 Edition is required, the control unit must be used with appliances that can
generate the temporal pattern signal. Refer to listee's Installation instructions Manual for
details.
NOTE: For Fire Alarm Verification Feature, the maximum Retard/Reset/Restart period shall not
exceed 30.0 seconds.
XLF: 07165-1477:109
*Rev. 11-16-2000
This listing is based upon technical data submitted by the applicant. CSFM Fire Engineering staff has reviewed the test results
and/or other data but does not make an independent verification of any claims. This listing is not an endorsement or
recommendation of the item listed. This listing should not be used to verify correct operational requirements or installation
criteria. Refer to listee’s data sheet, installation instructions and/or other suitable information sources.
Date Issued: JUNE 12, 2006 Listing Expires June 30, 2007
LISTING SERVICE
LISTING No. 7165-0410:154 Page 1 of 1
LISTEE: Hochiki America, 7051 Village Dr., Suite 100, Buena Park, CA 90621
*Contact: Bob Misiuk (714) 670-3251 FAX (714) 690-7890
DESIGN: HCP-1000 fire alarm control unit. Non-coded, automatic, manual, local, auxiliary, remote
station, waterflow and sprinkler supervisory service. System components:
INSTALLATION: In accordance with listee's printed installation instructions, applicable codes & ordinances,
and in a manner acceptable to the authority having jurisdiction.
APPROVAL: Listed as fire alarm control units for use with separately listed electrically and functionally
compatible initiating and indicating devices.
This control unit can generate a distinctive three-pulse Temporal Pattern Fire Alarm
Evacuation Signal (for total evacuation) in accordance with NFPA 72, 1999 Edition. Refer
to listee's Installation Manual for details.
NOTE: For Fire Alarm Verification Feature (delay of fire alarm signal), the maximum
Retard/Reset/Restart period shall not exceed 30 seconds.
XLF: 7165-1477:106
*Rev. 11-16-2000
This listing is based upon technical data submitted by the applicant. CSFM Fire Engineering staff has reviewed the test results
and/or other data but does not make an independent verification of any claims. This listing is not an endorsement or
recommendation of the item listed. This listing should not be used to verify correct operational requirements or installation
criteria. Refer to listee’s data sheet, installation instructions and/or other suitable information sources.
Date Issued: JUNE 12, 2006 Listing Expires June 30, 2007
LISTING SERVICE
LISTING No. 7165-0410:159 Page 1 of 1
LISTEE: Hochiki America, 7051 Village Dr., Suite 100, Buena Park, CA 90621-*2268
Contact: Bob Misiuk (714) 670-3251 FAX (714) 690-7890
DESIGN: Model FireNet 4127 Analog Addressable fire alarm control unit. Automatic, manual, waterflow and
sprinkler supervisory service. Refer to the listee's data sheet for detailed product description and
operational considerations. System components:
INSTALLATION: In accordance with listee's printed installation instructions, applicable codes & ordinances,
and in a manner acceptable to the authority having jurisdiction.
APPROVAL: Listed as fire alarm control panel for use with separately listed electrically and functionally
compatible initiating and indicating devices. Refer to listee’s Installation Instruction Manual for
details.
*This control unit can generate a temporal pattern Fire Alarm Evacuation signal (for total
evacuation) in accordance with NFPA 72, 1999 Edition.
NOTE: For Fire Alarm Verification Feature (delay of fire alarm signal), the maximum
Retard/Reset/Restart period shall not exceed 30 seconds.
*Corr. 10-18-2005
This listing is based upon technical data submitted by the applicant. CSFM Fire Engineering staff has reviewed the test results
and/or other data but does not make an independent verification of any claims. This listing is not an endorsement or
recommendation of the item listed. This listing should not be used to verify correct operational requirements or installation
criteria. Refer to listee’s data sheet, installation instructions and/or other suitable information sources.
Date Issued: JUNE 12, 2006 Listing Expires June 30, 2007
LISTING SERVICE
LISTING No. 7260-0410:141 Page 1 of 1
LISTEE: Hochiki America, 7051 Village Drive, Suite 100, Buena Park, CA 90621-2268
*Contact: Bob Misiuk (714) 670-3251 FAX (714) 690-7890
DESIGN: Model SPB-24 and SPB-24N projected beam smoke detection system. Unit consists of one
emitter unit and one receiver unit. Refer to listee's printed data sheet for additional product
description and operational consideration.
RATING: 24 VDC
INSTALLATION: In accordance with listee's printed installation instructions, applicable codes and ordinances
and in a manner acceptable to the authority having jurisdiction.
APPROVAL: Listed as beam smoke detectors for use with separately listed compatible fire alarm control
units.
*Rev. 11-16-2000
This listing is based upon technical data submitted by the applicant. CSFM Fire Engineering staff has reviewed the test results
and/or other data but does not make an independent verification of any claims. This listing is not an endorsement or
recommendation of the item listed. This listing should not be used to verify correct operational requirements or installation
criteria. Refer to listee’s data sheet, installation instructions and/or other suitable information sources.
Date Issued: JUNE 12, 2006 Listing Expires June 30, 2007
LISTING SERVICE
LISTINGS No. 7260-0410:158 Page 1 of 1
LISTEE: Hochiki America, 7051 Village Drive, Suite 100, Buena Park, CA 90621-2268
Contact: Bob Misiuk (714) 670-3251 FAX (714) 690-7890
DESIGN: Model SRA-24 projected beam smoke detector. Unit consists of a transmitter/receiver unit
and a reflector unit. This device is intended for ceiling installation only between 25 to 100 ft
apart. Refer to the listee's data sheet for detailed product description and operational
considerations.
RATING: 24 V dc
INSTALLATION: In accordance with listee's printed installation instructions, applicable codes and ordinances
and in a manner acceptable to the authority having jurisdiction
APPROVAL: Listed as beam smoke detector for use with separately listed compatible fire alarm control
units. Refer to listee’s Installation Instructions Manual for details.
04-14-03KK
This listing is based upon technical data submitted by the applicant. CSFM Fire Engineering staff has reviewed the test results
and/or other data but does not make an independent verification of any claims. This listing is not an endorsement or
recommendation of the item listed. This listing should not be used to verify correct operational requirements or installation
criteria. Refer to listee’s data sheet, installation instructions and/or other suitable information sources.
Date Issued: JUNE 12, 2006 Listing Expires June 30, 2007
LISTING SERVICE
LISTING No. 7270-0410:119 Page 1 of 1
LISTEE: Hochiki America, 7051 Village Dr., Suite 100, Buena Park, CA 90621-2268
*Contact: Bob Misiuk (714) 670-3251 FAX (714) 690-7890
DESIGN: Models AL-DFE-135 and AL-DFE-190. Refer to listee's data sheet for detailed product
description and operational considerations.
INSTALLATION: In accordance with the listee's printed installation instructions, applicable codes and
ordinances and in a manner acceptable to the authority having jurisdiction.
MARKING: Listee's name, model number, temperature & electrical ratings and UL label.
APPROVAL: Listed as system heat detectors when used in conjunction with listed compatible bases
(CSFM Listing No. 7300-0410:132) and separately listed compatible control units.
*Rev. 11-16-2000
This listing is based upon technical data submitted by the applicant. CSFM Fire Engineering staff has reviewed the test results
and/or other data but does not make an independent verification of any claims. This listing is not an endorsement or
recommendation of the item listed. This listing should not be used to verify correct operational requirements or installation
criteria. Refer to listee’s data sheet, installation instructions and/or other suitable information sources.
Date Issued: JUNE 12, 2006 Listing Expires June 30, 2007
LISTING SERVICE
LISTING No. 7270-0410:139 Page 1 of 1
LISTEE: Hochiki America, 7051 Village Dr., Suite 100, Buena Park, CA 90621-2268
*Contact: Bob Misiuk (714) 670-3251 FAX (714) 690-7890
DESIGN: Model ATA-EA detector with Model YBC-RL/2NC or YBF-RL/2NBE base. Refer to listee's data
sheet for detailed product description and operational considerations.
INSTALLATION: In accordance with listee's printed installation instructions, applicable codes and ordinances and
in a manner acceptable to the authority having jurisdiction.
APPROVAL: Listed as a heat detector for use with Fike Model 10-201 control unit (CSFM Listing No. 7165-
0900:106).
*Rev. 11-16-2000
This listing is based upon technical data submitted by the applicant. CSFM Fire Engineering staff has reviewed the test results
and/or other data but does not make an independent verification of any claims. This listing is not an endorsement or
recommendation of the item listed. This listing should not be used to verify correct operational requirements or installation
criteria. Refer to listee’s data sheet, installation instructions and/or other suitable information sources.
Date Issued: JUNE 12, 2006 Listing Expires June 30, 2007
LISTING SERVICE
LISTING No. 7270-0410:147 Page 1 of 1
LISTEE: Hochiki America, 7051 Village Drive, Suite 100, Buena Park, CA 90621-2268
Contact: Bob Misiuk (714) 670-3251 Fax (714) 690-7890
DESIGN: Model ATG-EA electronic fixed temperature heat detector (analog) with Models YBN-NSA-4
and HSB-NSA-6 bases. Unit consists of resistors, capacitors, diodes, transistors, LED,
thermistors, mounted on a printed wiring board inside an enclosure. Refer to listee's data
sheet for additional detailed product description and operational considerations.
INSTALLATION: In accordance with listee's printed installation instructions, applicable codes & ordinances and
in a manner acceptable to the authority having jurisdiction.
APPROVAL: Listed as heat detector for use with separately listed compatible fire alarm control units.
*Corrected 11-06-2001
This listing is based upon technical data submitted by the applicant. CSFM Fire Engineering staff has reviewed the test results
and/or other data but does not make an independent verification of any claims. This listing is not an endorsement or
recommendation of the item listed. This listing should not be used to verify correct operational requirements or installation
criteria. Refer to listee’s data sheet, installation instructions and/or other suitable information sources.
Date Issued: JUNE 12, 2006 Listing Expires June 30, 2007
LISTING SERVICE
LISTING No. 7270-0410:151 Page 1 of 1
LISTEE: Hochiki America, 7051 Village Drive, Suite 100, Buena Park, CA 90621-2268
*Contact: Bob Misiuk (714) 670-3251 FAX (714) 690-7890
DESIGN: Models DCD-135 and DCD-190, fixed temperature and rate of rise heat detectors. Refer to
listee's data sheet for additional detailed product description and operational considerations.
INSTALLATION: In accordance with listee's printed installation instructions, applicable codes and ordinances
and in a manner acceptable to the authority having jurisdiction.
APPROVAL: Listed as fixed temperature and rate of rise heat detector for use listed bases (CSFM Listing
No. 7300-0410:132) and separately listed fire alarm control units.
*Rev. 11-16-2000
This listing is based upon technical data submitted by the applicant. CSFM Fire Engineering staff has reviewed the test results
and/or other data but does not make an independent verification of any claims. This listing is not an endorsement or
recommendation of the item listed. This listing should not be used to verify correct operational requirements or installation
criteria. Refer to listee’s data sheet, installation instructions and/or other suitable information sources.
Date Issued: JUNE 12, 2006 Listing Expires June 30, 2007
LISTING SERVICE
LISTING No. 7271-0410:135 Page 1 of 1
LISTEE: Hochiki America, 7051 Village Dr., Suite 100, Buena Park, CA 90621-2268
*Contact: Bob Misiuk (714) 670-3251 FAX (714) 690-7890
DESIGN: Models SIH-24F and *SIJ-24 ionization type smoke detector. Refer to listee's data sheet for
detailed product description and operational considerations.
RATING: 24 VDC
INSTALLATION: In accordance with listee's printed installation instructions, applicable codes and ordinances
and in a manner acceptable to the authority having jurisdiction.
APPROVAL: Listed as ionization smoke detectors when used in conjunction with listed bases (CSFM
Listing No. 7300-0410:132) and separately listed compatible fire alarm control units.
*Rev. 11-16--2000
This listing is based upon technical data submitted by the applicant. CSFM Fire Engineering staff has reviewed the test results
and/or other data but does not make an independent verification of any claims. This listing is not an endorsement or
recommendation of the item listed. This listing should not be used to verify correct operational requirements or installation
criteria. Refer to listee’s data sheet, installation instructions and/or other suitable information sources.
Date Issued: JUNE 12, 2006 Listing Expires June 30, 2007
LISTING SERVICE
LISTING No. 7272-0410:107 Page 1 of 1
LISTEE: Hochiki America, 7051 Village Dr., Suite 100, Buena Park, CA 90621
Contact: Bob Misiuk (714) 670-3251 Fax (714) 690-7890
DESIGN: Models SLG-12, SLG-24, SLG-24FH, SLG-24F, SLK-12, SLK-24F, SLK-24FH, SLK-
24FB, SLK-24FL, SLK-24FLB, SLK-835, SLK-835H, SLR-835, SLR-835W, SLR-835B-
2, SLR-835B-4, SLR-835B-2W, SLR-835B-4W, SLR-24, SLR-24H, SLR-24V, *SLR-
24VN, SLR-835H, SLR-835HW, SLR-835BH-2, SLR-835BH-2W, SLR-835BH-4, SLR-
835BH-4W photoelectric type smoke detectors. Unit with suffix -H or -FH employs a
supplemental heat sensor. Refer to listee's data sheet for additional detailed product
description and operational considerations.
INSTALLATION: In accordance with listee's printed installation instructions, applicable codes & ordinances and
in a manner acceptable to the authority having jurisdiction.
APPROVAL: Listed as photoelectric smoke detectors for use with separately listed compatible fire alarm
control units when used in conjunction with listee's listed bases (CSFM Listing No. 7300-
0410:132). Models with supplemental heat sensor are not approved for use in lieu of
required heat detectors.
This listing is based upon technical data submitted by the applicant. CSFM Fire Engineering staff has reviewed the test results
and/or other data but does not make an independent verification of any claims. This listing is not an endorsement or
recommendation of the item listed. This listing should not be used to verify correct operational requirements or installation
criteria. Refer to listee’s data sheet, installation instructions and/or other suitable information sources.
Date Issued: JUNE 12, 2006 Listing Expires June 30, 2007
LISTING SERVICE
LISTING No. 7272-0410:107 Page 1 of 1
LISTEE: Hochiki America, 7051 Village Dr., Suite 100, Buena Park, CA 90621
Contact: Bob Misiuk (714) 670-3251 Fax (714) 690-7890
DESIGN: Models SLG-12, SLG-24, SLG-24FH, SLG-24F, SLK-12, SLK-24F, SLK-24FH, SLK-
24FB, SLK-24FL, SLK-24FLB, SLK-835, SLK-835H, SLR-835, SLR-835W, SLR-835B-
2, SLR-835B-4, SLR-835B-2W, SLR-835B-4W, SLR-24, SLR-24H, SLR-24V, *SLR-
24VN, SLR-835H, SLR-835HW, SLR-835BH-2, SLR-835BH-2W, SLR-835BH-4, SLR-
835BH-4W photoelectric type smoke detectors. Unit with suffix -H or -FH employs a
supplemental heat sensor. Refer to listee's data sheet for additional detailed product
description and operational considerations.
INSTALLATION: In accordance with listee's printed installation instructions, applicable codes & ordinances and
in a manner acceptable to the authority having jurisdiction.
APPROVAL: Listed as photoelectric smoke detectors for use with separately listed compatible fire alarm
control units when used in conjunction with listee's listed bases (CSFM Listing No. 7300-
0410:132). Models with supplemental heat sensor are not approved for use in lieu of
required heat detectors.
This listing is based upon technical data submitted by the applicant. CSFM Fire Engineering staff has reviewed the test results
and/or other data but does not make an independent verification of any claims. This listing is not an endorsement or
recommendation of the item listed. This listing should not be used to verify correct operational requirements or installation
criteria. Refer to listee’s data sheet, installation instructions and/or other suitable information sources.
Date Issued: JUNE 21, 2004 Listing Expires June 30, 2005
LISTING SERVICE
LISTING No. 7272-0410:140 Page 1 of 1
LISTEE: Hochiki America, 7051 Village Drive, Suite 100, Buena Park, CA 90621-2268
*Contact: Bob Misiuk (714) 670-3251 FAX (714) 690-7890
DESIGN: Model ALA-EA detector with Model YBC-RL/2NC base, and Model ALB-EA with Models
YBC-RL/2NC and YBF-RL/2NBE bases. Refer to listee's data sheet for detailed product
description and operational considerations.
INSTALLATION: In accordance with listee's printed installation instructions, applicable codes and ordinances
and in a manner acceptable to the authority having jurisdiction.
APPROVAL: Listed as photoelectric smoke detectors for use with Fike Model 10-201 control unit (CSFM
Listing No. 7165-0900:106).
*Rev. 11-16-2000
This listing is based upon technical data submitted by the applicant. CSFM Fire Engineering staff has reviewed the test results
and/or other data but does not make an independent verification of any claims. This listing is not an endorsement or
recommendation of the item listed. This listing should not be used to verify correct operational requirements or installation
criteria. Refer to listee’s data sheet, installation instructions and/or other suitable information sources.
Date Issued: JUNE 12, 2006 Listing Expires June 30, 2007
LISTING SERVICE
LISTING No. 7272-0410:149 Page 1 of 1
LISTEE: Hochiki America, 7051 Village Drive, Suite 100, Buena Park, CA 90621-2268
*Contact: Bob Misiuk (714) 670-3251 FAX (714) 690-7890
DESIGN: Models ALG-EA and ALG-V analog addressable photoelectric type smoke detector with
Models YBN-NSA-4 and HSB-NSA-6 bases. Unit consists of resistors, capacitors,
diodes, transistors, LED, photo diode, mounted on a printed wiring board inside an
enclosure. Refer to listee's data sheet for additional detailed product description and
operational considerations.
INSTALLATION: In accordance with listee's printed installation instructions, applicable codes & ordinances
and in a manner acceptable to the authority having jurisdiction.
APPROVAL: Listed as photoelectric smoke detector for use with separately listed compatible fire alarm
control units.
*Rev. 11-16-2000
This listing is based upon technical data submitted by the applicant. CSFM Fire Engineering staff has reviewed the test results
and/or other data but does not make an independent verification of any claims. This listing is not an endorsement or
recommendation of the item listed. This listing should not be used to verify correct operational requirements or installation
criteria. Refer to listee’s data sheet, installation instructions and/or other suitable information sources.
Date Issued: JUNE 12, 2006 Listing Expires June 30, 2007
LISTING SERVICE
LISTING No. 7300-0410:132 Page 1 of 2
LISTEE: Hochiki America, *7051 Village Dr., Suite 100, Buena Park, CA 90621-2268
Contact: Bob Misiuk (714) 670-3251 Fax (714) 690-7890
DESIGN: Detector bases (2 and 4-wire). Unit is intended for use with a separately listed compatible
detector head. Refer to listee's data sheet for detailed product description and operational
considerations. Models listed below.
*Corrected. 11-06-2001
Listing No. 7300-0410:132
Page 2 of 2
INSTALLATION: In accordance with listee's printed installation instructions, applicable codes and ordinances
and in a manner acceptable to the authority having jurisdiction.
APPROVAL: Listed as bases for use with listee’s separately listed compatible smoke and heat detectors.
Refer to heat or smoke detector listings for compatibility. Models HA-2R, HA-SLR, HA-LRA2
and HSC Series w/ suffix R are also suitable for releasing device service. Model YBA-R3 is
intended for use with thermostat detector only.
NOTE: Formerly 7300-0410:100, 106, 115, 124, 125, 126, 130, 131 & 133
*Corrected 11-06-2001
This listing is based upon technical data submitted by the applicant. CSFM Fire Engineering staff has reviewed the test
results and/or other data but does not make an independent verification of any claims. This listing is not an endorsement or
recommendation of the item listed. This listing should not be used to verify correct operational requirements o r installation
criteria. Refer to listee’s data sheet, installation instructions and/or other suitable information sources.
Date Issued: JUNE 14, 2003 Listing Expires June 30, 2004
LISTING SERVICE
LISTING No. 7300-0410:137 Page 1 of 1
LISTEE: Hochiki America, 7051 Village Dr., Suite 100, Buena Park, CA 90621-2268
*Contact: Bob Misiuk (714) 670-3251 FAX (714) 690-7890
INSTALLATION: In accordance with listee's printed installation instructions, applicable codes and ordinances
and in a manner acceptable to the authority having jurisdiction.
MARKING: Listee's name, model number, contact and coil rating, and UL label.
APPROVAL: Listed as end-of-line relays for use with separately listed compatible 4-wire detectors.
*Rev. 11-16-2000
This listing is based upon technical data submitted by the applicant. CSFM Fire Engineering staff has reviewed the test results
and/or other data but does not make an independent verification of any claims. This listing is not an endorsement or
recommendation of the item listed. This listing should not be used to verify correct operational requirements or installation
criteria. Refer to listee’s data sheet, installation instructions and/or other suitable information sources.
Date Issued: JUNE 12, 2006 Listing Expires June 30, 2007
LISTING SERVICE
LISTING No. 7300-0410:143 Page 1 of 1
LISTEE: Hochiki America, 7051 Village Drive, Suite 100, Buena Park, CA 90621-2268
*Contact: Bob Misiuk (714) 670-3251 Fax (714) 690-7890
DESIGN: Model YBJ-RL/2ND and HSB-DCP-6 detector bases. Refer to listee's data sheet for
additional detailed product description and operational considerations.
INSTALLATION: In accordance with listee's printed installation instructions, applicable codes & ordinances and
in a manner acceptable to the authority having jurisdiction.
APPROVAL: Listed as detector bases for use with listee's separately listed electrically compatible detector
heads and fire alarm control units.
*Rev. 11-16-2000
This listing is based upon technical data submitted by the applicant. CSFM Fire Engineering staff has reviewed the test results
and/or other data but does not make an independent verification of any claims. This listing is not an endorsement or
recommendation of the item listed. This listing should not be used to verify correct operational requirements or installation
criteria. Refer to listee’s data sheet, installation instructions and/or other suitable information sources.
Date Issued: JUNE 12, 2006 Listing Expires June 30, 2007
LISTING SERVICE
LISTING No. 7300-0410:150 Page 1 of 1
LISTEE: Hochiki America, 7051 Village Dr., Suite 100, Buena Park, CA 90621-2268
Contact: Bob Misiuk (714) 670-3251 FAX (714) 690-7890
Refer to listee's data sheet for additional detailed product description and operational
considerations.
INSTALLATION: In accordance with listee's printed installation instructions, applicable codes & ordinances and
in a manner acceptable to the authority having jurisdiction.
APPROVAL: Listed as control unit accessories for use with separately listed compatible fire alarm control
units. Refer to listee’s Installation Instruction Manual for details.
*Rev. 06-08-04
This listing is based upon technical data submitted by the applicant. CSFM Fire Engineering staff has reviewed the test results
and/or other data but does not make an independent verification of any claims. This listing is not an endorsement or
recommendation of the item listed. This listing should not be used to verify correct operational requirements or installation
criteria. Refer to listee’s data sheet, installation instructions and/or other suitable information sources.
Date Issued: JUNE 12, 2006 Listing Expires June 30, 2007
LISTING SERVICE
LISTING No. 7300-0410:160 Page 1 of 1
LISTEE: Hochiki America, 7051 Village Dr., Suite 100, Buena Park, CA 90621-2268
Contact: Bob Misiuk (714) 670-3251 FAX (714) 690-7890
DESIGN: Models SBC-2, -2R, -4/12, -4/24 detector sounder base. The use of suffix “W” indicates
the color white. Unit SBC-2R employs a relay. SBC-4 models employ extra output leads
for connection to a control panel intitiating loop. Refer to listee's data sheet for additional
detailed product description and operational considerations.
INSTALLATION: In accordance with listee's printed installation instructions, applicable codes & ordinances and
in a manner acceptable to the authority having jurisdiction.
APPROVAL: Listed as detector base for use with separately listed functionally and electrically compatible
fire alarm control units. Designed specifically for use with listee’s Models SIJ-24 (CSFM
Listing No. 7271-0410:135) Ionization Smoke Detector or Models SLR-24V, SLR-835 (CSFM
Listing No. 7272-0410:107) Photoelectric Smoke Detector. Refer to listee’s Installation
Instruction Manual for details.
NOTE: These appliances can generate a distinctive three-pulse Temporal Pattern Fire Alarm
Evacuation Signal (for total evacuation) in accordance with NFPA 72, 1999 Edition.
10-27-03
This listing is based upon technical data submitted by the applicant. CSFM Fire Engineering staff has reviewed the test results
and/or other data but does not make an independent verification of any claims. This listing is not an endorsement or
recommendation of the item listed. This listing should not be used to verify correct operational requirements or installation
criteria. Refer to listee’s data sheet, installation instructions and/or other suitable information sources.
Date Issued: JUNE 12, 2006 Listing Expires June 30, 2007
LISTING SERVICE
LISTING No. 7151-0410:163 Page 1 of 1
LISTEE: Hochiki America, 7051 Village Drive, Suite 100, Buena Park, CA 90621-2268
Contact: Bob Misiuk (714) 670-3251 Fax (714) 690-7890
DESIGN: Model HPS-SA-EX/WP with or without the suffix DA-C non-coded, explosion proof,
weather proof manual pull stations. These devices consist of a switch and terminal block
mounted within an explosion proof enclosure. Refer to listee's data sheet for additional
detailed product description and operational considerations.
INSTALLATION: In accordance with listee's printed installation instructions, applicable codes and ordinances,
and in a manner acceptable to the authority having jurisdiction.
APPROVAL: Listed as fire alarm manual pull stations for use with separately listed compatible fire alarm
control units. Suitable for use outdoor and in Class I, Group B, C and D; Class II, Group E, F
and G hazardous locations. Refer to listee’s Installation Instruction Manual for details.
XLF: 7151-1039:104
08-24-2004
This listing is based upon technical data submitted by the applicant. CSFM Fire Engineering staff has reviewed the test results
and/or other data but does not make an independent verification of any claims. This listing is not an endorsement or
recommendation of the item listed. This listing should not be used to verify correct operational requirements or installation
criteria. Refer to listee’s data sheet, installation instructions and/or other suitable information sources.
Date Issued: JUNE 12, 2006 Listing Expires June 30, 2007
LISTING SERVICE
LISTING No. 7150-0410:164 Page 1 of 1
LISTEE: Hochiki America, 7051 Village Drive, Suite 100, Buena Park, CA 90621-2268
Contact: Bob Misiuk (714) 670-3251 Fax (714) 690-7890
DESIGN: Models HPS-CP and HPS/CP/S non-coded boxes. Refer to listee's data sheet for detailed
product description and operational considerations.
INSTALLATION: In accordance with listee's printed installation instructions, applicable codes and ordinances and
in a manner acceptable to the authority having jurisdiction.
APPROVAL: Listed as boxes for use with separately listed compatible fire alarm control units. Refer to
listee’s Installation Instruction Manual for details.
XLF: 7150-0512:006
08-24-2004
This listing is based upon technical data submitted by the applicant. CSFM Fire Engineering staff has reviewed the test results
and/or other data but does not make an independent verification of any claims. This listing is not an endorsement or
recommendation of the item listed. This listing should not be used to verify correct operational requirements or installation
criteria. Refer to listee’s data sheet, installation instructions and/or other suitable information sources.
Date Issued: JUNE 12, 2006 Listing Expires June 30, 2007
LISTING SERVICE
LISTING No. 7150-0410:162 Page 1 of 1
LISTEE: Hochiki America, 7051 Village Drive, Suite 100, Buena Park, CA 90621-2268
Contact: Bob Misiuk (714) 670-3251 Fax (714) 690-7890
DESIGN: Models HPS-SAH, HPS/SAK, HPS-DAH, HPS-DAH/S, and HPS-SAH-WP with or without
the suffix DA-C non-coded manual pull stations. Refer to listee's data sheet for detailed
product description and operational considerations.
INSTALLATION: In accordance with listee's printed installation instructions and applicable codes and
ordinances and in a manner acceptable to the authority having jurisdiction.
APPROVAL: Listed as fire alarm manual pull stations for use with separately listed compatible fire alarm
control units. Model HPS-SAH-WP is suitable for outdoor use. Refer to listee’s Installation
Instruction Manual for details.
XLF: 7150-1039:101
08-24-2004
This listing is based upon technical data submitted by the applicant. CSFM Fire Engineering staff has reviewed the test results
and/or other data but does not make an independent verification of any claims. This listing is not an endorsement or
recommendation of the item listed. This listing should not be used to verify correct operational requirements or installation
criteria. Refer to listee’s data sheet, installation instructions and/or other suitable information sources.
Date Issued: JUNE 12, 2006 Listing Expires June 30, 2007
LISTING SERVICE
LISTING No. 7120-0410:165 Page 1 of 1
CATEGORY: Annunciators
LISTEE: Hochiki America, 7051 Village Dr., Suite 100, Buena Park, CA 90621-2268
Contact: Bob Misiuk (714) 670-3251 Fax (714) 690-7890
DESIGN: Model FN-LCD-N Network LCD Annunciator. Connects to the control panel via the RS-
485 network interface. Employs four Form C relays that are unsupervised. Refer to
listee's data sheet for additional detailed product description and operational
considerations.
RATING: 24 VDC
INSTALLATION: In accordance with listee's printed installation instructions, applicable codes & ordinances
and in a manner acceptable to the authority having jurisdiction.
APPROVAL: Listed as annunciator panel for use with listee's separately listed compatible Model FireNet
4127 fire alarm control unit (CSFM Listing No. 7165-0410:159). Refer to listee’s Installation
Instruction Manual for details.
01-12-2005
This listing is based upon technical data submitted by the applicant. CSFM Fire Engineering staff has reviewed the test results
and/or other data but does not make an independent verification of any claims. This listing is not an endorsement or
recommendation of the item listed. This listing should not be used to verify correct operational requirements or installation
criteria. Refer to listee’s data sheet, installation instructions and/or other suitable information sources.
Date Issued: JUNE 12, 2006 Listing Expires June 30, 2007
LISTING SERVICE
LISTING No. 7300-0410:161 Page 1 of 1
LISTEE: Hochiki America, 7051 Village Dr., Suite 100, Buena Park, CA 90621-2268
Contact: Bob Misiuk (714) 670-3251 FAX (714) 690-7890
DESIGN: Model ASB detector sounder base. Unit has an intregral audible signal for use with spot-
type detector units. Refer to listee's data sheet for additional detailed product description
and operational considerations.
INSTALLATION: In accordance with listee's printed installation instructions, applicable codes & ordinances and
in a manner acceptable to the authority having jurisdiction.
APPROVAL: Listed as a detector base for use with separately listed functionally and electrically compatible
fire alarm control units. Designed specifically for use with listee’s Model ALG-V (CSFM
Listing No. 7272-0410:149) Photoelectric Smoke Detector; Model AIE-EA (CSFM Listing No.
7271-0410:148) Ionization Smoke Detector; or Model ATG-EA (CSFM Listing No. 7270-
0410:147) Heat Detector. Refer to listee’s Installation Instruction Manual for details.
NOTE: These appliances can generate a distinctive three-pulse Temporal Pattern Fire Alarm
Evacuation Signal (for total evacuation) in accordance with NFPA 72, 1999 Edition.
08-24-2004
This listing is based upon technical data submitted by the applicant. CSFM Fire Engineering staff has reviewed the test results
and/or other data but does not make an independent verification of any claims. This listing is not an endorsement or
recommendation of the item listed. This listing should not be used to verify correct operational requirements or installation
criteria. Refer to listee’s data sheet, installation instructions and/or other suitable information sources.
Date Issued: JUNE 12, 2006 Listing Expires June 30, 2007